]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/gnus.texi
Restore deleted entry.
[gnu-emacs] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12
13 @quotation
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
21
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
25
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
30 @end quotation
31 @end copying
32
33 @iftex
34 @iflatex
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
38 \usepackage{epsfig}
39 \usepackage{pixidx}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
41
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
43 \else
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
45 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
46 \pdfcompresslevel=9
47 \fi
48
49 \makeindex
50 \begin{document}
51
52 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.11}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \else
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \fi
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
113 }
114
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
118 {\mbox{}}
119 }
120
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
122 \gnusdimen 0pt
123
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \gnuscleardoublepage
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \chapter{#2}
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \hspace*{-2cm}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
135 \end{picture}
136 \clearpage
137 }
138
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \begin{figure}
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
142 #3
143 \end{picture}
144 \caption{#1}
145 \end{figure}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
162 }
163
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
168 \section{#1}
169 }
170
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 }
179 }{\end{list}}
180
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
182 {\begin{list}{}{
183 \labelwidth=0cm
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
208 {\begin{list}{}{
209 }
210 }{\end{list}}
211
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
217 {
218 {
219 \ifodd\count0
220 {
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
222 }
223 \else
224 {
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
226 }
227 }
228 \fi
229 }
230 }
231 {
232 \ifodd\count0
233 \mbox{} \hfill
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \else
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \hfill \mbox{}
238 \fi
239 }
240
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
242 {
243 {
244 \ifodd\count0
245 {
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
247 }
248 \else
249 {
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
251 }
252 \fi
253 }
254 }
255 {
256 \ifodd\count0
257 \mbox{} \hfill
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \else
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \hfill \mbox{}
262 \fi
263 }
264
265 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
266 {
267 {
268 \ifodd\count0
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
271 }
272 \else
273 {
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
275 }
276 \fi
277 }
278 }
279 {
280 \ifodd\count0
281 \mbox{} \hfill
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \else
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \hfill \mbox{}
286 \fi
287 }
288
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
291
292 @end iflatex
293 @end iftex
294
295 @iftex
296 @iflatex
297
298 \begin{titlepage}
299 {
300
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \parindent=0cm
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \vfill
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
310 \vfill
311 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
313 \newpage
314 }
315
316 \mbox{}
317 \vfill
318
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
320
321 @c @insertcopying
322 \newpage
323 \end{titlepage}
324 @end iflatex
325 @end iftex
326
327 @ifnottex
328 @insertcopying
329 @end ifnottex
330
331 @dircategory Emacs
332 @direntry
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
334 @end direntry
335 @iftex
336 @finalout
337 @end iftex
338 @setchapternewpage odd
339
340
341
342 @titlepage
343 @title Gnus Manual
344
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @page
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
348 @insertcopying
349 @end titlepage
350
351
352 @node Top
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
354
355 @ifinfo
356
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
360 luck.
361
362 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
363 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.11.
364
365 @end ifinfo
366
367 @iftex
368
369 @iflatex
370 \tableofcontents
371 \gnuscleardoublepage
372 @end iflatex
373
374 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
375 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
376
377 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
378 being accused of plagiarism:
379
380 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
381 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
382 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
383 can even read news with it!
384
385 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
386 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
387 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
388 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
389 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
390 the program.
391
392 @end iftex
393
394 @menu
395 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
396 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
397 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
398 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
399 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
400 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
401 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
402 * Various:: General purpose settings.
403 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
404 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
405 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
406 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
407 * Key Index:: Key Index.
408
409 Other related manuals
410
411 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
412 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
413 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
414 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
415
416 @detailmenu
417 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
418
419 Starting Gnus
420
421 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
422 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
423 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
424 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
425 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
426 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
427 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
428 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
429 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
430 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
431 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
432
433 New Groups
434
435 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
436 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
437 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
438
439 Group Buffer
440
441 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
442 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
443 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
444 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
445 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
446 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
447 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
448 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
449 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
450 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
451 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
452 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
453 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
454 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
455 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
456 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
457 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
458
459 Group Buffer Format
460
461 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
462 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
463 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
464
465 Group Topics
466
467 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
468 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
469 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
470 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
471 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
472
473 Misc Group Stuff
474
475 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
476 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
477 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
478 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
479 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
480
481 Summary Buffer
482
483 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
484 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
485 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
486 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
487 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
488 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
489 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
490 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
491 * Threading:: How threads are made.
492 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
493 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
494 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
495 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
496 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
497 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
498 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
499 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
500 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
501 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
502 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
503 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
504 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
505 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
506 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
507 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
508 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
509 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
510 or reselecting the current group.
511 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
512 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
513 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
514 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
515
516 Summary Buffer Format
517
518 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
519 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
520 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
521 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
522
523 Choosing Articles
524
525 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
526 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
527
528 Reply, Followup and Post
529
530 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
531 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
532 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
533 * Canceling and Superseding::
534
535 Marking Articles
536
537 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
538 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
539 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
540 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
541 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
542 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
543
544 Threading
545
546 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
547 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
548
549 Customizing Threading
550
551 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
552 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
553 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
554 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
555
556 Decoding Articles
557
558 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
559 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
560 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
561 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
562 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
563 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
564
565 Decoding Variables
566
567 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
568 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
569 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
570
571 Article Treatment
572
573 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
574 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
575 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
576 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
577 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
578 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
579 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
580 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
581 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
582 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
583 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
584
585 Alternative Approaches
586
587 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
588 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
589
590 Various Summary Stuff
591
592 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
593 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
594 * Summary Generation Commands::
595 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
596
597 Article Buffer
598
599 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
600 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
601 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
602 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
603 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
604
605 Composing Messages
606
607 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
608 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
609 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
610 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
611 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
612 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
613 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
614 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
615 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
616
617 Select Methods
618
619 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
620 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
621 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
622 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
623 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
624 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
625 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
626 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
627 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
628
629 Server Buffer
630
631 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
632 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
633 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
634 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
635 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
636 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
637 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
638
639 Getting News
640
641 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
642 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
643
644 @acronym{NNTP}
645
646 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
647 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
648 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
649
650 Getting Mail
651
652 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
653 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
654 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
655 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
656 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
657 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
658 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
659 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
660 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
661 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
662 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
663 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
664 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
665
666 Mail Sources
667
668 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
669 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
670 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
671
672 Choosing a Mail Back End
673
674 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
675 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
676 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
677 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
678 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
679 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
680 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
681
682 Browsing the Web
683
684 * Archiving Mail::
685 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
686 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
687 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
688 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
689 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
690 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
691
692 @acronym{IMAP}
693
694 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
695 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
696 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
697 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
698 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
699 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
700
701 Other Sources
702
703 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
704 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
705 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
706 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
707 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
708
709 Document Groups
710
711 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
712
713 SOUP
714
715 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
716 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
717 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
718
719 Combined Groups
720
721 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
722 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
723
724 Email Based Diary
725
726 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
727 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
728 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
729
730 The NNDiary Back End
731
732 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
733 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
734 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
735
736 The Gnus Diary Library
737
738 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
739 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
740 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
741 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
742
743 Gnus Unplugged
744
745 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
746 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
747 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
748 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
749 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
750 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
751 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
752 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
753 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
754 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
755 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
756 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
757 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
758
759 Agent Categories
760
761 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
762 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
763 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
764
765 Agent Commands
766
767 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
768 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
769 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
770
771 Scoring
772
773 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
774 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
775 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
776 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
777 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
778 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
779 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
780 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
781 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
782 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
783 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
784 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
785 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
786 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
787 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
788 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
789 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
790
791 GroupLens
792
793 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
794 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
795 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
796 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
797
798 Advanced Scoring
799
800 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
801 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
802 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
803
804 Various
805
806 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
807 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
808 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
809 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
810 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
811 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
812 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
813 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
814 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
815 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
816 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
817 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
818 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
819 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
820 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
821 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
822 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
823 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
824 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
825 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
826 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
827
828 Formatting Variables
829
830 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
831 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
832 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
833 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
834 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
835 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
836 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
837 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
838
839 Image Enhancements
840
841 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
842 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
843 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
844 meant to be shown.
845 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
846 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
847
848 Thwarting Email Spam
849
850 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
851 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
852 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
853 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
854
855 Spam Package
856
857 * Spam Package Introduction::
858 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
859 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
860 * Spam and Ham Processors::
861 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
862 * Spam Back Ends::
863 * Extending the Spam package::
864 * Spam Statistics Package::
865
866 Spam Statistics Package
867
868 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
869 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
870 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
871
872 Appendices
873
874 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
875 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
876 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
877 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
878 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
879 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
880 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
881 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
882 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
883
884 History
885
886 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
887 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
888 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
889 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
890 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
891 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
892 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
893 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
894 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
895
896 New Features
897
898 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
899 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
900 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
901 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
902 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
903 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
904
905 Customization
906
907 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
908 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
909 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
910 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
911
912 Gnus Reference Guide
913
914 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
915 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
916 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
917 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
918 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
919 * Group Info:: The group info format.
920 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
921 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
922 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
923
924 Back End Interface
925
926 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
927 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
928 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
929 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
930 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
931 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
932
933 Various File Formats
934
935 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
936 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
937
938 Emacs for Heathens
939
940 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
941 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
942
943 @end detailmenu
944 @end menu
945
946 @node Starting Up
947 @chapter Starting Gnus
948 @cindex starting up
949
950 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
951 Heathens} first.
952
953 @kindex M-x gnus
954 @findex gnus
955 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
956 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
957 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
958 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
959 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
960 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
961
962 @findex gnus-other-frame
963 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
964 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
965 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
966
967 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
968 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
969 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
970
971 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
972 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
973
974 @menu
975 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
976 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
977 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
978 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
979 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
980 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
981 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
982 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
983 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
984 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
985 @end menu
986
987
988 @node Finding the News
989 @section Finding the News
990 @cindex finding news
991
992 @vindex gnus-select-method
993 @c @head
994 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
995 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
996 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
997 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
998 foreign groups.
999
1000 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1001 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1002
1003 @lisp
1004 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1005 @end lisp
1006
1007 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1008
1009 @lisp
1010 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1011 @end lisp
1012
1013 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1014 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1015 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1016 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1017
1018 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1019 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1020 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1021 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1022 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1023 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1024 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1025 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1026 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1027
1028 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1029 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1030 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1031 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1032
1033 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1034 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1035 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1036 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1037 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1038 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1039 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1040 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1041 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1042 server.)
1043
1044 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1045 @kindex B (Group)
1046 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1047 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1048 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1049 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1050 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1051 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1052
1053 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1054 @c @head
1055 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1056 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1057 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1058 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1059 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1060 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1061 groups are.
1062
1063 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1064 you would typically set this variable to
1065
1066 @lisp
1067 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1068 @end lisp
1069
1070
1071 @node The First Time
1072 @section The First Time
1073 @cindex first time usage
1074
1075 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1076 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1077
1078 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1079 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1080 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1081 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1082 something useful.
1083
1084 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1085 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1086 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1087
1088 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1089 help you with most common problems.
1090
1091 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1092 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1093 special.
1094
1095
1096 @node The Server is Down
1097 @section The Server is Down
1098 @cindex server errors
1099
1100 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1101 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1102 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1103
1104 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1105 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1106 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1107 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1108 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1109 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1110 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1111
1112 @findex gnus-no-server
1113 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1114 @c @head
1115 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1116 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1117 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1118 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1119 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1120 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1121 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1122
1123
1124 @node Slave Gnusae
1125 @section Slave Gnusae
1126 @cindex slave
1127
1128 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1129 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1130 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1131 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1132
1133 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1134 @file{.newsrc} file.
1135
1136 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1137 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1138 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1139 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1140 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1141 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1142 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1143
1144 @findex gnus-slave
1145 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1146 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1147 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1148 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1149 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1150 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1151 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1152 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1153
1154 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1155 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1156
1157 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1158 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1159 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1160 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1161 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1162
1163
1164
1165 @node New Groups
1166 @section New Groups
1167 @cindex new groups
1168 @cindex subscription
1169
1170 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1171 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1172 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1173 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1174 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1175 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1176 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1177 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1178 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1179
1180 @menu
1181 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1182 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1183 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1184 @end menu
1185
1186
1187 @node Checking New Groups
1188 @subsection Checking New Groups
1189
1190 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1191 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1192 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1193 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1194 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1195 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1196 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1197 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1198 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1199 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1200
1201 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1202 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1203 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1204 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1205 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1206 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1207 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1208 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1209 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1210 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1211 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1212
1213 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1214 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1215 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1216 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1217 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1218 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1219
1220
1221 @node Subscription Methods
1222 @subsection Subscription Methods
1223
1224 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1225 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1226 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1227
1228 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1229 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1230
1231 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1232
1233 @table @code
1234
1235 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1236 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1237 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1238 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1239 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1240
1241 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1242 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1243 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1244 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1245
1246 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1247 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1248 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1249
1250 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1251 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1252 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1253 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1254 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1255 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1256 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1257 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1258 up. Or something like that.
1259
1260 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1261 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1262 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1263 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1264 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1265
1266 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1267 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1268 Kill all new groups.
1269
1270 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1271 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1272 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1273 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1274 topic parameter that looks like
1275
1276 @example
1277 "nnslashdot"
1278 @end example
1279
1280 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1281 that topic.
1282
1283 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1284 top-level topic.
1285
1286 @end table
1287
1288 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1289 A closely related variable is
1290 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1291 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1292 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1293 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1294 hierarchy or not.
1295
1296 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1297 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1298 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1299 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1300
1301
1302 @node Filtering New Groups
1303 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1304
1305 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1306 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1307 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1308
1309 @example
1310 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1311 @end example
1312
1313 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1314 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1315 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1316 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1317 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1318 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1319 subscribing these groups.
1320 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1321 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1322
1323 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1324 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1325 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1326 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1327 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1328 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1329 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1330 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1331
1332 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1333 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1334 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1335 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1336 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1337 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1338 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1339 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1340 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1341 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1342 @code{nil}.
1343
1344 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1345 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1346
1347
1348 @node Changing Servers
1349 @section Changing Servers
1350 @cindex changing servers
1351
1352 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1353 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1354 very flaky and you want to use another.
1355
1356 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1357 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1358
1359 @emph{Wrong!}
1360
1361 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1362 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1363 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1364 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1365 worthless.
1366
1367 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1368 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1369 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1370 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1371
1372 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1373 @findex gnus-change-server
1374 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1375 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1376 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1377 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1378 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1379
1380 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1381 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1382 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1383 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1384 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1385
1386 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1387 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1388 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1389 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1390 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1391 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1392
1393 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1394 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1395 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1396 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1397
1398 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1399 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1400 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1401 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1402 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1403 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1404 cache for all groups).
1405
1406
1407 @node Startup Files
1408 @section Startup Files
1409 @cindex startup files
1410 @cindex .newsrc
1411 @cindex .newsrc.el
1412 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1413
1414 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1415 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1416 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1417 read.
1418
1419 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1420 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1421 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1422 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1423 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1424 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1425 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1426
1427 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1428 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1429 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1430 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1431 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1432 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1433
1434 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1435 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1436 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1437 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1438 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1439 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1440 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1441 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1442 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1443 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1444 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1445 news reader.
1446
1447 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1448 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1449 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1450 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1451 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1452 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1453 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1454 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1455 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1456 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1457 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1458 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1459
1460 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1461 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1462 @vindex version-control
1463 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1464 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1465 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1466 If you want version control for this file, set
1467 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1468 @code{version-control} variable.
1469
1470 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1471 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1472 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1473 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1474 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1475 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1476 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1477 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1478 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1479 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1480
1481 @lisp
1482 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1483 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1484
1485 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1486 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1487 @end lisp
1488
1489 @vindex gnus-init-file
1490 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1491 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1492 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1493 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1494 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1495 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1496 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1497 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1498 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1499 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1500 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1501 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1502 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1503
1504
1505 @node Auto Save
1506 @section Auto Save
1507 @cindex dribble file
1508 @cindex auto-save
1509
1510 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1511 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1512 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1513 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1514 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1515 this file.
1516
1517 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1518 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1519 saved.
1520
1521 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1522 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1523 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1524
1525 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1526 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1527 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1528 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1529 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1530 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1531
1532 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1533 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1534 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1535
1536
1537 @node The Active File
1538 @section The Active File
1539 @cindex active file
1540 @cindex ignored groups
1541
1542 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1543 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1544 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1545
1546 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1547 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1548 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1549 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1550 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1551 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1552 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1553
1554 @c This variable is
1555 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1556 @c if you set it to anything else.
1557
1558 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1559 @c @head
1560 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1561 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1562 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1563
1564 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1565 you actually subscribe to.
1566
1567 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1568 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1569 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1570 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1571
1572 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1573 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1574 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1575 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1576 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1577 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1578
1579 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1580 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1581 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1582 variable.
1583
1584 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1585 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1586 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1587 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1588 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1589 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1590
1591 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1592 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1593
1594 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1595 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1596
1597 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1598 secondary select methods.
1599
1600
1601 @node Startup Variables
1602 @section Startup Variables
1603
1604 @table @code
1605
1606 @item gnus-load-hook
1607 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1608 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1609 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1610 times you start Gnus.
1611
1612 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1613 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1614 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1615
1616 @item gnus-startup-hook
1617 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1618 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1619
1620 @item gnus-started-hook
1621 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1622 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1623 successfully.
1624
1625 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1626 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1627 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1628 generating the group buffer.
1629
1630 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1631 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1632 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1633 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1634 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1635 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1636 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1637 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1638
1639 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1640 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1641 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1642 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1643 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1644 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1645
1646 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1647 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1648 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1649
1650 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1651 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1652 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1653
1654 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1655 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1656 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1657 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1658
1659 @end table
1660
1661
1662 @node Group Buffer
1663 @chapter Group Buffer
1664 @cindex group buffer
1665
1666 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1667 @c
1668 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1669 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1670 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1671 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1672 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1673 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1674 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1675 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1676 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1677 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1678 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1679 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1680 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1681 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1682 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1683 @c human rights at 9...
1684
1685
1686 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1687 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1688 long as Gnus is active.
1689
1690 @iftex
1691 @iflatex
1692 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1693 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1694 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1695 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1696 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1697 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1698 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1699 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1700 }
1701 @end iflatex
1702 @end iftex
1703
1704 @menu
1705 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1706 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1707 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1708 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1709 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1710 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1711 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1712 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1713 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1714 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1715 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1716 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1717 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1718 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1719 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1720 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1721 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1722 @end menu
1723
1724
1725 @node Group Buffer Format
1726 @section Group Buffer Format
1727
1728 @menu
1729 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1730 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1731 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1732 @end menu
1733
1734 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1735 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1736 available in Emacs.
1737
1738 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1739 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1740 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1741 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1742 Emacs version.
1743
1744 @node Group Line Specification
1745 @subsection Group Line Specification
1746 @cindex group buffer format
1747
1748 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1749 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1750
1751 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1752
1753 @example
1754 25: news.announce.newusers
1755 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1756 @end example
1757
1758 Quite simple, huh?
1759
1760 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1761 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1762 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1763 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1764
1765 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1766 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1767 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1768 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1769 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1770 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1771
1772 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1773
1774 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1775 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1776 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1777 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1778 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1779
1780 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1781 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1782 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1783
1784 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1785
1786 @table @samp
1787
1788 @item M
1789 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1790
1791 @item S
1792 Whether the group is subscribed.
1793
1794 @item L
1795 Level of subscribedness.
1796
1797 @item N
1798 Number of unread articles.
1799
1800 @item I
1801 Number of dormant articles.
1802
1803 @item T
1804 Number of ticked articles.
1805
1806 @item R
1807 Number of read articles.
1808
1809 @item U
1810 Number of unseen articles.
1811
1812 @item t
1813 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1814 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1815
1816 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1817 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1818 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1819 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1820 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1821 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1822 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1823 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1824
1825 @item y
1826 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1827
1828 @item i
1829 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1830
1831 @item g
1832 Full group name.
1833
1834 @item G
1835 Group name.
1836
1837 @item C
1838 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1839 comment element in the group parameters.
1840
1841 @item D
1842 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1843 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1844 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1845 command.
1846
1847 @item o
1848 @samp{m} if moderated.
1849
1850 @item O
1851 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1852
1853 @item s
1854 Select method.
1855
1856 @item B
1857 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1858
1859 @item n
1860 Select from where.
1861
1862 @item z
1863 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1864 used.
1865
1866 @item P
1867 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1868
1869 @item c
1870 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1871 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1872 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1873 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1874 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1875
1876 @item m
1877 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1878 @cindex %
1879 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1880 the group lately.
1881
1882 @item p
1883 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1884
1885 @item d
1886 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1887 Timestamp}).
1888
1889 @item u
1890 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1891 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1892 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1893 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1894 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1895 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1896 specifier.
1897 @end table
1898
1899 @cindex *
1900 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1901 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1902 group, or a bogus native group.
1903
1904
1905 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1906 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1907 @cindex group mode line
1908
1909 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1910 The mode line can be changed by setting
1911 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1912 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1913
1914 @table @samp
1915 @item S
1916 The native news server.
1917 @item M
1918 The native select method.
1919 @end table
1920
1921
1922 @node Group Highlighting
1923 @subsection Group Highlighting
1924 @cindex highlighting
1925 @cindex group highlighting
1926
1927 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1928 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1929 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1930 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1931 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1932
1933 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1934 background is dark:
1935
1936 @lisp
1937 (cond (window-system
1938 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1939 (defface my-group-face-1
1940 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1941 (defface my-group-face-2
1942 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1943 "Second group face")
1944 (defface my-group-face-3
1945 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1946 (defface my-group-face-4
1947 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1948 (defface my-group-face-5
1949 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1950
1951 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1952 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1953 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1954 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1955 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1956 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1957 @end lisp
1958
1959 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1960
1961 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1962 include:
1963
1964 @table @code
1965 @item group
1966 The group name.
1967 @item unread
1968 The number of unread articles in the group.
1969 @item method
1970 The select method.
1971 @item mailp
1972 Whether the group is a mail group.
1973 @item level
1974 The level of the group.
1975 @item score
1976 The score of the group.
1977 @item ticked
1978 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1979 @item total
1980 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1981 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1982 @item topic
1983 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1984 topic being inserted.
1985 @end table
1986
1987 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1988 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1989 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1990
1991 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1992 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1993 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1994 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1995 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1996
1997
1998 @node Group Maneuvering
1999 @section Group Maneuvering
2000 @cindex group movement
2001
2002 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
2003 expected, hopefully.
2004
2005 @table @kbd
2006
2007 @item n
2008 @kindex n (Group)
2009 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
2010 Go to the next group that has unread articles
2011 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
2012
2013 @item p
2014 @itemx DEL
2015 @kindex DEL (Group)
2016 @kindex p (Group)
2017 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2018 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2019 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2020
2021 @item N
2022 @kindex N (Group)
2023 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2024 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2025
2026 @item P
2027 @kindex P (Group)
2028 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2029 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2030
2031 @item M-n
2032 @kindex M-n (Group)
2033 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2034 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2035 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2036
2037 @item M-p
2038 @kindex M-p (Group)
2039 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2040 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2041 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2042 @end table
2043
2044 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2045
2046 @table @kbd
2047
2048 @item j
2049 @kindex j (Group)
2050 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2051 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2052 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2053 like living groups.
2054
2055 @item ,
2056 @kindex , (Group)
2057 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2058 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2059 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2060
2061 @item .
2062 @kindex . (Group)
2063 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2064 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2065 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2066 @end table
2067
2068 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2069 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2070 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2071 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2072 is @code{t}.
2073
2074
2075 @node Selecting a Group
2076 @section Selecting a Group
2077 @cindex group selection
2078
2079 @table @kbd
2080
2081 @item SPACE
2082 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2083 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2084 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2085 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2086 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2087 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2088 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2089 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2090 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2091 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2092
2093 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2094 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2095 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2096
2097 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2098 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2099 ones.
2100
2101 @item RET
2102 @kindex RET (Group)
2103 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2104 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2105 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2106 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2107 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2108 entry.
2109
2110 @item M-RET
2111 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2112 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2113 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2114 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2115 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2116 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2117 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2118 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2119 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2120 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2121
2122 @item M-SPACE
2123 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2124 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2125 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2126 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2127 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2128
2129 @item C-M-RET
2130 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2131 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2132 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2133 doing any processing of its contents
2134 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2135 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2136 manner will have no permanent effects.
2137
2138 @end table
2139
2140 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2141 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2142 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2143 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2144 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2145 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2146 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2147 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2148 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2149 most recently will be fetched.
2150
2151 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2152 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2153 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2154 newsgroups.
2155
2156 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2157 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2158 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2159 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2160 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2161 are actually only the articles 1-10 and 29999900-30000000, Gnus doesn't
2162 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2163 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2164 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2165 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2166 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2167 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2168 get only the articles 29990001-30000000 (if the latest article number is
2169 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2170 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2171 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2172 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2173
2174 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2175 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2176 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2177 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2178 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2179 Which article this is is controlled by the
2180 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2181 variable are:
2182
2183 @table @code
2184
2185 @item unread
2186 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2187
2188 @item first
2189 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2190
2191 @item unseen
2192 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2193
2194 @item unseen-or-unread
2195 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2196 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2197 unread article.
2198
2199 @item best
2200 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2201
2202 @end table
2203
2204 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2205 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2206
2207 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2208 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2209 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2210 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2211 selected.
2212
2213
2214 @node Subscription Commands
2215 @section Subscription Commands
2216 @cindex subscription
2217
2218 @table @kbd
2219
2220 @item S t
2221 @itemx u
2222 @kindex S t (Group)
2223 @kindex u (Group)
2224 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2225 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2226 Toggle subscription to the current group
2227 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2228
2229 @item S s
2230 @itemx U
2231 @kindex S s (Group)
2232 @kindex U (Group)
2233 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2234 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2235 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2236 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2237
2238 @item S k
2239 @itemx C-k
2240 @kindex S k (Group)
2241 @kindex C-k (Group)
2242 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2243 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2244 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2245
2246 @item S y
2247 @itemx C-y
2248 @kindex S y (Group)
2249 @kindex C-y (Group)
2250 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2251 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2252
2253 @item C-x C-t
2254 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2255 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2256 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2257 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2258 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2259
2260 @item S w
2261 @itemx C-w
2262 @kindex S w (Group)
2263 @kindex C-w (Group)
2264 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2265 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2266
2267 @item S z
2268 @kindex S z (Group)
2269 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2270 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2271
2272 @item S C-k
2273 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2274 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2275 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2276 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2277 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2278 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2279 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2280 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2281 @file{.newsrc} file.
2282
2283 @end table
2284
2285 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2286
2287
2288 @node Group Data
2289 @section Group Data
2290
2291 @table @kbd
2292
2293 @item c
2294 @kindex c (Group)
2295 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2296 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2297 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2298 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2299 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2300 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2301 the group buffer.
2302
2303 @item C
2304 @kindex C (Group)
2305 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2306 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2307 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2308
2309 @item M-c
2310 @kindex M-c (Group)
2311 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2312 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2313 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2314
2315 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2316 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2317 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2318 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2319 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2320 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2321 caution.
2322
2323 @end table
2324
2325
2326 @node Group Levels
2327 @section Group Levels
2328 @cindex group level
2329 @cindex level
2330
2331 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2332 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2333 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2334 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2335 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2336
2337 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2338
2339 @table @kbd
2340
2341 @item S l
2342 @kindex S l (Group)
2343 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2344 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2345 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2346 prompted for a level.
2347 @end table
2348
2349 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2350 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2351 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2352 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2353 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2354 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2355 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2356 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2357 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2358 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2359 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2360 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2361 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2362 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2363 reasons of efficiency.
2364
2365 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2366 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2367
2368 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2369 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2370 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2371 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2372 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2373 groups are hidden, in a way.
2374
2375 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2376 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2377 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2378 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2379 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2380 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2381
2382 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2383 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2384 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2385 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2386 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2387 list of killed groups.)
2388
2389 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2390 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2391 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2392
2393 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2394 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2395 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2396 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2397 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2398 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2399 relevant valid ranges.
2400
2401 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2402 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2403 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2404 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2405 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2406 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2407 rest.
2408
2409 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2410 one with the best level.
2411
2412 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2413 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2414 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2415 by default.
2416
2417 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2418 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2419 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2420 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2421 listed.
2422
2423 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2424 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2425 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2426 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2427
2428 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2429 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2430 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2431 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2432 to 5. The default is 6.
2433
2434
2435 @node Group Score
2436 @section Group Score
2437 @cindex group score
2438 @cindex group rank
2439 @cindex rank
2440
2441 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2442 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2443 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2444 reason?
2445
2446 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2447 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2448 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2449 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2450 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2451 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2452 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2453 least significant part.))
2454
2455 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2456 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2457 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2458 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2459 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2460 action after each summary exit, you can add
2461 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2462 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2463 slow things down somewhat.
2464
2465
2466 @node Marking Groups
2467 @section Marking Groups
2468 @cindex marking groups
2469
2470 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2471 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2472 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2473 bidding on those groups.
2474
2475 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2476 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2477 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2478
2479 @table @kbd
2480
2481 @item #
2482 @kindex # (Group)
2483 @itemx M m
2484 @kindex M m (Group)
2485 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2486 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2487
2488 @item M-#
2489 @kindex M-# (Group)
2490 @itemx M u
2491 @kindex M u (Group)
2492 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2493 Remove the mark from the current group
2494 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2495
2496 @item M U
2497 @kindex M U (Group)
2498 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2499 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2500
2501 @item M w
2502 @kindex M w (Group)
2503 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2504 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2505
2506 @item M b
2507 @kindex M b (Group)
2508 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2509 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2510
2511 @item M r
2512 @kindex M r (Group)
2513 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2514 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2515 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2516 @end table
2517
2518 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2519
2520 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2521 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2522 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2523 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2524 the command to be executed.
2525
2526
2527 @node Foreign Groups
2528 @section Foreign Groups
2529 @cindex foreign groups
2530
2531 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2532 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2533 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2534 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2535 consulted.
2536
2537 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2538 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2539 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2540
2541 @table @kbd
2542
2543 @item G m
2544 @kindex G m (Group)
2545 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2546 @cindex making groups
2547 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2548 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2549 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2550
2551 @item G M
2552 @kindex G M (Group)
2553 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2554 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2555 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2556
2557 @item G r
2558 @kindex G r (Group)
2559 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2560 @cindex renaming groups
2561 Rename the current group to something else
2562 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2563 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2564 on some back ends.
2565
2566 @item G c
2567 @kindex G c (Group)
2568 @cindex customizing
2569 @findex gnus-group-customize
2570 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2571
2572 @item G e
2573 @kindex G e (Group)
2574 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2575 @cindex renaming groups
2576 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2577 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2578
2579 @item G p
2580 @kindex G p (Group)
2581 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2582 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2583 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2584
2585 @item G E
2586 @kindex G E (Group)
2587 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2588 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2589 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2590
2591 @item G d
2592 @kindex G d (Group)
2593 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2594 @cindex nndir
2595 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2596 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2597
2598 @item G h
2599 @kindex G h (Group)
2600 @cindex help group
2601 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2602 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2603
2604 @item G a
2605 @kindex G a (Group)
2606 @cindex (ding) archive
2607 @cindex archive group
2608 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2609 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2610 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2611 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2612 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2613 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2614 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2615
2616 @item G k
2617 @kindex G k (Group)
2618 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2619 @cindex nnkiboze
2620 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2621 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2622 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2623 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2624
2625 @item G D
2626 @kindex G D (Group)
2627 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2628 @cindex nneething
2629 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2630 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2631 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2632
2633 @item G f
2634 @kindex G f (Group)
2635 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2636 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2637 @cindex nndoc
2638 Make a group based on some file or other
2639 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2640 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2641 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2642 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2643 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2644 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2645 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2646 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2647 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2648
2649 @item G u
2650 @kindex G u (Group)
2651 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2652 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2653 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2654 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2655
2656 @item G w
2657 @kindex G w (Group)
2658 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2659 @cindex Google
2660 @cindex nnweb
2661 @cindex gmane
2662 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2663 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2664 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2665 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2666 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2667 @xref{Web Searches}.
2668
2669 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2670 to a particular group by using a match string like
2671 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2672
2673 @item G R
2674 @kindex G R (Group)
2675 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2676 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2677 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2678 @xref{RSS}.
2679
2680 @item G DEL
2681 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2682 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2683 This function will delete the current group
2684 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2685 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2686 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2687 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2688 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2689
2690 @item G V
2691 @kindex G V (Group)
2692 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2693 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2694 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2695
2696 @item G v
2697 @kindex G v (Group)
2698 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2699 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2700 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2701 @end table
2702
2703 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2704 methods.
2705
2706 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2707 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2708 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2709 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2710 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2711 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2712 newsgroups.
2713
2714
2715 @node Group Parameters
2716 @section Group Parameters
2717 @cindex group parameters
2718
2719 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2720 Here's an example group parameter list:
2721
2722 @example
2723 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2724 (auto-expire . t))
2725 @end example
2726
2727 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2728 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2729 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2730 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2731
2732 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2733 is an alist of regexps and values.
2734
2735 The following group parameters can be used:
2736
2737 @table @code
2738 @item to-address
2739 @cindex to-address
2740 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2741
2742 @example
2743 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2744 @end example
2745
2746 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2747 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2748 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2749 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2750 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2751
2752 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2753 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2754 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2755 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2756 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2757 list address instead.
2758
2759 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2760
2761 @item to-list
2762 @cindex to-list
2763 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2764
2765 @example
2766 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2767 @end example
2768
2769 It is totally ignored
2770 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2771 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2772
2773 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2774 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2775 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2776 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2777 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2778
2779 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2780 @cindex mail list groups
2781 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2782 entering summary buffer.
2783
2784 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2785
2786 @anchor{subscribed}
2787 @item subscribed
2788 @cindex subscribed
2789 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2790 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2791 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2792 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2793 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2794 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2795 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2796 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2797
2798 @lisp
2799 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2800 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2801 @end lisp
2802
2803 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2804 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2805
2806 @item visible
2807 @cindex visible
2808 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2809 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2810 of whether it has any unread articles.
2811
2812 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2813 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2814
2815 @item broken-reply-to
2816 @cindex broken-reply-to
2817 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2818 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2819 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2820 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2821 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2822 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2823
2824 @item to-group
2825 @cindex to-group
2826 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2827 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2828
2829 @item newsgroup
2830 @cindex newsgroup
2831 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2832 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2833 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2834 news group.
2835
2836 @item gcc-self
2837 @cindex gcc-self
2838 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2839 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2840 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2841 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2842 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2843 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2844 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2845
2846 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2847 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2848 doesn't accept articles.
2849
2850 @item auto-expire
2851 @cindex auto-expire
2852 @cindex expiring mail
2853 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2854 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2855 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2856
2857 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2858
2859 @item total-expire
2860 @cindex total-expire
2861 @cindex expiring mail
2862 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2863 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2864 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2865 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2866 expiry.
2867
2868 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2869
2870 @item expiry-wait
2871 @cindex expiry-wait
2872 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2873 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2874 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2875 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2876 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2877 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2878 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2879
2880 @item expiry-target
2881 @cindex expiry-target
2882 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2883 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2884
2885 @item score-file
2886 @cindex score file group parameter
2887 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2888 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2889 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2890
2891 @item adapt-file
2892 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2893 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2894 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2895 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2896
2897 @item admin-address
2898 @cindex admin-address
2899 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2900 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2901 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2902 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2903
2904 @item display
2905 @cindex display
2906 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2907 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2908
2909 @table @code
2910 @item all
2911 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2912
2913 @item an integer
2914 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2915 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2916
2917 @item default
2918 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2919 ticked articles.
2920
2921 @item an array
2922 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2923
2924 Here are some examples:
2925
2926 @table @code
2927 @item [unread]
2928 Display only unread articles.
2929
2930 @item [not expire]
2931 Display everything except expirable articles.
2932
2933 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2934 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2935 responded to.
2936 @end table
2937
2938 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2939 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2940 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2941 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2942 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2943
2944 @end table
2945
2946 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2947 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2948 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2949
2950 @item comment
2951 @cindex comment
2952 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2953 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2954 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2955
2956 @item charset
2957 @cindex charset
2958 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2959 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2960 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2961
2962 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2963
2964 @item ignored-charsets
2965 @cindex ignored-charset
2966 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2967 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2968 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2969
2970 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2971
2972 @item posting-style
2973 @cindex posting-style
2974 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2975 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2976 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2977 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2978 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2979
2980 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2981 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2982 like this in the group parameters:
2983
2984 @example
2985 (posting-style
2986 (name "Funky Name")
2987 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2988 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2989 @end example
2990
2991 @item post-method
2992 @cindex post-method
2993 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2994 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2995
2996 @item banner
2997 @cindex banner
2998 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2999 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3000 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3001 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3002 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3003
3004 @item sieve
3005 @cindex sieve
3006 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3007 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3008 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3009 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3010
3011 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3012 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3013 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3014 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3015
3016 @example
3017 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
3018 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
3019 @}
3020 @end example
3021
3022 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3023 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3024
3025 @item (agent parameters)
3026 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
3027 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3028 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3029 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3030 minimize the configuration effort.
3031
3032 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3033 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3034 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3035 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3036 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3037 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3038 @code{eval}ed there.
3039
3040 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
3041 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3042 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3043 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3044 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3045 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3046 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3047 @file{~/.gnus} file:
3048
3049 @lisp
3050 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3051 @end lisp
3052
3053 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3054 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3055 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3056
3057 @example
3058 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3059 @end example
3060
3061 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3062 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3063 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3064 into the group parameters for the group.
3065
3066 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3067 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3068 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3069 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3070 @code{(ding)} form.
3071
3072 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3073 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3074 following is added to a group parameter
3075
3076 @lisp
3077 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3078 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3079 @end lisp
3080
3081 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3082 expired.
3083
3084 @end table
3085
3086 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3087 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3088 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3089 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3090 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3091
3092 @vindex gnus-parameters
3093 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3094 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3095 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3096 For example:
3097
3098 @lisp
3099 (setq gnus-parameters
3100 '(("mail\\..*"
3101 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3102 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3103 (gnus-summary-line-format
3104 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3105 (gcc-self . t)
3106 (display . all))
3107
3108 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3109 (to-group . "\\1"))
3110
3111 ("mail\\.me"
3112 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3113
3114 ("list\\..*"
3115 (total-expire . t)
3116 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3117 @end lisp
3118
3119 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3120 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3121
3122 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3123 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3124 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3125 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3126 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3127 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3128 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3129 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3130 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3131 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3132 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3133 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3134
3135
3136 @node Listing Groups
3137 @section Listing Groups
3138 @cindex group listing
3139
3140 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3141
3142 @table @kbd
3143
3144 @item l
3145 @itemx A s
3146 @kindex A s (Group)
3147 @kindex l (Group)
3148 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3149 List all groups that have unread articles
3150 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3151 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3152 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3153 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3154 groups).
3155
3156 @item L
3157 @itemx A u
3158 @kindex A u (Group)
3159 @kindex L (Group)
3160 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3161 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3162 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3163 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3164 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3165 unsubscribed groups).
3166
3167 @item A l
3168 @kindex A l (Group)
3169 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3170 List all unread groups on a specific level
3171 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3172 with no unread articles.
3173
3174 @item A k
3175 @kindex A k (Group)
3176 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3177 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3178 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3179 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3180 from the server.
3181
3182 @item A z
3183 @kindex A z (Group)
3184 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3185 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3186
3187 @item A m
3188 @kindex A m (Group)
3189 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3190 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3191 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3192
3193 @item A M
3194 @kindex A M (Group)
3195 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3196 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3197
3198 @item A A
3199 @kindex A A (Group)
3200 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3201 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3202 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3203 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3204 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3205 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3206 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3207 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3208
3209 @item A a
3210 @kindex A a (Group)
3211 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3212 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3213 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3214
3215 @item A d
3216 @kindex A d (Group)
3217 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3218 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3219 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3220
3221 @item A c
3222 @kindex A c (Group)
3223 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3224 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3225
3226 @item A ?
3227 @kindex A ? (Group)
3228 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3229 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3230
3231 @item A /
3232 @kindex A / (Group)
3233 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3234 List groups limited within the current selection
3235 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3236
3237 @item A f
3238 @kindex A f (Group)
3239 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3240 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3241
3242 @item A p
3243 @kindex A p (Group)
3244 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3245 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3246
3247 @end table
3248
3249 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3250 @cindex visible group parameter
3251 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3252 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3253 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3254 get the same effect.
3255
3256 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3257 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3258 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3259 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3260 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3261
3262
3263 @node Sorting Groups
3264 @section Sorting Groups
3265 @cindex sorting groups
3266
3267 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3268 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3269 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3270 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3271 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3272 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3273 include:
3274
3275 @table @code
3276
3277 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3278 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3279 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3280
3281 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3282 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3283 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3284
3285 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3286 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3287 Sort by group level.
3288
3289 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3290 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3291 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3292
3293 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3294 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3295 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3296 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3297
3298 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3299 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3300 Sort by number of unread articles.
3301
3302 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3303 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3304 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3305
3306 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3307 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3308 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3309
3310
3311 @end table
3312
3313 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3314 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3315 the last one.
3316
3317
3318 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3319 some sorting criteria:
3320
3321 @table @kbd
3322 @item G S a
3323 @kindex G S a (Group)
3324 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3325 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3326 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3327
3328 @item G S u
3329 @kindex G S u (Group)
3330 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3331 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3332 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3333
3334 @item G S l
3335 @kindex G S l (Group)
3336 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3337 Sort the group buffer by group level
3338 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3339
3340 @item G S v
3341 @kindex G S v (Group)
3342 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3343 Sort the group buffer by group score
3344 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3345
3346 @item G S r
3347 @kindex G S r (Group)
3348 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3349 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3350 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3351
3352 @item G S m
3353 @kindex G S m (Group)
3354 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3355 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3356 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3357
3358 @item G S n
3359 @kindex G S n (Group)
3360 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3361 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3362 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3363
3364 @end table
3365
3366 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3367 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3368
3369 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3370 commands will sort in reverse order.
3371
3372 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3373
3374 @table @kbd
3375 @item G P a
3376 @kindex G P a (Group)
3377 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3378 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3379 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3380
3381 @item G P u
3382 @kindex G P u (Group)
3383 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3384 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3385 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3386
3387 @item G P l
3388 @kindex G P l (Group)
3389 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3390 Sort the groups by group level
3391 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3392
3393 @item G P v
3394 @kindex G P v (Group)
3395 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3396 Sort the groups by group score
3397 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3398
3399 @item G P r
3400 @kindex G P r (Group)
3401 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3402 Sort the groups by group rank
3403 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3404
3405 @item G P m
3406 @kindex G P m (Group)
3407 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3408 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3409 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3410
3411 @item G P n
3412 @kindex G P n (Group)
3413 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3414 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3415 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3416
3417 @item G P s
3418 @kindex G P s (Group)
3419 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3420 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3421
3422 @end table
3423
3424 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3425 move groups around.
3426
3427
3428 @node Group Maintenance
3429 @section Group Maintenance
3430 @cindex bogus groups
3431
3432 @table @kbd
3433 @item b
3434 @kindex b (Group)
3435 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3436 Find bogus groups and delete them
3437 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3438
3439 @item F
3440 @kindex F (Group)
3441 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3442 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3443 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3444 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3445 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3446 zombies.
3447
3448 @item C-c C-x
3449 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3450 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3451 @cindex expiring mail
3452 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3453 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3454 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3455 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3456
3457 @item C-c C-M-x
3458 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3459 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3460 @cindex expiring mail
3461 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3462 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3463
3464 @end table
3465
3466
3467 @node Browse Foreign Server
3468 @section Browse Foreign Server
3469 @cindex foreign servers
3470 @cindex browsing servers
3471
3472 @table @kbd
3473 @item B
3474 @kindex B (Group)
3475 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3476 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3477 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3478 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3479 @end table
3480
3481 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3482 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3483 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3484 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3485
3486 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3487
3488 @table @kbd
3489 @item n
3490 @kindex n (Browse)
3491 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3492 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3493
3494 @item p
3495 @kindex p (Browse)
3496 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3497 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3498
3499 @item SPACE
3500 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3501 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3502 Enter the current group and display the first article
3503 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3504
3505 @item RET
3506 @kindex RET (Browse)
3507 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3508 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3509
3510 @item u
3511 @kindex u (Browse)
3512 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3513 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3514 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3515
3516 @item l
3517 @itemx q
3518 @kindex q (Browse)
3519 @kindex l (Browse)
3520 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3521 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3522
3523 @item d
3524 @kindex d (Browse)
3525 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3526 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3527
3528 @item ?
3529 @kindex ? (Browse)
3530 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3531 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3532 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3533 @end table
3534
3535
3536 @node Exiting Gnus
3537 @section Exiting Gnus
3538 @cindex exiting Gnus
3539
3540 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3541
3542 @table @kbd
3543 @item z
3544 @kindex z (Group)
3545 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3546 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3547 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3548 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3549
3550 @item q
3551 @kindex q (Group)
3552 @findex gnus-group-exit
3553 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3554 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3555
3556 @item Q
3557 @kindex Q (Group)
3558 @findex gnus-group-quit
3559 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3560 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3561 @end table
3562
3563 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3564 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3565 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3566 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3567 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3568 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3569 exiting Gnus.
3570
3571 Note:
3572
3573 @quotation
3574 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3575 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3576 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3577 plastic chair.
3578 @end quotation
3579
3580
3581 @node Group Topics
3582 @section Group Topics
3583 @cindex topics
3584
3585 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3586 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3587 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3588 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3589 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3590 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3591
3592 @iftex
3593 @iflatex
3594 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3595 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3596 }
3597 @end iflatex
3598 @end iftex
3599
3600 Here's an example:
3601
3602 @example
3603 Gnus
3604 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3605 3: comp.emacs
3606 2: alt.religion.emacs
3607 Naughty Emacs
3608 452: alt.sex.emacs
3609 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3610 Misc
3611 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3612 13: comp.sources.unix
3613 @end example
3614
3615 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3616 @kindex t (Group)
3617 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3618 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3619 is a toggling command.)
3620
3621 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3622 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3623 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3624 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3625 Hot and bothered?
3626
3627 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3628 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3629 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3630
3631 @lisp
3632 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3633 @end lisp
3634
3635 @menu
3636 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3637 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3638 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3639 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3640 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3641 @end menu
3642
3643
3644 @node Topic Commands
3645 @subsection Topic Commands
3646 @cindex topic commands
3647
3648 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3649 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3650 definitions slightly.
3651
3652 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3653 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3654 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3655 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3656 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3657 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3658
3659 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3660 the way you like.
3661
3662 @table @kbd
3663
3664 @item T n
3665 @kindex T n (Topic)
3666 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3667 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3668 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3669
3670 @item T TAB
3671 @itemx TAB
3672 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3673 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3674 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3675 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3676 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3677 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3678
3679 @item M-TAB
3680 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3681 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3682 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3683 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3684
3685 @end table
3686
3687 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3688 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3689 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3690 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3691
3692 @table @kbd
3693
3694 @item C-k
3695 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3696 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3697 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3698 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3699
3700 @item C-y
3701 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3702 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3703 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3704 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3705 before all groups.
3706
3707 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3708 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3709 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3710 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3711 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3712
3713 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3714 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3715
3716 @end table
3717
3718 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3719 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3720 key.
3721
3722 @table @kbd
3723
3724 @item RET
3725 @kindex RET (Topic)
3726 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3727 @itemx SPACE
3728 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3729 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3730 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3731 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3732 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3733 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3734
3735 @end table
3736
3737 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3738
3739 @table @kbd
3740
3741 @item T m
3742 @kindex T m (Topic)
3743 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3744 Move the current group to some other topic
3745 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3746 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3747
3748 @item T j
3749 @kindex T j (Topic)
3750 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3751 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3752
3753 @item T c
3754 @kindex T c (Topic)
3755 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3756 Copy the current group to some other topic
3757 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3758 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3759
3760 @item T h
3761 @kindex T h (Topic)
3762 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3763 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3764 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3765
3766 @item T s
3767 @kindex T s (Topic)
3768 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3769 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3770 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3771
3772 @item T D
3773 @kindex T D (Topic)
3774 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3775 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3776 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3777 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3778 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3779 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3780 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3781 topic.
3782
3783 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3784 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3785
3786 @item T M
3787 @kindex T M (Topic)
3788 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3789 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3790 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3791
3792 @item T C
3793 @kindex T C (Topic)
3794 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3795 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3796 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3797
3798 @item T H
3799 @kindex T H (Topic)
3800 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3801 Toggle hiding empty topics
3802 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3803
3804 @item T #
3805 @kindex T # (Topic)
3806 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3807 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3808 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3809 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3810
3811 @item T M-#
3812 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3813 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3814 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3815 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3816 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3817
3818 @item C-c C-x
3819 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3820 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3821 @cindex expiring mail
3822 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3823 expiry process (if any)
3824 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3825
3826 @item T r
3827 @kindex T r (Topic)
3828 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3829 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3830
3831 @item T DEL
3832 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3833 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3834 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3835
3836 @item A T
3837 @kindex A T (Topic)
3838 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3839 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3840 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3841
3842 @item T M-n
3843 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3844 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3845 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3846
3847 @item T M-p
3848 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3849 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3850 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3851
3852 @item G p
3853 @kindex G p (Topic)
3854 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3855 @cindex group parameters
3856 @cindex topic parameters
3857 @cindex parameters
3858 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3859 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3860
3861 @end table
3862
3863
3864 @node Topic Variables
3865 @subsection Topic Variables
3866 @cindex topic variables
3867
3868 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3869 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3870
3871 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3872 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3873 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3874 Valid elements are:
3875
3876 @table @samp
3877 @item i
3878 Indentation.
3879 @item n
3880 Topic name.
3881 @item v
3882 Visibility.
3883 @item l
3884 Level.
3885 @item g
3886 Number of groups in the topic.
3887 @item a
3888 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3889 @item A
3890 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3891 @end table
3892
3893 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3894 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3895 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3896 The default is 2.
3897
3898 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3899 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3900
3901 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3902 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3903 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3904
3905
3906 @node Topic Sorting
3907 @subsection Topic Sorting
3908 @cindex topic sorting
3909
3910 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3911 commands:
3912
3913
3914 @table @kbd
3915 @item T S a
3916 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3917 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3918 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3919 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3920
3921 @item T S u
3922 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3923 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3924 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3925 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3926
3927 @item T S l
3928 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3929 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3930 Sort the current topic by group level
3931 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3932
3933 @item T S v
3934 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3935 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3936 Sort the current topic by group score
3937 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3938
3939 @item T S r
3940 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3941 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3942 Sort the current topic by group rank
3943 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3944
3945 @item T S m
3946 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3947 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3948 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3949 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3950
3951 @item T S e
3952 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3953 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3954 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3955 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3956
3957 @item T S s
3958 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3959 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3960 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3961 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3962 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3963
3964 @end table
3965
3966 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3967 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3968 sorting.
3969
3970
3971 @node Topic Topology
3972 @subsection Topic Topology
3973 @cindex topic topology
3974 @cindex topology
3975
3976 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3977
3978 @example
3979 @group
3980 Gnus
3981 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3982 3: comp.emacs
3983 2: alt.religion.emacs
3984 Naughty Emacs
3985 452: alt.sex.emacs
3986 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3987 Misc
3988 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3989 13: comp.sources.unix
3990 @end group
3991 @end example
3992
3993 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3994 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3995 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3996 follows:
3997
3998 @lisp
3999 (("Gnus" visible)
4000 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4001 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4002 (("Misc" visible)))
4003 @end lisp
4004
4005 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4006 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4007 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4008 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4009 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4010 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4011
4012 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4013 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4014 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4015
4016
4017 @node Topic Parameters
4018 @subsection Topic Parameters
4019 @cindex topic parameters
4020
4021 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4022 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4023 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4024 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4025 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4026
4027 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4028 parameters:
4029
4030 @table @code
4031 @item subscribe
4032 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4033 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4034 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4035 topic.
4036
4037 @item subscribe-level
4038 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4039 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4040 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4041
4042 @end table
4043
4044 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4045 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4046 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4047 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4048
4049 @example
4050 @group
4051 Gnus
4052 Emacs
4053 3: comp.emacs
4054 2: alt.religion.emacs
4055 452: alt.sex.emacs
4056 Relief
4057 452: alt.sex.emacs
4058 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4059 Misc
4060 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4061 13: comp.sources.unix
4062 452: alt.sex.emacs
4063 @end group
4064 @end example
4065
4066 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4067 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4068 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4069 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4070 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4071 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4072
4073 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4074 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4075 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4076 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4077 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4078
4079 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4080 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4081 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4082 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4083 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4084 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4085 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4086 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4087
4088
4089 @node Misc Group Stuff
4090 @section Misc Group Stuff
4091
4092 @menu
4093 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4094 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4095 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4096 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4097 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4098 @end menu
4099
4100 @table @kbd
4101
4102 @item v
4103 @kindex v (Group)
4104 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4105 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4106 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4107
4108 @lisp
4109 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4110 (lambda ()
4111 (interactive)
4112 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4113 @end lisp
4114
4115 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4116 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4117
4118 @item ^
4119 @kindex ^ (Group)
4120 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4121 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4122 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4123
4124 @item a
4125 @kindex a (Group)
4126 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4127 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4128 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4129 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4130 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4131 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4132 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4133
4134 @item m
4135 @kindex m (Group)
4136 @findex gnus-group-mail
4137 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4138 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4139 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4140 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4141
4142 @item i
4143 @kindex i (Group)
4144 @findex gnus-group-news
4145 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4146 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4147 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4148
4149 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4150 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4151 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4152 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4153 for this to work though.
4154
4155 @end table
4156
4157 Variables for the group buffer:
4158
4159 @table @code
4160
4161 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4162 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4163 is called after the group buffer has been
4164 created.
4165
4166 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4167 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4168 is called after the group buffer is
4169 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4170 unnatural way.
4171
4172 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4173 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4174 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4175 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4176
4177 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4178 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4179 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4180 whether they are empty or not.
4181
4182 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4183 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4184 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4185 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4186
4187 For example:
4188 @lisp
4189 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4190 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4191 @end lisp
4192
4193 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4194 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4195 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4196 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4197 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4198 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4199 default is @code{nil}.
4200
4201 For example:
4202 @lisp
4203 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4204 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4205 @end lisp
4206
4207 @end table
4208
4209 @node Scanning New Messages
4210 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4211 @cindex new messages
4212 @cindex scanning new news
4213
4214 @table @kbd
4215
4216 @item g
4217 @kindex g (Group)
4218 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4219 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4220 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4221 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4222 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4223 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4224 back end(s).
4225
4226 @item M-g
4227 @kindex M-g (Group)
4228 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4229 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4230 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4231 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4232 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4233 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4234 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4235
4236 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4237 @cindex activating groups
4238 @item C-c M-g
4239 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4240 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4241
4242 @item R
4243 @kindex R (Group)
4244 @cindex restarting
4245 @findex gnus-group-restart
4246 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4247 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4248 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4249
4250 @end table
4251
4252 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4253 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4254
4255 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4256 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4257 news.
4258
4259
4260 @node Group Information
4261 @subsection Group Information
4262 @cindex group information
4263 @cindex information on groups
4264
4265 @table @kbd
4266
4267
4268 @item H f
4269 @kindex H f (Group)
4270 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4271 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4272 @cindex FAQ
4273 @cindex ange-ftp
4274 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4275 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4276 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4277 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4278 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4279 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4280 used for fetching the file.
4281
4282 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4283 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4284
4285 @item H c
4286 @kindex H c (Group)
4287 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4288 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4289 @cindex charter
4290 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4291 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4292 prefix argument.
4293
4294 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4295 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4296 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4297
4298 @item H C
4299 @kindex H C (Group)
4300 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4301 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4302 @cindex control message
4303 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4304 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4305 group if given a prefix argument.
4306
4307 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4308 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4309 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4310 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4311
4312 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4313 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4314 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4315
4316 @item H d
4317 @itemx C-c C-d
4318 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4319 @kindex H d (Group)
4320 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4321 @cindex describing groups
4322 @cindex group description
4323 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4324 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4325 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4326
4327 @item M-d
4328 @kindex M-d (Group)
4329 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4330 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4331 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4332
4333 @item H v
4334 @itemx V
4335 @kindex V (Group)
4336 @kindex H v (Group)
4337 @cindex version
4338 @findex gnus-version
4339 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4340
4341 @item ?
4342 @kindex ? (Group)
4343 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4344 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4345
4346 @item C-c C-i
4347 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4348 @cindex info
4349 @cindex manual
4350 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4351 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4352 @end table
4353
4354
4355 @node Group Timestamp
4356 @subsection Group Timestamp
4357 @cindex timestamps
4358 @cindex group timestamps
4359
4360 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4361 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4362 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4363
4364 @lisp
4365 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4366 @end lisp
4367
4368 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4369
4370 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4371 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4372
4373 @lisp
4374 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4375 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4376 @end lisp
4377
4378 This will result in lines looking like:
4379
4380 @example
4381 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4382 0: custom 19961002T012713
4383 @end example
4384
4385 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4386 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4387 something like:
4388
4389 @lisp
4390 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4391 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4392 @end lisp
4393
4394 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4395 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4396 trick:
4397
4398 @lisp
4399 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4400 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4401 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4402 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4403 (if time
4404 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4405 "")))
4406 @end lisp
4407
4408
4409 @node File Commands
4410 @subsection File Commands
4411 @cindex file commands
4412
4413 @table @kbd
4414
4415 @item r
4416 @kindex r (Group)
4417 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4418 @vindex gnus-init-file
4419 @cindex reading init file
4420 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4421 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4422
4423 @item s
4424 @kindex s (Group)
4425 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4426 @cindex saving .newsrc
4427 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4428 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4429 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4430
4431 @c @item Z
4432 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4433 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4434 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4435
4436 @end table
4437
4438
4439 @node Sieve Commands
4440 @subsection Sieve Commands
4441 @cindex group sieve commands
4442
4443 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4444 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4445 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4446 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4447 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4448
4449 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4450 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4451 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4452 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4453 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4454 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4455 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4456 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4457 regenerate the Sieve script.
4458
4459 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4460 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4461 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4462 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4463 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4464 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4465 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4466 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4467 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4468 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4469
4470 @example
4471 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4472 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4473 stop;
4474 @}
4475 @end example
4476
4477 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4478
4479 @table @kbd
4480
4481 @item D g
4482 @kindex D g (Group)
4483 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4484 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4485 @cindex generating sieve script
4486 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4487 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4488
4489 @item D u
4490 @kindex D u (Group)
4491 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4492 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4493 @cindex updating sieve script
4494 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4495 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4496 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4497
4498 @end table
4499
4500
4501 @node Summary Buffer
4502 @chapter Summary Buffer
4503 @cindex summary buffer
4504
4505 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4506 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4507
4508 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4509 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4510
4511 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4512
4513 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4514 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4515 available in Emacs.
4516
4517 @kindex v (Summary)
4518 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4519 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4520 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4521 @lisp
4522 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4523 @end lisp
4524
4525 @menu
4526 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4527 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4528 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4529 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4530 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4531 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4532 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4533 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4534 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4535 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4536 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4537 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4538 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4539 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4540 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4541 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4542 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4543 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4544 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4545 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4546 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4547 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4548 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4549 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4550 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4551 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4552 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4553 or reselecting the current group.
4554 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4555 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4556 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4557 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4558 @end menu
4559
4560
4561 @node Summary Buffer Format
4562 @section Summary Buffer Format
4563 @cindex summary buffer format
4564
4565 @iftex
4566 @iflatex
4567 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4568 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4569 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4570 }
4571 @end iflatex
4572 @end iftex
4573
4574 @menu
4575 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4576 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4577 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4578 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4579 @end menu
4580
4581 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4582 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4583 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4584 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4585 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4586 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4587 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4588 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4589 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4590 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4591 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4592
4593 @lisp
4594 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4595 'mail-extract-address-components)
4596 @end lisp
4597
4598 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4599 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4600 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4601 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4602
4603
4604 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4605 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4606
4607 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4608 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4609 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4610 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4611 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4612
4613 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4614 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4615 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4616 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4617 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4618 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4619
4620 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4621
4622 The following format specification characters and extended format
4623 specification(s) are understood:
4624
4625 @table @samp
4626 @item N
4627 Article number.
4628 @item S
4629 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4630 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4631 @item s
4632 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4633 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4634 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4635 @item F
4636 Full @code{From} header.
4637 @item n
4638 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4639 @item f
4640 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4641 From Newsgroups}).
4642 @item a
4643 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4644 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4645 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4646 may be more thorough.
4647 @item A
4648 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4649 the @code{a} spec.
4650 @item L
4651 Number of lines in the article.
4652 @item c
4653 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4654 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4655 @item k
4656 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4657 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4658 @item I
4659 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4660 @item B
4661 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4662 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4663
4664 @example
4665 >
4666 +->
4667 | +->
4668 | | \->
4669 | | \->
4670 | \->
4671 +->
4672 \->
4673 @end example
4674
4675 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4676 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4677 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4678 line-drawing glyphs.
4679 @table @code
4680 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4681 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4682 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4683 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4684
4685 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4686 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4687 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4688 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4689
4690 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4691 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4692 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4693 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4694
4695 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4696 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4697 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4698
4699 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4700 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4701 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4702
4703 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4704 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4705 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4706
4707 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4708 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4709 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4710
4711 @end table
4712
4713 @item T
4714 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4715 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4716 @item [
4717 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4718 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4719 @item ]
4720 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4721 for adopted articles.
4722 @item >
4723 One space for each thread level.
4724 @item <
4725 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4726 @item U
4727 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4728
4729 @item R
4730 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4731 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4732 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4733
4734 @item i
4735 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4736 @item z
4737 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4738 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4739 default level. If the difference between
4740 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4741 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4742 @item V
4743 Total thread score.
4744 @item x
4745 @code{Xref}.
4746 @item D
4747 @code{Date}.
4748 @item d
4749 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4750 @item o
4751 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4752 @item M
4753 @code{Message-ID}.
4754 @item r
4755 @code{References}.
4756 @item t
4757 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4758 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4759 @item e
4760 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4761 article has any children.
4762 @item P
4763 The line number.
4764 @item O
4765 Download mark.
4766 @item *
4767 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4768 @item &user-date;
4769 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4770 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4771 @item u
4772 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4773 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4774 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4775 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4776 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4777 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4778 @end table
4779
4780 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4781 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4782 There can only be one such area.
4783
4784 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4785 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4786 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4787 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4788 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4789 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4790
4791 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4792 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4793
4794 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4795
4796
4797 @node To From Newsgroups
4798 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4799 @cindex To
4800 @cindex Newsgroups
4801
4802 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4803 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4804 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4805 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4806 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4807
4808 @enumerate
4809 @item
4810 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4811 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4812 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4813 instance:
4814
4815 @lisp
4816 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4817 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4818 @end lisp
4819
4820 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4821 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4822
4823 @item
4824 @findex gnus-extra-header
4825 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4826 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4827 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4828
4829 @example
4830 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4831 @end example
4832
4833 @item
4834 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4835 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4836 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4837 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4838 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4839 headers are used instead.
4840
4841 @end enumerate
4842
4843 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4844 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4845 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4846 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4847 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4848 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4849 regeneration.
4850
4851 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4852 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4853 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4854 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4855
4856 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4857 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4858
4859 @lisp
4860 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4861 '(To Newsgroups))
4862 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4863 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4864 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4865 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4866 "Your Name Here")
4867 @end lisp
4868
4869 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4870 to fit your needs.)
4871
4872 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4873 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4874 support:
4875
4876 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4877 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4878 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4879
4880 @example
4881 Newsgroups:full
4882 @end example
4883
4884 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4885 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4886
4887
4888 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4889 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4890
4891 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4892 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4893 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4894 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4895
4896 Here are the elements you can play with:
4897
4898 @table @samp
4899 @item G
4900 Group name.
4901 @item p
4902 Unprefixed group name.
4903 @item A
4904 Current article number.
4905 @item z
4906 Current article score.
4907 @item V
4908 Gnus version.
4909 @item U
4910 Number of unread articles in this group.
4911 @item e
4912 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4913 summary buffer.
4914 @item Z
4915 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4916 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4917 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4918 and no unselected ones.
4919 @item g
4920 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4921 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4922 @item S
4923 Subject of the current article.
4924 @item u
4925 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4926 @item s
4927 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4928 @item d
4929 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4930 @item t
4931 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4932 @item r
4933 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4934 @item E
4935 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4936 @end table
4937
4938
4939 @node Summary Highlighting
4940 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4941
4942 @table @code
4943
4944 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4945 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4946 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4947 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4948 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4949
4950 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4951 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4952 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4953 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4954
4955 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4956 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4957 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4958 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4959
4960 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4961 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4962 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4963 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4964 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4965 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4966 to something like
4967 @lisp
4968 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4969 ((> score default) . bold))
4970 @end lisp
4971 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4972 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4973 @end table
4974
4975
4976 @node Summary Maneuvering
4977 @section Summary Maneuvering
4978 @cindex summary movement
4979
4980 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4981 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4982
4983 None of these commands select articles.
4984
4985 @table @kbd
4986 @item G M-n
4987 @itemx M-n
4988 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4989 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4990 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4991 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4992 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4993
4994 @item G M-p
4995 @itemx M-p
4996 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4997 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4998 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4999 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5000 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5001
5002 @item G g
5003 @kindex G g (Summary)
5004 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5005 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5006 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5007 @end table
5008
5009 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5010 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5011 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5012 to the group buffer.
5013
5014 Variables related to summary movement:
5015
5016 @table @code
5017
5018 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5019 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5020 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5021 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5022 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5023 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5024 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5025 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5026 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5027 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5028 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5029 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5030 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5031 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5032
5033 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5034 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5035 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5036 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5037 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5038 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5039 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5040
5041 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5042
5043 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5044 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5045 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5046 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5047 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5048
5049 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5050 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5051 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5052 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5053 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5054 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5055 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5056 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5057 threads.
5058
5059 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5060 the given number of lines from the top.
5061
5062 @end table
5063
5064
5065 @node Choosing Articles
5066 @section Choosing Articles
5067 @cindex selecting articles
5068
5069 @menu
5070 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5071 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5072 @end menu
5073
5074
5075 @node Choosing Commands
5076 @subsection Choosing Commands
5077
5078 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5079 and they all select and display an article.
5080
5081 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5082 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5083
5084 @table @kbd
5085 @item SPACE
5086 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5087 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5088 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5089 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5090
5091 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5092 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5093 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5094
5095 @item G n
5096 @itemx n
5097 @kindex n (Summary)
5098 @kindex G n (Summary)
5099 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5100 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5101 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5102
5103 @item G p
5104 @itemx p
5105 @kindex p (Summary)
5106 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5107 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5108 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5109
5110 @item G N
5111 @itemx N
5112 @kindex N (Summary)
5113 @kindex G N (Summary)
5114 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5115 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5116
5117 @item G P
5118 @itemx P
5119 @kindex P (Summary)
5120 @kindex G P (Summary)
5121 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5122 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5123
5124 @item G C-n
5125 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5126 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5127 Go to the next article with the same subject
5128 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5129
5130 @item G C-p
5131 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5132 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5133 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5134 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5135
5136 @item G f
5137 @itemx .
5138 @kindex G f (Summary)
5139 @kindex . (Summary)
5140 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5141 Go to the first unread article
5142 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5143
5144 @item G b
5145 @itemx ,
5146 @kindex G b (Summary)
5147 @kindex , (Summary)
5148 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5149 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5150 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5151 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5152
5153 @item G l
5154 @itemx l
5155 @kindex l (Summary)
5156 @kindex G l (Summary)
5157 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5158 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5159
5160 @item G o
5161 @kindex G o (Summary)
5162 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5163 @cindex history
5164 @cindex article history
5165 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5166 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5167 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5168 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5169 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5170 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5171
5172 @item G j
5173 @itemx j
5174 @kindex j (Summary)
5175 @kindex G j (Summary)
5176 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5177 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5178 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5179
5180 @end table
5181
5182
5183 @node Choosing Variables
5184 @subsection Choosing Variables
5185
5186 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5187
5188 @table @code
5189 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5190 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5191 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5192 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5193 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5194 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5195
5196 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5197 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5198 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5199 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5200 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5201 hook will do so.
5202
5203 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5204 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5205 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5206 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5207 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5208 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5209 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5210 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5211 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5212 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5213 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5214 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5215 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5216 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5217
5218 @end table
5219
5220
5221 @node Paging the Article
5222 @section Scrolling the Article
5223 @cindex article scrolling
5224
5225 @table @kbd
5226
5227 @item SPACE
5228 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5229 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5230 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5231 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5232 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5233
5234 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5235 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5236 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5237 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5238 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5239 what is considered uninteresting with
5240 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5241 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5242
5243 @item DEL
5244 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5245 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5246 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5247
5248 @item RET
5249 @kindex RET (Summary)
5250 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5251 Scroll the current article one line forward
5252 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5253
5254 @item M-RET
5255 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5256 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5257 Scroll the current article one line backward
5258 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5259
5260 @item A g
5261 @itemx g
5262 @kindex A g (Summary)
5263 @kindex g (Summary)
5264 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5265 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5266 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5267 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5268 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5269 the way it came from the server.
5270
5271 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5272 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5273 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5274
5275 @lisp
5276 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5277 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5278 (2 . big5)))
5279 @end lisp
5280
5281 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5282
5283 @item A <
5284 @itemx <
5285 @kindex < (Summary)
5286 @kindex A < (Summary)
5287 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5288 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5289 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5290
5291 @item A >
5292 @itemx >
5293 @kindex > (Summary)
5294 @kindex A > (Summary)
5295 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5296 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5297
5298 @item A s
5299 @itemx s
5300 @kindex A s (Summary)
5301 @kindex s (Summary)
5302 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5303 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5304 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5305
5306 @item h
5307 @kindex h (Summary)
5308 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5309 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5310
5311 @end table
5312
5313
5314 @node Reply Followup and Post
5315 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5316
5317 @menu
5318 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5319 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5320 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5321 * Canceling and Superseding::
5322 @end menu
5323
5324
5325 @node Summary Mail Commands
5326 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5327 @cindex mail
5328 @cindex composing mail
5329
5330 Commands for composing a mail message:
5331
5332 @table @kbd
5333
5334 @item S r
5335 @itemx r
5336 @kindex S r (Summary)
5337 @kindex r (Summary)
5338 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5339 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5340 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5341 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5342 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5343
5344 @item S R
5345 @itemx R
5346 @kindex R (Summary)
5347 @kindex S R (Summary)
5348 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5349 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5350 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5351 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5352 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5353
5354 @item S w
5355 @kindex S w (Summary)
5356 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5357 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5358 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5359 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5360 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5361 present, that's used instead.
5362
5363 @item S W
5364 @kindex S W (Summary)
5365 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5366 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5367 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5368 the process/prefix convention.
5369
5370 @item S v
5371 @kindex S v (Summary)
5372 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5373 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5374 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5375 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5376 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5377 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5378
5379 @item S V
5380 @kindex S V (Summary)
5381 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5382 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5383 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5384 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5385
5386 @item S B r
5387 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5388 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5389 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5390 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5391 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5392 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5393 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5394 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5395
5396 @item S B R
5397 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5398 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5399 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5400 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5401 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5402
5403 @item S o m
5404 @itemx C-c C-f
5405 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5406 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5407 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5408 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5409 Forward the current article to some other person
5410 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5411 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5412 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5413 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5414 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5415 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5416 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5417 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5418 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5419 section.
5420
5421 @item S m
5422 @itemx m
5423 @kindex m (Summary)
5424 @kindex S m (Summary)
5425 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5426 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5427 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5428 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5429 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5430
5431 @item S i
5432 @itemx i
5433 @kindex i (Summary)
5434 @kindex S i (Summary)
5435 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5436 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5437 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5438 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5439
5440 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5441 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5442 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5443 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5444 for this to work though.
5445
5446 @item S D b
5447 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5448 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5449 @cindex bouncing mail
5450 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5451 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5452 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5453 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5454 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5455 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5456 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5457 very well fail, though.
5458
5459 @item S D r
5460 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5461 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5462 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5463 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5464 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5465 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5466 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5467 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5468 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5469 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5470
5471 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5472 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5473 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5474 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5475 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5476
5477 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5478 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5479
5480 @item S D e
5481 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5482 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5483
5484 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5485 if it were a new message before resending.
5486
5487 @item S O m
5488 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5489 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5490 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5491 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5492 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5493
5494 @item S M-c
5495 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5496 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5497 @cindex crossposting
5498 @cindex excessive crossposting
5499 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5500 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5501
5502 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5503 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5504 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5505 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5506 command understands the process/prefix convention
5507 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5508
5509 @end table
5510
5511 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5512 Manual}, for more information.
5513
5514
5515 @node Summary Post Commands
5516 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5517 @cindex post
5518 @cindex composing news
5519
5520 Commands for posting a news article:
5521
5522 @table @kbd
5523 @item S p
5524 @itemx a
5525 @kindex a (Summary)
5526 @kindex S p (Summary)
5527 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5528 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5529 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5530 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5531 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5532
5533 @item S f
5534 @itemx f
5535 @kindex f (Summary)
5536 @kindex S f (Summary)
5537 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5538 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5539 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5540
5541 @item S F
5542 @itemx F
5543 @kindex S F (Summary)
5544 @kindex F (Summary)
5545 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5546 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5547 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5548 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5549 process/prefix convention.
5550
5551 @item S n
5552 @kindex S n (Summary)
5553 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5554 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5555 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5556
5557 @item S N
5558 @kindex S N (Summary)
5559 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5560 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5561 message through mail and include the original message
5562 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5563 the process/prefix convention.
5564
5565 @item S o p
5566 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5567 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5568 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5569 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5570 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5571 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5572 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5573 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5574 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5575 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5576 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5577 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5578 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5579
5580 @item S O p
5581 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5582 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5583 @cindex digests
5584 @cindex making digests
5585 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5586 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5587 process/prefix convention.
5588
5589 @item S u
5590 @kindex S u (Summary)
5591 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5592 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5593 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5594 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5595 @end table
5596
5597 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5598 Manual}, for more information.
5599
5600
5601 @node Summary Message Commands
5602 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5603
5604 @table @kbd
5605 @item S y
5606 @kindex S y (Summary)
5607 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5608 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5609 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5610 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5611 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5612
5613 @end table
5614
5615
5616 @node Canceling and Superseding
5617 @subsection Canceling Articles
5618 @cindex canceling articles
5619 @cindex superseding articles
5620
5621 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5622 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5623
5624 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5625
5626 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5627 @kindex C (Summary)
5628 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5629 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5630 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5631 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5632 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5633 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5634
5635 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5636 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5637 question.
5638
5639 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5640 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5641 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5642
5643 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5644 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5645 message, Message Manual}).
5646
5647 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5648 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5649 your original article.
5650
5651 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5652 @kindex S (Summary)
5653 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5654 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5655 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5656 usual way.
5657
5658 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5659 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5660 have posted almost the same article twice.
5661
5662 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5663 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5664 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5665 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5666 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5667 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5668 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5669 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5670 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5671 canceled/superseded.
5672
5673 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5674
5675 @node Delayed Articles
5676 @section Delayed Articles
5677 @cindex delayed sending
5678 @cindex send delayed
5679
5680 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5681 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5682 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5683 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5684
5685 @lisp
5686 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5687 @end lisp
5688
5689 @findex gnus-delay-article
5690 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5691 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5692 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5693 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5694
5695 @itemize @bullet
5696 @item
5697 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5698 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5699 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5700 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5701
5702 @item
5703 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5704 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5705 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5706
5707 @item
5708 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5709 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5710 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5711 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5712 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5713 that means a time tomorrow.
5714 @end itemize
5715
5716 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5717 couple of variables:
5718
5719 @table @code
5720 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5721 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5722 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5723 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5724
5725 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5726 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5727 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5728 formats described above.
5729
5730 @item gnus-delay-group
5731 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5732 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5733 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5734 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5735
5736 @item gnus-delay-header
5737 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5738 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5739 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5740 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5741 @end table
5742
5743 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5744 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5745 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5746 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5747 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5748
5749 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5750 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5751 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5752 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5753 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5754 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5755 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5756
5757 @table @code
5758 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5759 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5760 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5761 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5762 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5763 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5764 argument is ignored.
5765
5766 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5767 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5768 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5769 @end table
5770
5771
5772 @node Marking Articles
5773 @section Marking Articles
5774 @cindex article marking
5775 @cindex article ticking
5776 @cindex marks
5777
5778 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5779
5780 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5781 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5782 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5783
5784 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5785
5786 @ifinfo
5787 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5788 @end ifinfo
5789
5790 @menu
5791 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5792 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5793 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5794 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5795 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5796 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5797 @end menu
5798
5799
5800 @node Unread Articles
5801 @subsection Unread Articles
5802
5803 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5804 other.
5805
5806 @table @samp
5807 @item !
5808 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5809 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5810
5811 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5812 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5813 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5814 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5815 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5816 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5817 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5818
5819 @item ?
5820 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5821 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5822
5823 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5824 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5825 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5826 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5827 messages.
5828
5829 @item SPACE
5830 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5831 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5832
5833 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5834 @end table
5835
5836
5837 @node Read Articles
5838 @subsection Read Articles
5839 @cindex expirable mark
5840
5841 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5842
5843 @table @samp
5844
5845 @item r
5846 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5847 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5848 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5849
5850 @item R
5851 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5852 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5853
5854 @item O
5855 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5856 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5857 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5858
5859 @item K
5860 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5861 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5862
5863 @item X
5864 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5865 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5866
5867 @item Y
5868 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5869 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5870
5871 @item C
5872 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5873 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5874
5875 @item G
5876 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5877 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5878
5879 @item F
5880 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5881 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5882
5883 @item Q
5884 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5885 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5886 Threading}.
5887
5888 @item M
5889 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5890 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5891 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5892
5893 @end table
5894
5895 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5896 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5897
5898 One more special mark, though:
5899
5900 @table @samp
5901 @item E
5902 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5903 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5904
5905 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5906 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5907 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5908 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5909 any time.
5910 @end table
5911
5912
5913 @node Other Marks
5914 @subsection Other Marks
5915 @cindex process mark
5916 @cindex bookmarks
5917
5918 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5919 read or not.
5920
5921 @itemize @bullet
5922
5923 @item
5924 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5925 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5926 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5927 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5928 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5929
5930 @item
5931 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5932 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5933 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5934 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5935
5936 @item
5937 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5938 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5939 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5940
5941 @item
5942 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5943 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5944 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5945
5946 @item
5947 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5948 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5949 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5950 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5951
5952 @item
5953 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5954 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5955 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5956 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5957 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5958 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5959
5960 @item
5961 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5962 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5963 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5964 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5965
5966 @item
5967 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5968 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5969 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5970 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5971 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5972 use.)
5973
5974 @item
5975 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5976 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5977 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5978 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5979 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5980 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5981
5982 @item
5983 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5984 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5985 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5986 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5987 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5988 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5989 use.)
5990
5991 @item
5992 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5993 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5994 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5995 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5996 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5997
5998 @item
5999 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6000 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6001 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6002 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6003 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6004 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6005
6006 @end itemize
6007
6008 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6009 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6010 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6011
6012 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6013 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6014 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6015
6016
6017 @node Setting Marks
6018 @subsection Setting Marks
6019 @cindex setting marks
6020
6021 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6022
6023 @table @kbd
6024 @item M c
6025 @itemx M-u
6026 @kindex M c (Summary)
6027 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6028 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6029 @cindex mark as unread
6030 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6031 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6032 article as unread.
6033
6034 @item M t
6035 @itemx !
6036 @kindex ! (Summary)
6037 @kindex M t (Summary)
6038 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6039 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6040 @xref{Article Caching}.
6041
6042 @item M ?
6043 @itemx ?
6044 @kindex ? (Summary)
6045 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6046 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6047 Mark the current article as dormant
6048 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6049
6050 @item M d
6051 @itemx d
6052 @kindex M d (Summary)
6053 @kindex d (Summary)
6054 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6055 Mark the current article as read
6056 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6057
6058 @item D
6059 @kindex D (Summary)
6060 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6061 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6062 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6063
6064 @item M k
6065 @itemx k
6066 @kindex k (Summary)
6067 @kindex M k (Summary)
6068 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6069 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6070 and then select the next unread article
6071 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6072
6073 @item M K
6074 @itemx C-k
6075 @kindex M K (Summary)
6076 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6077 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6078 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6079 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6080
6081 @item M C
6082 @kindex M C (Summary)
6083 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6084 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6085 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6086
6087 @item M C-c
6088 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6089 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6090 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6091 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6092
6093 @item M H
6094 @kindex M H (Summary)
6095 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6096 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6097 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6098
6099 @item M h
6100 @kindex M h (Summary)
6101 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6102 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6103 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6104
6105 @item C-w
6106 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6107 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6108 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6109 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6110
6111 @item M V k
6112 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6113 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6114 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6115 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6116
6117 @item M e
6118 @itemx E
6119 @kindex M e (Summary)
6120 @kindex E (Summary)
6121 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6122 Mark the current article as expirable
6123 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6124
6125 @item M b
6126 @kindex M b (Summary)
6127 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6128 Set a bookmark in the current article
6129 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6130
6131 @item M B
6132 @kindex M B (Summary)
6133 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6134 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6135 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6136
6137 @item M V c
6138 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6139 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6140 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6141 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6142
6143 @item M V u
6144 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6145 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6146 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6147 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6148
6149 @item M V m
6150 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6151 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6152 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6153 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6154 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6155 @end table
6156
6157 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6158 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6159 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6160 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6161 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6162 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6163 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6164 The default is @code{t}.
6165
6166
6167 @node Generic Marking Commands
6168 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6169
6170 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6171 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6172 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6173 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6174 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6175 well.
6176
6177 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6178 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6179 command should do.
6180
6181 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6182 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6183 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6184 to list in this manual.
6185
6186 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6187 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6188 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6189 article, you could say something like:
6190
6191 @lisp
6192 @group
6193 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6194 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6195 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6196 @end group
6197 @end lisp
6198
6199 @noindent
6200 or
6201
6202 @lisp
6203 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6204 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6205 @end lisp
6206
6207
6208 @node Setting Process Marks
6209 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6210 @cindex setting process marks
6211
6212 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6213 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6214 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6215 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6216 articles into the cache. For more information,
6217 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6218
6219 @table @kbd
6220
6221 @item M P p
6222 @itemx #
6223 @kindex # (Summary)
6224 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6225 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6226 Mark the current article with the process mark
6227 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6228 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6229
6230 @item M P u
6231 @itemx M-#
6232 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6233 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6234 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6235 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6236
6237 @item M P U
6238 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6239 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6240 Remove the process mark from all articles
6241 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6242
6243 @item M P i
6244 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6245 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6246 Invert the list of process marked articles
6247 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6248
6249 @item M P R
6250 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6251 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6252 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6253 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6254
6255 @item M P G
6256 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6257 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6258 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6259 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6260
6261 @item M P r
6262 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6263 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6264 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6265
6266 @item M P g
6267 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6268 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6269 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6270
6271 @item M P t
6272 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6273 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6274 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6275 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6276
6277 @item M P T
6278 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6279 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6280 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6281 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6282
6283 @item M P v
6284 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6285 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6286 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6287 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6288
6289 @item M P s
6290 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6291 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6292 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6293
6294 @item M P S
6295 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6296 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6297 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6298 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6299
6300 @item M P a
6301 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6302 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6303 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6304
6305 @item M P b
6306 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6308 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6309 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6310
6311 @item M P k
6312 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6313 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6314 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6315 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6316
6317 @item M P y
6318 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6319 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6320 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6321 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6322
6323 @item M P w
6324 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6325 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6326 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6327 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6328
6329 @end table
6330
6331 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6332 set process marks based on article body contents.
6333
6334
6335 @node Limiting
6336 @section Limiting
6337 @cindex limiting
6338
6339 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6340 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6341 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6342 buffer.
6343
6344 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6345 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6346 additional articles.
6347
6348 @table @kbd
6349
6350 @item / /
6351 @itemx / s
6352 @kindex / / (Summary)
6353 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6354 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6355 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6356 matching articles.
6357
6358 @item / a
6359 @kindex / a (Summary)
6360 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6361 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6362 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6363 matching articles.
6364
6365 @item / x
6366 @kindex / x (Summary)
6367 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6368 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6369 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6370 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6371 matching articles.
6372
6373 @item / u
6374 @itemx x
6375 @kindex / u (Summary)
6376 @kindex x (Summary)
6377 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6378 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6379 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6380 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6381 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6382
6383 @item / m
6384 @kindex / m (Summary)
6385 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6386 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6387 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6388
6389 @item / t
6390 @kindex / t (Summary)
6391 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6392 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6393 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6394 articles younger than that number of days.
6395
6396 @item / n
6397 @kindex / n (Summary)
6398 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6399 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6400 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6401 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6402
6403 @item / w
6404 @kindex / w (Summary)
6405 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6406 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6407 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6408 the stack.
6409
6410 @item / .
6411 @kindex / . (Summary)
6412 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6413 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6414 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6415
6416 @item / v
6417 @kindex / v (Summary)
6418 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6419 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6420 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6421
6422 @item / p
6423 @kindex / p (Summary)
6424 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6425 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6426 group parameter predicate
6427 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6428 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6429
6430 @item / E
6431 @itemx M S
6432 @kindex M S (Summary)
6433 @kindex / E (Summary)
6434 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6435 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6436 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6437
6438 @item / D
6439 @kindex / D (Summary)
6440 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6441 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6442 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6443
6444 @item / *
6445 @kindex / * (Summary)
6446 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6447 Include all cached articles in the limit
6448 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6449
6450 @item / d
6451 @kindex / d (Summary)
6452 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6453 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6454 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6455
6456 @item / M
6457 @kindex / M (Summary)
6458 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6459 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6460
6461 @item / T
6462 @kindex / T (Summary)
6463 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6464 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6465
6466 @item / c
6467 @kindex / c (Summary)
6468 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6469 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6470 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6471
6472 @item / C
6473 @kindex / C (Summary)
6474 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6475 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6476 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6477 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6478
6479 @item / N
6480 @kindex / N (Summary)
6481 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6482 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6483 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6484
6485 @item / o
6486 @kindex / o (Summary)
6487 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6488 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6489 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6490
6491 @end table
6492
6493
6494 @node Threading
6495 @section Threading
6496 @cindex threading
6497 @cindex article threading
6498
6499 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6500 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6501 hierarchical fashion.
6502
6503 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6504 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6505 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6506 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6507 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6508 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6509 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6510
6511 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6512
6513 @table @dfn
6514 @item root
6515 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6516
6517 @item thread
6518 A tree-like article structure.
6519
6520 @item sub-thread
6521 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6522
6523 @item loose threads
6524 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6525 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6526 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6527 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6528 called loose threads.
6529
6530 @item thread gathering
6531 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6532
6533 @item sparse threads
6534 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6535 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6536
6537 @end table
6538
6539
6540 @menu
6541 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6542 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6543 @end menu
6544
6545
6546 @node Customizing Threading
6547 @subsection Customizing Threading
6548 @cindex customizing threading
6549
6550 @menu
6551 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6552 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6553 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6554 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6555 @end menu
6556
6557
6558 @node Loose Threads
6559 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6560 @cindex <
6561 @cindex >
6562 @cindex loose threads
6563
6564 @table @code
6565 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6566 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6567 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6568 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6569 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6570 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6571
6572 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6573 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6574 There are four possible values:
6575
6576 @iftex
6577 @iflatex
6578 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6579 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6580 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6581 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6582 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6583 }
6584 @end iflatex
6585 @end iftex
6586
6587 @cindex adopting articles
6588
6589 @table @code
6590
6591 @item adopt
6592 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6593 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6594 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6595 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6596
6597 @item dummy
6598 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6599 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6600 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6601 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6602 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6603 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6604 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6605 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6606 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6607 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6608
6609 @item empty
6610 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6611 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6612 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6613 Buffer Format}).)
6614
6615 @item none
6616 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6617 display them after one another.
6618
6619 @item nil
6620 Don't gather loose threads.
6621 @end table
6622
6623 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6624 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6625 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6626 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6627 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6628 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6629 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6630 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6631 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6632 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6633 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6634
6635 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6636 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6637 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6638 Matching}).
6639
6640 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6641 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6642 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6643 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6644 simplification is used.
6645
6646 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6647 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6648 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6649 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6650
6651 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6652 @lisp
6653 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6654 (concat
6655 "\\`\\[?\\("
6656 (mapconcat
6657 'identity
6658 '("looking"
6659 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6660 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6661 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6662 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6663 ;; ...
6664 )
6665 "\\|")
6666 "\\)\\s *\\("
6667 (mapconcat 'identity
6668 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6669 "\\|")
6670 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6671 @end lisp
6672
6673 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6674 subjects.
6675
6676 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6677 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6678 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6679 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6680 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6681 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6682
6683 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6684
6685 @table @code
6686 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6687 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6688 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6689
6690 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6691 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6692 Simplify fuzzily.
6693
6694 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6695 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6696 Remove excessive whitespace.
6697
6698 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6699 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6700 Remove all whitespace.
6701 @end table
6702
6703 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6704
6705
6706 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6707 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6708 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6709 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6710 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6711 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6712 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6713 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6714
6715 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6716 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6717 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6718 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6719 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6720 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6721 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6722 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6723 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6724 cholera:
6725
6726 @table @code
6727 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6728 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6729 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6730 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6731
6732 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6733 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6734 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6735 @end table
6736
6737 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6738 something like:
6739
6740 @lisp
6741 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6742 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6743 @end lisp
6744
6745 @end table
6746
6747
6748 @node Filling In Threads
6749 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6750
6751 @table @code
6752 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6753 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6754 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6755 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6756 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6757 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6758 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6759 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6760 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6761 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6762 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6763 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6764 do about that.
6765
6766 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6767 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6768 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6769
6770 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6771 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6772 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6773 newsgroups.
6774
6775 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6776 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6777 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6778 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6779 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6780 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6781 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6782 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6783 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6784 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6785 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6786 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6787 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6788 @code{nil} by default.
6789
6790 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6791 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6792 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6793 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6794 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6795 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6796 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6797
6798 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6799 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6800 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6801
6802 @end table
6803
6804
6805 @node More Threading
6806 @subsubsection More Threading
6807
6808 @table @code
6809 @item gnus-show-threads
6810 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6811 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6812 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6813 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6814 slower and more awkward.
6815
6816 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6817 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6818 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6819 generated.
6820
6821 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6822 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6823 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6824
6825 Here's an example:
6826
6827 @lisp
6828 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6829 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6830 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6831 @end lisp
6832
6833 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6834 unread, but you get my drift.)
6835
6836
6837 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6838 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6839 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6840 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6841 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6842 threads are expunged.
6843
6844 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6845 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6846 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6847 will be hidden.
6848
6849 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6850 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6851 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6852 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6853 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6854 result in a new thread.
6855
6856 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6857 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6858 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6859 The default is 4.
6860
6861 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6862 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6863 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6864 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6865 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6866 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6867 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6868 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6869 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6870 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6871 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6872
6873 @end table
6874
6875
6876 @node Low-Level Threading
6877 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6878
6879 @table @code
6880
6881 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6882 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6883 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6884
6885 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6886 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6887 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6888 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6889 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6890 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6891 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6892 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6893 meaningful. Here's one example:
6894
6895 @lisp
6896 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6897
6898 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6899 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6900 (when (string-match
6901 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6902 (mail-header-set-id
6903 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6904 header))))
6905 @end lisp
6906
6907 @end table
6908
6909
6910 @node Thread Commands
6911 @subsection Thread Commands
6912 @cindex thread commands
6913
6914 @table @kbd
6915
6916 @item T k
6917 @itemx C-M-k
6918 @kindex T k (Summary)
6919 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6920 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6921 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6922 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6923 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6924 articles instead.
6925
6926 @item T l
6927 @itemx C-M-l
6928 @kindex T l (Summary)
6929 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6930 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6931 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6932 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6933
6934 @item T i
6935 @kindex T i (Summary)
6936 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6937 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6938 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6939
6940 @item T #
6941 @kindex T # (Summary)
6942 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6943 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6944 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6945
6946 @item T M-#
6947 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6948 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6949 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6950 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6951
6952 @item T T
6953 @kindex T T (Summary)
6954 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6955 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6956
6957 @item T s
6958 @kindex T s (Summary)
6959 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6960 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6961 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6962
6963 @item T h
6964 @kindex T h (Summary)
6965 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6966 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6967
6968 @item T S
6969 @kindex T S (Summary)
6970 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6971 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6972
6973 @item T H
6974 @kindex T H (Summary)
6975 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6976 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6977
6978 @item T t
6979 @kindex T t (Summary)
6980 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6981 Re-thread the current article's thread
6982 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6983 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6984
6985 @item T ^
6986 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6987 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6988 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6989 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6990
6991 @end table
6992
6993 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6994 understand the numeric prefix.
6995
6996 @table @kbd
6997
6998 @item T n
6999 @kindex T n (Summary)
7000 @itemx C-M-f
7001 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7002 @itemx M-down
7003 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7004 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7005 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7006
7007 @item T p
7008 @kindex T p (Summary)
7009 @itemx C-M-b
7010 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7011 @itemx M-up
7012 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7013 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7014 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7015
7016 @item T d
7017 @kindex T d (Summary)
7018 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7019 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7020
7021 @item T u
7022 @kindex T u (Summary)
7023 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7024 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7025
7026 @item T o
7027 @kindex T o (Summary)
7028 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7029 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7030 @end table
7031
7032 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7033 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7034 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7035 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7036 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7037 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7038 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7039 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7040 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7041 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7042 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7043 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7044 Matching}).
7045
7046
7047 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7048 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7049
7050 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7051 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7052 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7053 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7054 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7055 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7056 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7057 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7058 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7059 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7060 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7061 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7062 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7063 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7064
7065 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7066 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7067 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7068 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7069 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7070 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7071 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7072 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7073
7074 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7075 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7076 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
7077
7078 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7079 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7080 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7081 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7082 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7083 ascending article order.
7084
7085 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7086 by number, you could do something like:
7087
7088 @lisp
7089 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7090 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7091 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7092 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7093 @end lisp
7094
7095 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7096 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7097 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7098 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7099 which the articles arrived.
7100
7101 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7102 say something like:
7103
7104 @lisp
7105 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7106 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7107 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7108 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7109 @end lisp
7110
7111 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7112 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7113 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7114 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7115 tickles your fancy.
7116
7117 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7118 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7119 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7120 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7121 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7122 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7123 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7124 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7125 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7126 variable. It is very similar to the
7127 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7128 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7129 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7130 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7131 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7132 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7133 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7134
7135 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7136 say something like:
7137
7138 @lisp
7139 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7140 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7141 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7142 @end lisp
7143
7144
7145
7146 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7147 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7148 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7149 @cindex article pre-fetch
7150 @cindex pre-fetch
7151
7152 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7153 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7154 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7155 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7156 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7157
7158 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7159 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7160
7161 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7162 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7163 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7164 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7165 connection is blocked.
7166
7167 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7168 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7169 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7170 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7171
7172 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7173 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7174 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7175 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7176 extra connection.
7177
7178 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7179 you really want to.
7180
7181 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7182 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7183 happen automatically.
7184
7185 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7186 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7187 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7188 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7189 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7190 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7191 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7192
7193 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7194 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7195 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7196 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7197 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7198 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7199 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7200 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7201 article data structure as the only parameter.
7202
7203 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7204 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7205
7206 @lisp
7207 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7208 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7209 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7210 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7211 100)))
7212
7213 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7214 @end lisp
7215
7216 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7217 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7218 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7219
7220 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7221 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7222 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7223 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7224
7225 @table @code
7226 @item read
7227 Remove articles when they are read.
7228
7229 @item exit
7230 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7231 @end table
7232
7233 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7234
7235 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7236 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7237 @c from the next group.
7238
7239
7240 @node Article Caching
7241 @section Article Caching
7242 @cindex article caching
7243 @cindex caching
7244
7245 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7246 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7247 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7248 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7249 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7250
7251 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7252
7253 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7254 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7255 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7256 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7257 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7258 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7259 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7260 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7261
7262 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7263 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7264 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7265 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7266 as dormant, and don't worry.
7267
7268 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7269
7270 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7271 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7272 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7273 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7274 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7275 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7276 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7277 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7278 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7279 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7280
7281 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7282 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7283 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7284 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7285 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7286 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7287 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7288 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7289 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7290 not then be downloaded by this command.
7291
7292 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7293 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7294 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7295 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7296 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7297 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7298
7299 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7300 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7301 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7302 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7303 variables, the group is not cached.
7304
7305 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7306 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7307 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7308 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7309 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7310 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7311 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7312 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7313 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7314 file.
7315
7316 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7317 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7318 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7319 where, isn't that cool?
7320
7321 @node Persistent Articles
7322 @section Persistent Articles
7323 @cindex persistent articles
7324
7325 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7326 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7327 useful in my opinion.
7328
7329 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7330 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7331 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7332 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7333 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7334 the expiry going on at the news server.
7335
7336 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7337 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7338 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7339
7340 @table @kbd
7341
7342 @item *
7343 @kindex * (Summary)
7344 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7345 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7346
7347 @item M-*
7348 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7349 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7350 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7351 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7352 article.
7353 @end table
7354
7355 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7356
7357 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7358 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7359 interested in persistent articles:
7360
7361 @lisp
7362 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7363 @end lisp
7364
7365
7366 @node Article Backlog
7367 @section Article Backlog
7368 @cindex backlog
7369 @cindex article backlog
7370
7371 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7372 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7373 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7374 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7375 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7376 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7377 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7378 increase memory usage some.
7379
7380 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7381 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7382 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7383 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7384 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7385 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7386 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7387
7388 The default value is 20.
7389
7390
7391 @node Saving Articles
7392 @section Saving Articles
7393 @cindex saving articles
7394
7395 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7396 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7397 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7398 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7399 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7400
7401 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7402 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7403 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7404
7405 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7406 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7407 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7408
7409 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7410 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7411 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7412 deleted before saving.
7413
7414 @table @kbd
7415
7416 @item O o
7417 @itemx o
7418 @kindex O o (Summary)
7419 @kindex o (Summary)
7420 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7421 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7422 Save the current article using the default article saver
7423 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7424
7425 @item O m
7426 @kindex O m (Summary)
7427 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7428 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7429 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7430
7431 @item O r
7432 @kindex O r (Summary)
7433 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7434 Save the current article in Rmail format
7435 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7436
7437 @item O f
7438 @kindex O f (Summary)
7439 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7440 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7441 Save the current article in plain file format
7442 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7443
7444 @item O F
7445 @kindex O F (Summary)
7446 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7447 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7448 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7449
7450 @item O b
7451 @kindex O b (Summary)
7452 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7453 Save the current article body in plain file format
7454 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7455
7456 @item O h
7457 @kindex O h (Summary)
7458 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7459 Save the current article in mh folder format
7460 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7461
7462 @item O v
7463 @kindex O v (Summary)
7464 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7465 Save the current article in a VM folder
7466 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7467
7468 @item O p
7469 @itemx |
7470 @kindex O p (Summary)
7471 @kindex | (Summary)
7472 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7473 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7474 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7475 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7476 complete headers in the piped output.
7477
7478 @item O P
7479 @kindex O P (Summary)
7480 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7481 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7482 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7483 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7484 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7485 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7486 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7487
7488 @end table
7489
7490 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7491 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7492 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7493 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7494 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7495 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7496 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7497 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7498 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7499 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7500 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7501 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7502 files.
7503
7504
7505 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7506 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7507 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7508 functions below, or you can create your own.
7509
7510 @table @code
7511
7512 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7513 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7514 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7515 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7516 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7517 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7518 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7519
7520 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7521 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7522 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7523 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7524 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7525 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7526
7527 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7528 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7529 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7530 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7531 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7532 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7533 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7534
7535 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7536 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7537 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7538 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7539 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7540 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7541
7542 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7543 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7544 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7545 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7546 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7547
7548 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7549 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7550 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7551 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7552 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7553 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7554
7555 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7556 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7557 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7558 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7559 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7560 @cindex rcvstore
7561 @cindex MH folders
7562 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7563 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7564 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7565 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7566 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7567
7568 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7569 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7570 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7571 reader to use this setting.
7572 @end table
7573
7574 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7575
7576 @table @code
7577 @item :decode
7578 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7579 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7580 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7581 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file}, and
7582 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7583
7584 @item :function
7585 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7586 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7587 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7588 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7589 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7590 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7591
7592 @item :headers
7593 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7594 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7595 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7596 headers should be saved.
7597 @end table
7598
7599 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7600 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7601 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7602 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7603 default.
7604
7605 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7606 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7607 available functions that generate names:
7608
7609 @table @code
7610
7611 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7612 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7613 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7614
7615 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7616 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7617 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7618
7619 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7620 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7621 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7622
7623 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7624 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7625 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7626
7627 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7628 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7629 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7630 @end table
7631
7632 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7633 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7634 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7635 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7636 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7637 like:
7638
7639 @lisp
7640 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7641 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7642 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7643 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7644 @end lisp
7645
7646 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7647 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7648 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7649 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7650 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7651 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7652 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7653 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7654 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7655
7656 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7657 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7658 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7659 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7660
7661 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7662 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7663 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7664 name.
7665
7666 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7667 lots of mail groups called things like
7668 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7669 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7670 following will do just that:
7671
7672 @lisp
7673 (defun my-save-name (group)
7674 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7675 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7676
7677 (setq gnus-split-methods
7678 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7679 (my-save-name)))
7680 @end lisp
7681
7682
7683 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7684 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7685 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7686 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7687 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7688 all the files in the top level directory
7689 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7690 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7691 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7692 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7693
7694 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7695 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7696 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7697 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7698 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7699 for kill files.
7700
7701 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7702 a spool, you could
7703
7704 @lisp
7705 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7706 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7707 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7708 @end lisp
7709
7710 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7711 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7712 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7713 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7714
7715
7716 @node Decoding Articles
7717 @section Decoding Articles
7718 @cindex decoding articles
7719
7720 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7721 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7722
7723 @menu
7724 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7725 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7726 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7727 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7728 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7729 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7730 @end menu
7731
7732 @cindex series
7733 @cindex article series
7734 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7735 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7736 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7737 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7738 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7739
7740 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7741 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7742 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7743
7744 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7745 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7746 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7747
7748 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7749 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7750 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7751
7752
7753 @node Uuencoded Articles
7754 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7755 @cindex uudecode
7756 @cindex uuencoded articles
7757
7758 @table @kbd
7759
7760 @item X u
7761 @kindex X u (Summary)
7762 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7763 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7764 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7765
7766 @item X U
7767 @kindex X U (Summary)
7768 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7769 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7770 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7771
7772 @item X v u
7773 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7774 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7775 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7776
7777 @item X v U
7778 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7779 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7780 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7781 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7782
7783 @end table
7784
7785 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7786 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7787 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7788 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7789 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7790
7791 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7792 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7793 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7794 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7795 @kbd{X u}.
7796
7797 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7798 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7799 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7800 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7801 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7802 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7803 off.
7804
7805
7806 @node Shell Archives
7807 @subsection Shell Archives
7808 @cindex unshar
7809 @cindex shell archives
7810 @cindex shared articles
7811
7812 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7813 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7814 some commands to deal with these:
7815
7816 @table @kbd
7817
7818 @item X s
7819 @kindex X s (Summary)
7820 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7821 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7822
7823 @item X S
7824 @kindex X S (Summary)
7825 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7826 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7827
7828 @item X v s
7829 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7830 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7831 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7832
7833 @item X v S
7834 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7835 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7836 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7837 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7838 @end table
7839
7840
7841 @node PostScript Files
7842 @subsection PostScript Files
7843 @cindex PostScript
7844
7845 @table @kbd
7846
7847 @item X p
7848 @kindex X p (Summary)
7849 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7850 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7851
7852 @item X P
7853 @kindex X P (Summary)
7854 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7855 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7856 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7857
7858 @item X v p
7859 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7860 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7861 View the current PostScript series
7862 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7863
7864 @item X v P
7865 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7866 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7867 View and save the current PostScript series
7868 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7869 @end table
7870
7871
7872 @node Other Files
7873 @subsection Other Files
7874
7875 @table @kbd
7876 @item X o
7877 @kindex X o (Summary)
7878 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7879 Save the current series
7880 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7881
7882 @item X b
7883 @kindex X b (Summary)
7884 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7885 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7886 doesn't really work yet.
7887 @end table
7888
7889
7890 @node Decoding Variables
7891 @subsection Decoding Variables
7892
7893 Adjective, not verb.
7894
7895 @menu
7896 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7897 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7898 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7899 @end menu
7900
7901
7902 @node Rule Variables
7903 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7904 @cindex rule variables
7905
7906 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7907 variables are of the form
7908
7909 @lisp
7910 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7911 '(regexp2 command2)
7912 ...)
7913 @end lisp
7914
7915 @table @code
7916
7917 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7918 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7919 @cindex sox
7920 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7921 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7922 say something like:
7923 @lisp
7924 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7925 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7926 @end lisp
7927
7928 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7929 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7930 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7931 user and default view rules.
7932
7933 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7934 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7935 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7936 archives.
7937 @end table
7938
7939
7940 @node Other Decode Variables
7941 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7942
7943 @table @code
7944 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7945
7946 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7947 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7948 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7949 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7950 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7951
7952 @table @code
7953
7954 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7955 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7956 View the file.
7957
7958 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7959 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7960 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7961 @end table
7962
7963 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7964 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7965 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7966 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7967 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7968 time.
7969
7970 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7971 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7972 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7973
7974 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7975 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7976 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7977 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7978 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7979 kludgey.
7980
7981 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7982 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7983 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7984
7985 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7986 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7987 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7988 looking for files to display.
7989
7990 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7991 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7992 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7993 after viewing it.
7994
7995 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7996 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7997 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7998 rules.
7999
8000 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8001 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8002 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8003 unpacking commands.
8004
8005 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8006 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8007 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8008 from articles.
8009
8010 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8011 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8012 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8013 decoded articles as unread.
8014
8015 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8016 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8017 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8018 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8019
8020 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8021 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8022 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8023
8024 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8025 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8026 @cindex metamail
8027 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8028 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8029 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8030 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8031
8032 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8033 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8034 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8035 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8036 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8037 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8038 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8039 simply dropped them.
8040
8041 @end table
8042
8043
8044 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8045 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8046
8047 @table @code
8048
8049 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8050 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8051 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8052 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8053 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8054 for you when you post the article.
8055
8056 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8057 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8058 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8059 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8060
8061 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8062 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8063 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8064 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8065 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8066 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8067 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8068
8069 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8070 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8071 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8072 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8073 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8074 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8075 Default is @code{t}.
8076
8077 @end table
8078
8079
8080 @node Viewing Files
8081 @subsection Viewing Files
8082 @cindex viewing files
8083 @cindex pseudo-articles
8084
8085 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8086 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8087 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8088 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8089 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8090 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8091 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8092
8093 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8094 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8095 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8096 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8097
8098 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8099 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8100 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8101
8102 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8103 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8104 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8105 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8106 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8107
8108 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8109 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8110 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8111 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8112 a list of parameters to that command.
8113
8114 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8115 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8116 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8117
8118 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8119 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8120 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8121
8122
8123 @node Article Treatment
8124 @section Article Treatment
8125
8126 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8127 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8128 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8129 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8130 these articles easier.
8131
8132 @menu
8133 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8134 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8135 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8136 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8137 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8138 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8139 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8140 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8141 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8142 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8143 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8144 @end menu
8145
8146
8147 @node Article Highlighting
8148 @subsection Article Highlighting
8149 @cindex highlighting
8150
8151 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8152 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8153
8154 @table @kbd
8155
8156 @item W H a
8157 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8158 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8159 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8160 Do much highlighting of the current article
8161 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8162 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8163
8164 @item W H h
8165 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8166 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8167 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8168 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8169 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8170 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8171 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8172 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8173 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8174 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8175 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8176 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8177
8178 @item W H c
8179 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8180 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8181 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8182
8183 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8184
8185 @table @code
8186 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8187
8188 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8189 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8190 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8191
8192 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8193 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8194 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8195
8196 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8197 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8198 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8199 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8200 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8201 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8202
8203 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8204 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8205 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8206
8207 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8208 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8209 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8210
8211 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8212 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8213 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8214 that it's a citation.
8215
8216 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8217 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8218 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8219
8220 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8221 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8222 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8223
8224 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8225 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8226 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8227 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8228
8229 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8230 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8231 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8232 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8233 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8234 is @code{t}.
8235
8236 @end table
8237
8238
8239 @item W H s
8240 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8241 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8242 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8243 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8244 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8245 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8246 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8247 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8248 default.
8249
8250 @end table
8251
8252 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8253
8254
8255 @node Article Fontisizing
8256 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8257 @cindex emphasis
8258 @cindex article emphasis
8259
8260 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8261 @kindex W e (Summary)
8262 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8263 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8264 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8265 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8266
8267 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8268 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8269 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8270 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8271 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8272 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8273 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8274 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8275 highlighting.
8276
8277 @lisp
8278 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8279 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8280 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8281 @end lisp
8282
8283 @cindex slash
8284 @cindex asterisk
8285 @cindex underline
8286 @cindex /
8287 @cindex *
8288
8289 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8290 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8291 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8292 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8293 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8294 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8295 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8296 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8297 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8298 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8299 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8300 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8301 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8302
8303 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8304 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8305 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8306 say something like:
8307
8308 @lisp
8309 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8310 @end lisp
8311
8312 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8313
8314 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8315 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8316 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8317 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8318
8319 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8320
8321
8322 @node Article Hiding
8323 @subsection Article Hiding
8324 @cindex article hiding
8325
8326 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8327 too much cruft in most articles.
8328
8329 @table @kbd
8330
8331 @item W W a
8332 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8333 @findex gnus-article-hide
8334 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8335 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8336 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8337
8338 @item W W h
8339 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8340 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8341 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8342 Headers}.
8343
8344 @item W W b
8345 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8346 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8347 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8348 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8349
8350 @item W W s
8351 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8352 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8353 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8354 Signature}.
8355
8356 @item W W l
8357 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8358 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8359 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8360 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8361 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8362 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8363 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8364 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8365
8366 @table @code
8367
8368 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8369 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8370 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8371 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8372
8373 @end table
8374
8375 @item W W P
8376 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8377 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8378 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8379 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8380
8381 @item W W B
8382 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8383 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8384 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8385 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8386 @cindex banner
8387 @cindex OneList
8388 @cindex stripping advertisements
8389 @cindex advertisements
8390 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8391 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8392 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8393 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8394 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8395 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8396 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8397 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8398 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8399 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8400 used.
8401
8402 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8403 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8404 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8405
8406 @table @code
8407
8408 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8409 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8410 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8411 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8412 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8413 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8414 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8415 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8416 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8417 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8418 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8419
8420 @lisp
8421 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8422 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8423 @end lisp
8424
8425 @end table
8426
8427 @item W W c
8428 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8429 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8430 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8431 customizing the hiding:
8432
8433 @table @code
8434
8435 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8436 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8437 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8438 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8439 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8440 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8441 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8442 specs are valid:
8443
8444 @table @samp
8445 @item b
8446 Starting point of the hidden text.
8447 @item e
8448 Ending point of the hidden text.
8449 @item l
8450 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8451 @item n
8452 Number of lines of hidden text.
8453 @end table
8454
8455 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8456 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8457 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8458 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8459 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8460
8461 @end table
8462
8463 @item W W C-c
8464 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8465 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8466
8467 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8468 following two variables:
8469
8470 @table @code
8471 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8472 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8473 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8474 50), hide the cited text.
8475
8476 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8477 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8478 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8479 is hidden.
8480 @end table
8481
8482 @item W W C
8483 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8484 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8485 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8486 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8487 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8488 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8489
8490 @end table
8491
8492 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8493 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8494 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8495
8496 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8497 citation customization.
8498
8499 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8500 automatically.
8501
8502
8503 @node Article Washing
8504 @subsection Article Washing
8505 @cindex washing
8506 @cindex article washing
8507
8508 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8509 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8510
8511 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8512 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8513 Cleaner, perhaps.
8514
8515 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8516 articles by default.
8517
8518 @table @kbd
8519
8520 @item C-u g
8521 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8522 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8523 the server.
8524
8525 @item g
8526 Force redisplaying of the current article
8527 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8528 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8529 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8530 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8531
8532 @item W l
8533 @kindex W l (Summary)
8534 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8535 Remove page breaks from the current article
8536 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8537 delimiters.
8538
8539 @item W r
8540 @kindex W r (Summary)
8541 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8542 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8543 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8544 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8545 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8546 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8547
8548 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8549 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8550 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8551 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8552
8553 @item W m
8554 @kindex W m (Summary)
8555 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8556 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8557
8558 @item W t
8559 @item t
8560 @kindex W t (Summary)
8561 @kindex t (Summary)
8562 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8563 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8564 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8565
8566 @item W v
8567 @kindex W v (Summary)
8568 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8569 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8570 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8571
8572 @item W o
8573 @kindex W o (Summary)
8574 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8575 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8576
8577 @item W d
8578 @kindex W d (Summary)
8579 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8580 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8581 @cindex Smartquotes
8582 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8583 @cindex Latin 1
8584 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8585 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8586 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8587 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8588 interactively.
8589
8590 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8591 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8592 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8593 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8594
8595 @item W Y f
8596 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8597 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8598 @cindex Outlook Express
8599 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8600 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8601 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8602
8603 @item W Y u
8604 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8605 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8606 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8607 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8608 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8609 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8610 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8611 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8612 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8613 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8614
8615 @item W Y a
8616 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8617 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8618 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8619 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8620
8621 @item W Y c
8622 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8623 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8624 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8625 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8626
8627 @item W w
8628 @kindex W w (Summary)
8629 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8630 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8631
8632 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8633 when filling.
8634
8635 @item W Q
8636 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8637 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8638 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8639
8640 @item W C
8641 @kindex W C (Summary)
8642 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8643 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8644 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8645
8646 @item W c
8647 @kindex W c (Summary)
8648 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8649 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8650 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8651 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8652 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8653
8654 @item W q
8655 @kindex W q (Summary)
8656 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8657 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8658 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8659 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8660 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8661 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8662 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8663 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8664 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8665
8666 @item W 6
8667 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8668 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8669 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8670 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8671 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8672 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8673 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8674 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8675
8676 @item W Z
8677 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8678 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8679 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8680 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8681 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8682
8683 @item W u
8684 @kindex W u (Summary)
8685 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8686 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8687 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8688 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8689 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8690
8691 @item W h
8692 @kindex W h (Summary)
8693 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8694 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8695 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8696 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8697
8698 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
8699 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
8700 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
8701
8702 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8703 The default is to use the function specified by
8704 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8705 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8706 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8707 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8708 can use include:
8709
8710 @table @code
8711 @item w3
8712 Use Emacs/W3.
8713
8714 @item w3m
8715 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8716
8717 @item w3m-standalone
8718 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
8719
8720 @item links
8721 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8722
8723 @item lynx
8724 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8725
8726 @item html2text
8727 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8728
8729 @end table
8730
8731 @item W b
8732 @kindex W b (Summary)
8733 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8734 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8735 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8736
8737 @item W B
8738 @kindex W B (Summary)
8739 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8740 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8741 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8742
8743 @item W p
8744 @kindex W p (Summary)
8745 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8746 Verify a signed control message
8747 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8748 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8749 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8750 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8751 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8752 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8753
8754 @item W s
8755 @kindex W s (Summary)
8756 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8757 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8758 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8759 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8760
8761 @item W a
8762 @kindex W a (Summary)
8763 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8764 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8765 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8766
8767 @item W E l
8768 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8769 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8770 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8771 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8772
8773 @item W E m
8774 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8775 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8776 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8777 lines with a single empty line.
8778 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8779
8780 @item W E t
8781 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8782 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8783 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8784 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8785
8786 @item W E a
8787 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8788 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8789 Do all the three commands above
8790 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8791
8792 @item W E A
8793 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8794 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8795 Remove all blank lines
8796 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8797
8798 @item W E s
8799 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8800 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8801 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8802 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8803
8804 @item W E e
8805 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8806 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8807 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8808 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8809
8810 @end table
8811
8812 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8813
8814
8815 @node Article Header
8816 @subsection Article Header
8817
8818 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8819
8820 @table @kbd
8821
8822 @item W G u
8823 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8824 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8825 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8826
8827 @item W G n
8828 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8829 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8830 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8831 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8832
8833 @item W G f
8834 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8835 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8836 Fold all the message headers
8837 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8838
8839 @item W E w
8840 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8841 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8842 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8843 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8844
8845 @end table
8846
8847
8848 @node Article Buttons
8849 @subsection Article Buttons
8850 @cindex buttons
8851
8852 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8853 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8854 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8855 button on these references.
8856
8857 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8858 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8859 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8860 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8861 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8862
8863 @table @code
8864
8865 @item gnus-button-alist
8866 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8867 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8868
8869 @lisp
8870 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8871 @end lisp
8872
8873 @table @var
8874
8875 @item regexp
8876 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8877 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8878 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8879 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8880 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8881
8882 @item button-par
8883 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8884 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8885 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8886
8887 @item use-p
8888 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8889 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8890 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8891 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8892 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8893
8894 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8895
8896 @item function
8897 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8898
8899 @item data-par
8900 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8901 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8902
8903 @end table
8904
8905 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8906
8907 @lisp
8908 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8909 @end lisp
8910
8911 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8912 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8913 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8914 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8915 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8916
8917 @lisp
8918 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8919 @end lisp
8920
8921 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8922 @end table
8923
8924 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8925
8926 @table @code
8927 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8928 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8929
8930 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8931
8932 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8933 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8934 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8935 default values of the variables above.
8936
8937 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8938
8939 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8940 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8941 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8942 argument with a string naming the man page.
8943
8944 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8945
8946 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8947 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8948 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8949
8950 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8951 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8952 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8953 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8954 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8955 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8956 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8957 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
8958 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8959 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8960 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8961 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8962
8963 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8964 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8965 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8966 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8967 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8968 string is invalid.
8969
8970 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8971 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8972 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8973 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8974
8975 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8976
8977 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8978 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8979 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8980 argument, the string naming the URL.
8981
8982 @item gnus-ctan-url
8983 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8984 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8985 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8986
8987 @c Misc stuff
8988
8989 @item gnus-article-button-face
8990 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8991 Face used on buttons.
8992
8993 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8994 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8995 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8996
8997 @end table
8998
8999 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9000
9001
9002 @node Article Button Levels
9003 @subsection Article button levels
9004 @cindex button levels
9005 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9006 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9007 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9008 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9009 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9010 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9011 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9012 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9013
9014 @lisp
9015 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9016 (setq gnus-parameters
9017 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9018 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9019 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9020 @end lisp
9021
9022 @table @code
9023
9024 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9025 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9026 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9027 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9028 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9029 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9030
9031 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9032 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9033 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9034 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9035 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9036 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9037 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9038 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9039 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9040 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9041 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9042 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9043 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9044
9045 @item gnus-button-man-level
9046 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9047 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9048 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9049
9050 @item gnus-button-message-level
9051 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9052 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9053 Related variables and functions include
9054 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9055 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9056 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9057 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9058
9059 @item gnus-button-tex-level
9060 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
9061 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
9062 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
9063 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
9064 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
9065 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
9066
9067 @end table
9068
9069
9070 @node Article Date
9071 @subsection Article Date
9072
9073 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9074 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9075 when the article was sent.
9076
9077 @table @kbd
9078
9079 @item W T u
9080 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9081 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9082 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9083 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9084
9085 @item W T i
9086 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9087 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9088 @cindex ISO 8601
9089 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9090 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9091
9092 @item W T l
9093 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9094 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9095 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9096
9097 @item W T p
9098 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9099 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9100 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9101 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9102
9103 @item W T s
9104 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9105 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9106 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9107 @findex format-time-string
9108 Display the date using a user-defined format
9109 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9110 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9111 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9112 for a list of possible format specs.
9113
9114 @item W T e
9115 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9116 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9117 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9118 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9119 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9120 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9121
9122 @example
9123 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9124 @end example
9125
9126 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
9127 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
9128 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9129 replace it.
9130
9131 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9132 into wonderful absurdities.
9133
9134 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9135
9136 @lisp
9137 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9138 @end lisp
9139
9140 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9141 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9142 command.
9143
9144 @item W T o
9145 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9146 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9147 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9148 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9149 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9150 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9151 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9152
9153 @end table
9154
9155 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9156 preferred format automatically.
9157
9158
9159 @node Article Display
9160 @subsection Article Display
9161 @cindex picons
9162 @cindex x-face
9163 @cindex smileys
9164
9165 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9166 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9167
9168 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9169 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9170
9171 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9172 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9173
9174 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9175 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9176
9177 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9178 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9179
9180 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9181 they'll be removed.
9182
9183 @table @kbd
9184 @item W D x
9185 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9186 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9187 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9188 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9189
9190 @item W D d
9191 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9192 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9193 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9194 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9195
9196 @item W D s
9197 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9198 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9199 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9200
9201 @item W D f
9202 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9203 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9204 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9205
9206 @item W D m
9207 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9208 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9209 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9210 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9211
9212 @item W D n
9213 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9214 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9215 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9216 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9217
9218 @item W D D
9219 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9220 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9221 Remove all images from the article buffer
9222 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9223
9224 @end table
9225
9226
9227
9228 @node Article Signature
9229 @subsection Article Signature
9230 @cindex signatures
9231 @cindex article signature
9232
9233 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9234 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9235 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9236 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9237 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9238 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9239 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9240 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9241 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9242
9243 @lisp
9244 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9245 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9246 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9247 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9248 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9249 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9250 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9251 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9252 @end lisp
9253
9254 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9255 positives.
9256
9257 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9258 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9259 signature when displaying articles.
9260
9261 @enumerate
9262 @item
9263 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9264 that integer.
9265 @item
9266 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9267 than that number.
9268 @item
9269 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9270 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9271 @item
9272 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9273 in question is not a signature.
9274 @end enumerate
9275
9276 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9277 listed above. Here's an example:
9278
9279 @lisp
9280 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9281 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9282 @end lisp
9283
9284 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9285 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9286 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9287 signature after all.
9288
9289
9290 @node Article Miscellanea
9291 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9292
9293 @table @kbd
9294 @item A t
9295 @kindex A t (Summary)
9296 @findex gnus-article-babel
9297 Translate the article from one language to another
9298 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9299
9300 @end table
9301
9302
9303 @node MIME Commands
9304 @section MIME Commands
9305 @cindex MIME decoding
9306 @cindex attachments
9307 @cindex viewing attachments
9308
9309 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9310 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9311
9312 @table @kbd
9313 @item b
9314 @itemx K v
9315 @kindex b (Summary)
9316 @kindex K v (Summary)
9317 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9318
9319 @item K o
9320 @kindex K o (Summary)
9321 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9322
9323 @item K c
9324 @kindex K c (Summary)
9325 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9326
9327 @item K e
9328 @kindex K e (Summary)
9329 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9330
9331 @item K i
9332 @kindex K i (Summary)
9333 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9334
9335 @item K |
9336 @kindex K | (Summary)
9337 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9338 @end table
9339
9340 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9341 the same manner:
9342
9343 @table @kbd
9344 @item K b
9345 @kindex K b (Summary)
9346 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9347 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9348 parts.
9349
9350 @item K m
9351 @kindex K m (Summary)
9352 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9353 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9354 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9355 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9356 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9357
9358 @item X m
9359 @kindex X m (Summary)
9360 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9361 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9362 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9363 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9364
9365 @item M-t
9366 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9367 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9368 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9369 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9370
9371 @item W M w
9372 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9373 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9374 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9375 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9376
9377 @item W M c
9378 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9379 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9380 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9381 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9382
9383 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9384 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9385 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9386 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9387 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9388 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9389
9390 @item W M v
9391 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9392 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9393 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9394 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9395
9396 @end table
9397
9398 Relevant variables:
9399
9400 @table @code
9401 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9402 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9403 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9404 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9405 @code{nil}.
9406
9407 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9408
9409 @lisp
9410 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9411 '("text/x-vcard"))
9412 @end lisp
9413
9414 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9415 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9416 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9417 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9418 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9419 default is @code{nil}.
9420
9421 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9422 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9423 @cindex uuencode
9424 @cindex yEnc
9425 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9426 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9427 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9428 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9429 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9430 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9431 for encoding in Gnus.
9432
9433 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9434 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9435 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9436 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9437 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9438 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9439 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9440 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9441
9442 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9443 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9444 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9445 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9446 displayed. This variable overrides
9447 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9448 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9449 is @code{nil}.
9450
9451 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9452 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9453 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9454
9455 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9456 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9457 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9458 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9459 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9460
9461 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9462 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9463 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9464 default value is @code{nil}.
9465
9466 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9467 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9468 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9469 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9470 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9471 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9472 save all jpegs into some directory).
9473
9474 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9475
9476 @lisp
9477 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9478 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9479 (with-temp-buffer
9480 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9481 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9482 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9483 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9484 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9485 @end lisp
9486
9487 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9488 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9489 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9490
9491 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9492 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9493 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9494
9495 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9496 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9497 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9498
9499 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9500 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9501 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9502 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9503 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9504
9505 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9506 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9507 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9508 overrides @code{nil} values of
9509 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9510 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9511
9512 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9513 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9514 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9515 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9516
9517 Ready-made functions include@*
9518 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9519 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9520 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9521 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9522 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9523 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9524 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9525 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9526 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9527 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9528 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9529 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9530
9531 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9532 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9533
9534 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9535 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9536 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9537
9538 @lisp
9539 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9540 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9541 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9542 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9543 @end lisp
9544
9545 @noindent
9546 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9547
9548 @end table
9549
9550
9551 @node Charsets
9552 @section Charsets
9553 @cindex charsets
9554
9555 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9556 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9557 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9558 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9559 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9560 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9561 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9562
9563 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9564 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9565 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9566 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9567
9568 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9569 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9570 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9571 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9572 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9573 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9574 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9575 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9576 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9577
9578 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9579 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9580 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9581 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9582 quoted-printable header encoding.
9583
9584 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9585 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9586 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9587
9588 @table @var
9589 @item test
9590 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9591 variable to query,
9592 @item header
9593 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9594 means encode all charsets),
9595 @item body-list
9596 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9597 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9598 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9599 @end table
9600
9601 @cindex Russian
9602 @cindex koi8-r
9603 @cindex koi8-u
9604 @cindex iso-8859-5
9605 @cindex coding system aliases
9606 @cindex preferred charset
9607
9608 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9609 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9610 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9611
9612 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9613
9614 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9615 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9616
9617 @lisp
9618 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9619 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9620 @end lisp
9621
9622 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9623 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9624
9625 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9626
9627 @lisp
9628 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9629 @end lisp
9630
9631 This will almost do the right thing.
9632
9633 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9634 something like
9635
9636 @lisp
9637 (codepage-setup 1251)
9638 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9639 @end lisp
9640
9641
9642 @node Article Commands
9643 @section Article Commands
9644
9645 @table @kbd
9646
9647 @item A P
9648 @cindex PostScript
9649 @cindex printing
9650 @kindex A P (Summary)
9651 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9652 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9653 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9654 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9655 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9656 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9657
9658 @end table
9659
9660
9661 @node Summary Sorting
9662 @section Summary Sorting
9663 @cindex summary sorting
9664
9665 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9666 can't really see why you'd want that.
9667
9668 @table @kbd
9669
9670 @item C-c C-s C-n
9671 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9672 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9673 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9674
9675 @item C-c C-s C-a
9676 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9677 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9678 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9679
9680 @item C-c C-s C-s
9681 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9682 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9683 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9684
9685 @item C-c C-s C-d
9686 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9687 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9688 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9689
9690 @item C-c C-s C-l
9691 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9692 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9693 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9694
9695 @item C-c C-s C-c
9696 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9697 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9698 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9699
9700 @item C-c C-s C-i
9701 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9702 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9703 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9704
9705 @item C-c C-s C-r
9706 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9707 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9708 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9709
9710 @item C-c C-s C-o
9711 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9712 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9713 Sort using the default sorting method
9714 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9715 @end table
9716
9717 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9718 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9719 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9720 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9721 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9722 Commands}).
9723
9724
9725 @node Finding the Parent
9726 @section Finding the Parent
9727 @cindex parent articles
9728 @cindex referring articles
9729
9730 @table @kbd
9731 @item ^
9732 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9733 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9734 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9735 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9736 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9737 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9738 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9739 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9740 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9741 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9742
9743 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9744 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9745 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9746 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9747 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9748 article.
9749
9750 @item A R (Summary)
9751 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9752 @kindex A R (Summary)
9753 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9754 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9755
9756 @item A T (Summary)
9757 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9758 @kindex A T (Summary)
9759 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9760 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9761 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9762 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9763 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9764 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9765 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9766
9767 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9768 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9769 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9770 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9771 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9772 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9773
9774 @item M-^ (Summary)
9775 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9776 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9777 @cindex Message-ID
9778 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9779 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
9780 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
9781 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
9782 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
9783 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9784
9785 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
9786 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
9787 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
9788 @end table
9789
9790 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9791 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9792 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9793 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9794 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9795 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9796 necessary.
9797
9798 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9799 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9800 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9801 match.
9802
9803 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9804 then ask Google if that fails:
9805
9806 @lisp
9807 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9808 '(current
9809 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9810 @end lisp
9811
9812 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9813 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9814 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9815 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9816 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9817 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9818 not support this at all.
9819
9820
9821 @node Alternative Approaches
9822 @section Alternative Approaches
9823
9824 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9825 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9826
9827 @menu
9828 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9829 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9830 @end menu
9831
9832
9833 @node Pick and Read
9834 @subsection Pick and Read
9835 @cindex pick and read
9836
9837 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9838 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9839 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9840 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9841
9842 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9843 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9844 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9845 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9846 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9847 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9848
9849 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9850
9851 @table @kbd
9852 @item .
9853 @kindex . (Pick)
9854 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9855 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9856 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9857 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9858 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9859 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9860 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9861 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9862
9863 @item SPACE
9864 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9865 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9866 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9867 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9868
9869 @item u
9870 @kindex u (Pick)
9871 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9872 Unpick the thread or article
9873 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9874 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9875 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9876 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9877 the thread or article at that line.
9878
9879 @item RET
9880 @kindex RET (Pick)
9881 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9882 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9883 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9884 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9885 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9886 will still be visible when you are reading.
9887
9888 @end table
9889
9890 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9891 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9892 which is mapped to the same function
9893 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9894
9895 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9896
9897 @lisp
9898 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9899 @end lisp
9900
9901 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9902 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9903
9904 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9905 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9906 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9907
9908 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9909 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9910 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9911 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9912 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9913 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9914 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9915
9916
9917 @node Binary Groups
9918 @subsection Binary Groups
9919 @cindex binary groups
9920
9921 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9922 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9923 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9924 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9925 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9926 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9927 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9928
9929 @kindex g (Binary)
9930 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9931 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9932 command, when you have turned on this mode
9933 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9934
9935 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9936 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9937
9938
9939 @node Tree Display
9940 @section Tree Display
9941 @cindex trees
9942
9943 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9944 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9945 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9946 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9947 in the tree buffer.
9948
9949 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9950
9951 @table @code
9952 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9953 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9954 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9955
9956 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9957 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9958 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9959 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9960 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9961
9962 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9963 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9964 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9965 default is @code{modeline}.
9966
9967 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9968 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9969 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9970 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9971 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9972 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9973 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9974
9975 Valid specs are:
9976
9977 @table @samp
9978 @item n
9979 The name of the poster.
9980 @item f
9981 The @code{From} header.
9982 @item N
9983 The number of the article.
9984 @item [
9985 The opening bracket.
9986 @item ]
9987 The closing bracket.
9988 @item s
9989 The subject.
9990 @end table
9991
9992 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9993
9994 Variables related to the display are:
9995
9996 @table @code
9997 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9998 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9999 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10000 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10001 @example
10002 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10003 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10004 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10005 @end example
10006 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10007
10008 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10009 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10010 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10011 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10012
10013 @end table
10014
10015 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10016 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10017 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10018 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10019 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10020 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10021 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10022 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10023 other windows displayed next to it.
10024
10025 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10026 at all times:
10027
10028 @lisp
10029 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10030 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10031 @end lisp
10032
10033 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10034 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10035 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10036 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10037 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10038 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10039 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10040
10041 @end table
10042
10043 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10044
10045 @example
10046 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10047 | \[Jan]
10048 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10049 | \(***)-[Eri]
10050 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10051 \[Bjo]
10052 \[Gun]
10053 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10054 @end example
10055
10056 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10057
10058 @example
10059 @group
10060 @{***@}
10061 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10062 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10063 |--\-----\-----\ |
10064 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10065 | | |--\
10066 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10067 |
10068 [Paa]
10069 @end group
10070 @end example
10071
10072 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10073 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10074 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10075
10076 @lisp
10077 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10078 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10079 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10080 (gnus-add-configuration
10081 '(article
10082 (vertical 1.0
10083 (horizontal 0.25
10084 (summary 0.75 point)
10085 (tree 1.0))
10086 (article 1.0))))
10087 @end lisp
10088
10089 @xref{Window Layout}.
10090
10091
10092 @node Mail Group Commands
10093 @section Mail Group Commands
10094 @cindex mail group commands
10095
10096 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10097 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10098
10099 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10100 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10101
10102 @table @kbd
10103
10104 @item B e
10105 @kindex B e (Summary)
10106 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10107 @cindex expiring mail
10108 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10109 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10110 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10111 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10112
10113 @item B C-M-e
10114 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10115 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10116 @cindex expiring mail
10117 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10118 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10119 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10120 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10121
10122 @item B DEL
10123 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10124 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10125 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10126 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10127 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10128 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10129
10130 @item B m
10131 @kindex B m (Summary)
10132 @cindex move mail
10133 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10134 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10135 Move the article from one mail group to another
10136 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10137 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10138
10139 @item B c
10140 @kindex B c (Summary)
10141 @cindex copy mail
10142 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10143 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10144 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10145 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10146 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10147
10148 @item B B
10149 @kindex B B (Summary)
10150 @cindex crosspost mail
10151 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10152 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10153 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10154 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10155 be properly updated.
10156
10157 @item B i
10158 @kindex B i (Summary)
10159 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10160 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10161 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10162 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10163
10164 @item B I
10165 @kindex B I (Summary)
10166 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10167 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10168 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10169 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10170
10171 @item B r
10172 @kindex B r (Summary)
10173 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10174 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10175 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10176 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10177 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10178 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10179 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10180 (which is the default).
10181
10182 @item B w
10183 @itemx e
10184 @kindex B w (Summary)
10185 @kindex e (Summary)
10186 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10187 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10188 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10189 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10190 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10191 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10192 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10193
10194 @item B q
10195 @kindex B q (Summary)
10196 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10197 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10198 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10199 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10200
10201 @item B t
10202 @kindex B t (Summary)
10203 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10204 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10205 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10206
10207 @item B p
10208 @kindex B p (Summary)
10209 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10210 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10211 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10212 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10213 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10214 article from your news server (or rather, from
10215 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10216 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10217 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10218 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10219 just not have arrived yet.
10220
10221 @item K E
10222 @kindex K E (Summary)
10223 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10224 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10225 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10226 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10227 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10228
10229 @end table
10230
10231 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10232 @cindex moving articles
10233 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10234 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10235 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10236 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10237 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10238 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10239 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10240
10241 @lisp
10242 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10243 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10244 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10245 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10246 @end lisp
10247
10248
10249 @node Various Summary Stuff
10250 @section Various Summary Stuff
10251
10252 @menu
10253 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10254 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10255 * Summary Generation Commands::
10256 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10257 @end menu
10258
10259 @table @code
10260 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10261 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10262 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10263 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10264 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10265 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10266
10267 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10268 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10269 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10270 current article.
10271
10272 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10273 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10274 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10275
10276 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10277 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10278 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10279 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10280 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10281 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10282 have been set.
10283
10284 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10285 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10286 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10287 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10288 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10289
10290 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10291 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10292 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10293 generated.
10294
10295 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10296 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10297 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10298 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10299 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10300 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10301 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10302 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10303 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10304 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10305
10306 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10307 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10308 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10309 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10310 list of articles to be selected.
10311
10312 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10313 the list in one particular group:
10314
10315 @lisp
10316 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10317 (if (string= group "some.group")
10318 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10319 articles))
10320 @end lisp
10321
10322 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10323 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10324 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10325 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10326 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10327 buffer is active.
10328
10329 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10330 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10331 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10332 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10333 variable will be used instead.
10334
10335 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10336 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10337 buffers. For example:
10338
10339 @lisp
10340 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10341 '(message-use-followup-to
10342 (gnus-visible-headers .
10343 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10344 @end lisp
10345
10346 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10347 @end table
10348
10349
10350 @node Summary Group Information
10351 @subsection Summary Group Information
10352
10353 @table @kbd
10354
10355 @item H f
10356 @kindex H f (Summary)
10357 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10358 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10359 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10360 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10361 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10362 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10363 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10364 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10365 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10366
10367 @item H d
10368 @kindex H d (Summary)
10369 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10370 Give a brief description of the current group
10371 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10372 rereading the description from the server.
10373
10374 @item H h
10375 @kindex H h (Summary)
10376 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10377 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10378 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10379
10380 @item H i
10381 @kindex H i (Summary)
10382 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10383 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10384 @end table
10385
10386
10387 @node Searching for Articles
10388 @subsection Searching for Articles
10389
10390 @table @kbd
10391
10392 @item M-s
10393 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10394 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10395 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10396 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10397
10398 @item M-r
10399 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10400 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10401 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10402 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10403
10404 @item &
10405 @kindex & (Summary)
10406 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10407 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10408 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10409 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10410 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10411 search backward instead.
10412
10413 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10414 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10415
10416 @item M-&
10417 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10418 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10419 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10420 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10421 @end table
10422
10423 @node Summary Generation Commands
10424 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10425
10426 @table @kbd
10427
10428 @item Y g
10429 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10430 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10431 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10432
10433 @item Y c
10434 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10435 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10436 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10437 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10438
10439 @item Y d
10440 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10441 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10442 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10443 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10444
10445 @end table
10446
10447
10448 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10449 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10450
10451 @table @kbd
10452
10453 @item A D
10454 @itemx C-d
10455 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10456 @kindex A D (Summary)
10457 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10458 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10459 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10460 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10461 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10462 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10463 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10464 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10465 fashion.
10466
10467 @item C-M-d
10468 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10469 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10470 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10471 several documents into one biiig group
10472 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10473 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10474 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10475 command understands the process/prefix convention
10476 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10477
10478 @item C-t
10479 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10480 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10481 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10482 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10483 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10484 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10485
10486 @item =
10487 @kindex = (Summary)
10488 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10489 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10490 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10491
10492 @item C-M-e
10493 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10494 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10495 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10496 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10497
10498 @item C-M-a
10499 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10500 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10501 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10502 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10503
10504 @end table
10505
10506
10507 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10508 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10509 @cindex summary exit
10510 @cindex exiting groups
10511
10512 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10513 group and return you to the group buffer.
10514
10515 @table @kbd
10516
10517 @item Z Z
10518 @itemx Z Q
10519 @itemx q
10520 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10521 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10522 @kindex q (Summary)
10523 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10524 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10525 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10526 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10527 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10528 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10529 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10530 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10531 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10532 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10533 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10534 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10535
10536 @item Z E
10537 @itemx Q
10538 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10539 @kindex Q (Summary)
10540 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10541 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10542 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10543
10544 @item Z c
10545 @itemx c
10546 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10547 @kindex c (Summary)
10548 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10549 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10550 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10551 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10552
10553 @item Z C
10554 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10555 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10556 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10557 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10558
10559 @item Z n
10560 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10561 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10562 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10563 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10564
10565 @item Z R
10566 @itemx C-x C-s
10567 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10568 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10569 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10570 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10571 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10572 all articles, both read and unread.
10573
10574 @item Z G
10575 @itemx M-g
10576 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10577 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10578 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10579 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10580 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10581 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10582 articles, both read and unread.
10583
10584 @item Z N
10585 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10586 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10587 Exit the group and go to the next group
10588 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10589
10590 @item Z P
10591 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10592 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10593 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10594 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10595
10596 @item Z s
10597 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10598 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10599 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10600 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10601 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10602 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10603 @end table
10604
10605 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10606 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10607 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10608 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10609
10610 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10611 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10612 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10613 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10614 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10615 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10616 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10617 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10618 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10619 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10620 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10621 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10622
10623 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10624
10625 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10626 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10627 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10628 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10629 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10630 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10631 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10632 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10633 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10634
10635
10636 @node Crosspost Handling
10637 @section Crosspost Handling
10638
10639 @cindex velveeta
10640 @cindex spamming
10641 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10642 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10643 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10644 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10645 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10646 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10647 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10648
10649 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10650 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10651 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10652 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10653 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10654
10655 @cindex cross-posting
10656 @cindex Xref
10657 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10658 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10659 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10660 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10661 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10662 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10663 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10664 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10665 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10666 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10667 the cross reference mechanism.
10668
10669 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10670 @cindex overview.fmt
10671 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10672 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10673 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10674 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10675 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10676 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10677 overview files.
10678
10679 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10680 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10681 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
10682
10683 C'est la vie.
10684
10685 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10686
10687
10688 @node Duplicate Suppression
10689 @section Duplicate Suppression
10690
10691 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10692 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10693 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10694 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10695 reasons.
10696
10697 @enumerate
10698 @item
10699 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10700 is evil and not very common.
10701
10702 @item
10703 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10704 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10705
10706 @item
10707 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10708 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10709
10710 @item
10711 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10712 @end enumerate
10713
10714 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10715 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10716
10717 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10718 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10719 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10720 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10721 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10722 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10723 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10724 once.
10725
10726 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10727 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10728 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10729 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10730 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10731 saw the article in.
10732
10733 @table @code
10734 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10735 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10736 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10737
10738 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10739 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10740 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10741 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10742 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10743 session are suppressed.
10744
10745 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10746 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10747 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10748 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10749
10750 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10751 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10752 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10753 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10754 @end table
10755
10756 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10757 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10758 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10759 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10760 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10761 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10762 to you to figure out, I think.
10763
10764 @node Security
10765 @section Security
10766
10767 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10768 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10769 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10770 things to work:
10771
10772 @enumerate
10773 @item
10774 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10775 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10776 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10777 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10778
10779 @item
10780 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10781 or newer is recommended.
10782
10783 @end enumerate
10784
10785 The variables that control security functionality on reading messages
10786 include:
10787
10788 @table @code
10789 @item mm-verify-option
10790 @vindex mm-verify-option
10791 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10792 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10793 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10794
10795 @item mm-decrypt-option
10796 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10797 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10798 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10799 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10800
10801 @item mml1991-use
10802 @vindex mml1991-use
10803 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10804 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10805 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10806 deprecated.
10807
10808 @item mml2015-use
10809 @vindex mml2015-use
10810 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10811 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10812 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10813 deprecated.
10814
10815 @end table
10816
10817 By default the buttons that display security information are not
10818 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
10819 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
10820 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
10821 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
10822 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
10823 how to customize these variables to always display security
10824 information.
10825
10826 @cindex snarfing keys
10827 @cindex importing PGP keys
10828 @cindex PGP key ring import
10829 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10830 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10831 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10832 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10833 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10834 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10835 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10836 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10837 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10838
10839 @example
10840 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10841 @end example
10842 @noindent
10843 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10844 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10845
10846 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
10847 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
10848 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10849
10850 @node Mailing List
10851 @section Mailing List
10852 @cindex mailing list
10853 @cindex RFC 2396
10854
10855 @kindex A M (summary)
10856 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10857 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10858 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10859 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10860 summary buffer.
10861
10862 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10863
10864 @table @kbd
10865
10866 @item C-c C-n h
10867 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10868 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10869 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10870
10871 @item C-c C-n s
10872 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10873 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10874 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10875
10876 @item C-c C-n u
10877 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10878 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10879 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10880 field exists.
10881
10882 @item C-c C-n p
10883 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10884 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10885 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10886
10887 @item C-c C-n o
10888 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10889 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10890 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10891
10892 @item C-c C-n a
10893 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10894 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10895 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10896
10897 @end table
10898
10899
10900 @node Article Buffer
10901 @chapter Article Buffer
10902 @cindex article buffer
10903
10904 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10905 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10906 tell Gnus otherwise.
10907
10908 @menu
10909 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10910 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10911 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10912 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10913 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10914 @end menu
10915
10916
10917 @node Hiding Headers
10918 @section Hiding Headers
10919 @cindex hiding headers
10920 @cindex deleting headers
10921
10922 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10923 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10924
10925 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10926 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10927 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10928 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10929 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10930 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10931 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10932 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10933 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10934
10935 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10936
10937 @table @code
10938
10939 @item gnus-visible-headers
10940 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10941 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10942 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10943 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10944
10945 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10946 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10947
10948 @lisp
10949 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10950 @end lisp
10951
10952 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10953 remain visible.
10954
10955 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10956 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10957 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10958 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10959 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10960 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10961
10962 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10963 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10964
10965 @lisp
10966 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10967 @end lisp
10968
10969 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10970 be removed.
10971
10972 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10973 variable will have no effect.
10974
10975 @end table
10976
10977 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10978 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10979 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10980 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10981 the headers are to be displayed.
10982
10983 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10984 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10985
10986 @lisp
10987 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10988 @end lisp
10989
10990 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10991 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10992
10993 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10994 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10995 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10996 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10997 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10998 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10999 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11000 from sight.
11001
11002 These conditions are:
11003 @table @code
11004 @item empty
11005 Remove all empty headers.
11006 @item followup-to
11007 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11008 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11009 @item reply-to
11010 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11011 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11012 parameter is set.
11013 @item newsgroups
11014 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11015 name.
11016 @item to-address
11017 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11018 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11019 @item to-list
11020 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11021 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11022 @item cc-list
11023 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11024 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11025 @item date
11026 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11027 old.
11028 @item long-to
11029 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11030 @item many-to
11031 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11032 @end table
11033
11034 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11035
11036 @lisp
11037 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11038 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11039 @end lisp
11040
11041 This is also the default value for this variable.
11042
11043
11044 @node Using MIME
11045 @section Using MIME
11046 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11047
11048 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11049 while people stand around yawning.
11050
11051 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11052 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11053
11054 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11055 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11056 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11057
11058 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11059 @findex gnus-display-mime
11060 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11061 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11062 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11063 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11064
11065 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11066 @acronym{MIME} button:
11067
11068 @table @kbd
11069 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11070 @item RET (Article)
11071 @kindex RET (Article)
11072 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11073 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11074 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11075 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11076 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11077 object is displayed inline.
11078
11079 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11080 @item M-RET (Article)
11081 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11082 @itemx v (Article)
11083 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11084 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11085
11086 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11087 @item t (Article)
11088 @kindex t (Article)
11089 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11090 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11091
11092 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11093 @item C (Article)
11094 @kindex C (Article)
11095 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11096 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11097
11098 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11099 @item o (Article)
11100 @kindex o (Article)
11101 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11102 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11103
11104 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11105 @item C-o (Article)
11106 @kindex C-o (Article)
11107 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11108 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11109 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11110 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11111 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11112 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11113
11114 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11115 @item d (Article)
11116 @kindex d (Article)
11117 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11118 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11119 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11120
11121 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11122 @item c (Article)
11123 @kindex c (Article)
11124 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11125 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11126 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11127 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11128 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11129
11130 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11131 @item p (Article)
11132 @kindex p (Article)
11133 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11134 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11135 @file{.mailcap} file.
11136
11137 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11138 @item i (Article)
11139 @kindex i (Article)
11140 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11141 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
11142 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11143 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11144 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11145 Article}).
11146
11147 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11148 @item E (Article)
11149 @kindex E (Article)
11150 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11151 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11152 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11153
11154 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11155 @item e (Article)
11156 @kindex e (Article)
11157 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11158 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11159
11160 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11161 @item | (Article)
11162 @kindex | (Article)
11163 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11164
11165 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11166 @item . (Article)
11167 @kindex . (Article)
11168 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11169 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11170
11171 @end table
11172
11173 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11174 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11175 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11176
11177 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11178 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11179 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11180 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11181 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11182 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11183 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11184 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11185 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11186
11187 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11188
11189 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11190
11191
11192 @node Customizing Articles
11193 @section Customizing Articles
11194 @cindex article customization
11195
11196 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11197 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11198 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11199 called automatically when you select the articles.
11200
11201 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11202 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11203 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11204 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11205
11206 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11207 for sensible values.
11208
11209 @enumerate
11210 @item
11211 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11212
11213 @item
11214 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11215
11216 @item
11217 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11218
11219 @item
11220 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11221
11222 @item
11223 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11224 than this number.
11225
11226 @item
11227 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11228 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11229 regexps in the list.
11230
11231 @item
11232 A list where the first element is not a string:
11233
11234 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11235 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11236 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11237
11238 @lisp
11239 (or last
11240 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11241 @end lisp
11242
11243 @end enumerate
11244
11245 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11246 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11247 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11248 considered to contain just a single part.
11249
11250 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11251 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11252 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11253 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11254 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11255 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11256 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11257
11258 @ifinfo
11259 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11260 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11261 @c `i foo-bar'.
11262 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11263 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11264 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11265 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11266 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11267 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11268 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11269 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11270 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11271 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11272 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11273 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11274 @vindex gnus-treat-date-english
11275 @vindex gnus-treat-date-iso8601
11276 @vindex gnus-treat-date-lapsed
11277 @vindex gnus-treat-date-local
11278 @vindex gnus-treat-date-original
11279 @vindex gnus-treat-date-user-defined
11280 @vindex gnus-treat-date-ut
11281 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11282 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11283 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11284 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11285 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11286 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11287 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11288 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11289 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11290 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11291 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11292 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11293 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11294 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11295 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11296 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11297 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11298 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11299 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11300 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11301 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11302 @vindex gnus-treat-translate
11303 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11304 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11305 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11306 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11307 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11308 @end ifinfo
11309
11310 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11311 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11312 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11313 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11314
11315 @table @code
11316 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11317 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11318
11319 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11320
11321 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11322 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11323 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11324 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11325 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11326 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11327 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11328 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11329 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11330 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11331
11332 @xref{Article Washing}.
11333
11334 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11335 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11336 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11337 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11338 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11339 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11340 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11341
11342 @xref{Article Date}.
11343
11344 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11345 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11346 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11347
11348 @xref{Picons}.
11349
11350 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11351
11352 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11353
11354 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11355 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11356 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11357
11358 @xref{Smileys}.
11359
11360 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11361 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11362
11363 @xref{X-Face}.
11364
11365 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11366 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11367
11368 @xref{Face}.
11369
11370 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11371 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11372 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11373 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11374 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11375 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11376 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11377 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11378 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11379 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11380 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11381 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11382 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11383 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11384 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11385 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11386 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11387 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11388 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11389 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11390
11391 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11392
11393 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11394 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11395 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11396 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11397 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11398 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11399
11400 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11401
11402 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11403 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11404 @vindex gnus-treat-translate
11405 @item gnus-treat-translate
11406 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11407 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11408
11409 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11410 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11411 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11412 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11413 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11414 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11415 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11416 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11417
11418 @xref{Article Header}.
11419
11420
11421 @end table
11422
11423 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11424 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11425 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11426 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11427 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11428 everything.
11429
11430
11431 @node Article Keymap
11432 @section Article Keymap
11433
11434 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11435 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11436 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11437 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11438 buffer.
11439
11440 @kindex v (Article)
11441 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
11442 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
11443 command or better use it as a prefix key.
11444
11445 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11446
11447 @table @kbd
11448
11449 @item SPACE
11450 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11451 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11452 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11453 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11454
11455 @item DEL
11456 @kindex DEL (Article)
11457 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11458 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11459 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11460
11461 @item C-c ^
11462 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11463 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11464 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11465 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11466 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11467
11468 @item C-c C-m
11469 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11470 @findex gnus-article-mail
11471 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11472 given a prefix, include the mail.
11473
11474 @item s
11475 @kindex s (Article)
11476 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11477 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11478 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11479
11480 @item ?
11481 @kindex ? (Article)
11482 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11483 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11484 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11485
11486 @item TAB
11487 @kindex TAB (Article)
11488 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11489 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11490 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11491
11492 @item M-TAB
11493 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11494 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11495 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11496
11497 @item R
11498 @kindex R (Article)
11499 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11500 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11501 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11502 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11503 region.
11504
11505 @item F
11506 @kindex F (Article)
11507 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11508 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11509 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11510 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11511 region.
11512
11513
11514 @end table
11515
11516
11517 @node Misc Article
11518 @section Misc Article
11519
11520 @table @code
11521
11522 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11523 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11524 @cindex article buffers, several
11525 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11526 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11527 article buffer.
11528
11529 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11530 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11531 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11532 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11533 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11534
11535 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11536 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11537 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11538 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11539 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11540 the contents of the article buffer.
11541
11542 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11543 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11544 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11545
11546 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11547 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11548 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11549 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11550
11551 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11552 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11553 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11554 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11555
11556 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11557 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11558 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11559 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11560 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11561 with two extensions:
11562
11563 @table @samp
11564
11565 @item w
11566 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11567 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11568 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11569
11570 @table @samp
11571
11572 @item c
11573 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11574
11575 @item h
11576 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11577
11578 @item p
11579 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11580 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11581 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11582
11583 @item s
11584 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11585
11586 @item o
11587 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11588
11589 @item e
11590 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11591
11592 @end table
11593
11594 @item m
11595 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11596
11597 @end table
11598
11599 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11600
11601 @item gnus-break-pages
11602 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11603 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11604 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11605 paging will not be done.
11606
11607 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11608 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11609 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11610 (formfeed).
11611
11612 @cindex IDNA
11613 @cindex internationalized domain names
11614 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11615 @item gnus-use-idna
11616 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11617 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11618 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11619 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11620 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11621
11622 @end table
11623
11624
11625 @node Composing Messages
11626 @chapter Composing Messages
11627 @cindex composing messages
11628 @cindex messages
11629 @cindex mail
11630 @cindex sending mail
11631 @cindex reply
11632 @cindex followup
11633 @cindex post
11634 @cindex using gpg
11635 @cindex using s/mime
11636 @cindex using smime
11637
11638 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11639 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11640 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11641 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11642 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11643 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11644
11645 @menu
11646 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11647 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11648 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11649 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11650 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11651 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11652 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11653 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11654 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11655 @end menu
11656
11657 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11658 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11659
11660
11661 @node Mail
11662 @section Mail
11663
11664 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11665
11666 @table @code
11667 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11668 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11669 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11670 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11671 @code{nil} include all headers.
11672
11673 @item gnus-add-to-list
11674 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11675 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11676 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11677
11678 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11679 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11680 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
11681 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
11682 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
11683 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
11684 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
11685 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
11686
11687 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11688 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
11689
11690 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11691 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11692 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11693 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11694 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11695
11696 @end table
11697
11698
11699 @node Posting Server
11700 @section Posting Server
11701
11702 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11703 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11704
11705 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11706
11707 It can be quite complicated.
11708
11709 @vindex gnus-post-method
11710 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11711 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11712 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11713 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11714 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11715 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11716 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11717 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11718 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11719
11720 @lisp
11721 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11722 @end lisp
11723
11724 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11725 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11726 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11727 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11728
11729 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11730 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11731
11732 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11733 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11734 for posting.
11735
11736 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11737 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11738
11739 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11740 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11741 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11742 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11743 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11744 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11745 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11746 package correctly. An example:
11747
11748 @lisp
11749 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11750 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11751 @end lisp
11752
11753 To the thing similar to this, there is
11754 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11755 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11756 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11757
11758 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11759 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11760 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11761
11762 @node POP before SMTP
11763 @section POP before SMTP
11764 @cindex pop before smtp
11765 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11766 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11767
11768 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11769 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11770 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11771 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11772 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11773
11774 @lisp
11775 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11776 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11777 @end lisp
11778
11779 @noindent
11780 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11781 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11782 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11783 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11784 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11785 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11786 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11787 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11788
11789 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11790 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11791 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11792 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11793 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11794 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11795
11796 @lisp
11797 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11798 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11799 :password "secret"))
11800 @end lisp
11801
11802 @noindent
11803 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11804 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11805
11806 @lisp
11807 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11808 (lambda ()
11809 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11810 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11811 :password "secret")))
11812 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11813 @end lisp
11814
11815 @node Mail and Post
11816 @section Mail and Post
11817
11818 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11819 posting:
11820
11821 @table @code
11822 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11823 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11824 @cindex mailing lists
11825
11826 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11827 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11828 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11829 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11830 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11831 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11832 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11833 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11834 still a pain, though.
11835
11836 @item gnus-user-agent
11837 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11838 @cindex User-Agent
11839
11840 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11841 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
11842 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
11843 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
11844 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
11845 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
11846 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11847
11848 @end table
11849
11850 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11851 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11852 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11853
11854 @cindex ispell
11855 @findex ispell-message
11856 @lisp
11857 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11858 @end lisp
11859
11860 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11861 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11862
11863 @lisp
11864 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11865 (lambda ()
11866 (cond
11867 ((string-match
11868 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11869 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11870 (t
11871 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11872 @end lisp
11873
11874 Modify to suit your needs.
11875
11876
11877 @node Archived Messages
11878 @section Archived Messages
11879 @cindex archived messages
11880 @cindex sent messages
11881
11882 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11883 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11884 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11885 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11886 is the default.
11887
11888 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11889 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11890 Group Commands}).
11891
11892 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11893 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11894 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11895
11896 @lisp
11897 (nnfolder "archive"
11898 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11899 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11900 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11901 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11902 @end lisp
11903
11904 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11905 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11906 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11907 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11908
11909 @lisp
11910 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11911 '(nnfolder "archive"
11912 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11913 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11914 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11915 @end lisp
11916
11917 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11918 @cindex Gcc
11919 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11920 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11921 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11922
11923 This variable can be used to do the following:
11924
11925 @table @asis
11926 @item a string
11927 Messages will be saved in that group.
11928
11929 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11930 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11931 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11932 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11933 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11934 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11935 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11936 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11937 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11938
11939 @item a list of strings
11940 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11941
11942 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11943 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11944
11945 @item @code{nil}
11946 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11947 @end table
11948
11949 Let's illustrate:
11950
11951 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11952 @lisp
11953 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11954 @end lisp
11955
11956 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11957 @lisp
11958 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11959 @end lisp
11960
11961 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11962 @lisp
11963 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11964 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11965 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11966 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11967 @end lisp
11968
11969 More complex stuff:
11970 @lisp
11971 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11972 '((if (message-news-p)
11973 "misc-news"
11974 "misc-mail")))
11975 @end lisp
11976
11977 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11978 messages in one file per month:
11979
11980 @lisp
11981 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11982 '((if (message-news-p)
11983 "misc-news"
11984 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11985 @end lisp
11986
11987 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11988 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11989
11990 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11991 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11992 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11993 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11994 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11995 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11996 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11997 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11998 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11999 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12000
12001 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
12002 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
12003 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
12004 this will disable archiving.
12005
12006 @table @code
12007 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
12008 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
12009 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
12010 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
12011 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
12012 group names.
12013
12014 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
12015 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
12016 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
12017 of names).
12018
12019 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
12020 but the latter is the preferred method.
12021
12022 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12023 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12024 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12025
12026 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12027 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12028 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12029 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12030 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12031 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12032 changed in the future.
12033
12034 @end table
12035
12036
12037 @node Posting Styles
12038 @section Posting Styles
12039 @cindex posting styles
12040 @cindex styles
12041
12042 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12043
12044 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12045 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12046 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12047 on?
12048
12049 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12050 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12051 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12052 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12053 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12054 variable:
12055
12056 @lisp
12057 ((".*"
12058 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12059 (organization "What me?"))
12060 ("^comp"
12061 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12062 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12063 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12064 @end lisp
12065
12066 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12067 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12068 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12069 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12070 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12071 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12072 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12073 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12074
12075 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12076 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12077 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12078 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12079 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12080 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12081 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12082 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12083 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12084 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12085 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12086 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12087 said to @dfn{match}.
12088
12089 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12090 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12091 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12092 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12093 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12094 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12095 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12096 name can be one of:
12097
12098 @itemize @bullet
12099 @item @code{signature}
12100 @item @code{signature-file}
12101 @item @code{x-face-file}
12102 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12103 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12104 @item @code{body}
12105 @end itemize
12106
12107 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12108 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12109 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12110 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12111 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12112
12113 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
12114 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
12115 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
12116 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12117 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
12118 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
12119 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
12120 references chars lines xref extra.
12121
12122 @vindex message-reply-headers
12123
12124 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12125 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12126 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12127
12128 @findex message-mail-p
12129 @findex message-news-p
12130
12131 So here's a new example:
12132
12133 @lisp
12134 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12135 '((".*"
12136 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12137 (name "User Name")
12138 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12139 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12140 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12141 ("^rec.humor"
12142 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12143 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12144 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12145 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12146 (signature my-news-signature))
12147 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12148 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12149 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12150 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12151 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12152 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12153 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12154 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12155 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12156 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12157 ("nnml:.*"
12158 (From (save-excursion
12159 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
12160 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12161 ("^nn.+:"
12162 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12163 @end lisp
12164
12165 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12166 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12167 if you fill many roles.
12168 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12169 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12170
12171 @node Drafts
12172 @section Drafts
12173 @cindex drafts
12174
12175 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12176 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12177 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12178 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12179 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12180
12181 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12182 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12183 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12184 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12185 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12186 group.)
12187
12188 @cindex nndraft
12189 @vindex nndraft-directory
12190 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12191 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12192 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12193 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12194 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12195 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12196
12197 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12198 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12199 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12200 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12201 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12202 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12203 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12204 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12205 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12206
12207 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12208 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12209 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12210 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12211 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12212 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12213 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12214 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12215 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12216 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12217 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12218 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12219 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12220 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12221 @c
12222 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12223 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12224 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12225
12226 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12227 @kindex D e (Draft)
12228 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12229 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12230 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12231
12232 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12233 Articles}).
12234
12235 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12236 @kindex D s (Draft)
12237 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12238 @kindex D S (Draft)
12239 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12240 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12241 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12242 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12243 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12244 in the buffer.
12245
12246 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12247 @kindex D t (Draft)
12248 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12249 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12250 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12251
12252
12253 @node Rejected Articles
12254 @section Rejected Articles
12255 @cindex rejected articles
12256
12257 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12258 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12259 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12260 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12261
12262 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12263 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12264 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12265 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12266 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12267
12268 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12269 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12270 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12271
12272 @node Signing and encrypting
12273 @section Signing and encrypting
12274 @cindex using gpg
12275 @cindex using s/mime
12276 @cindex using smime
12277
12278 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12279 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12280 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12281 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12282
12283 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12284 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12285 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12286 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12287 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12288 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12289 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12290 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12291 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12292 automatically encrypted messages.
12293
12294 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12295 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12296 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12297
12298 @table @kbd
12299
12300 @item C-c C-m s s
12301 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12302 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12303
12304 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12305
12306 @item C-c C-m s o
12307 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12308 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12309
12310 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12311
12312 @item C-c C-m s p
12313 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12314 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12315
12316 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12317
12318 @item C-c C-m c s
12319 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12320 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12321
12322 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12323
12324 @item C-c C-m c o
12325 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12326 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12327
12328 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12329
12330 @item C-c C-m c p
12331 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12332 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12333
12334 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12335
12336 @item C-c C-m C-n
12337 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12338 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12339 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12340
12341 @end table
12342
12343 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12344
12345 @node Select Methods
12346 @chapter Select Methods
12347 @cindex foreign groups
12348 @cindex select methods
12349
12350 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12351 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12352 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12353 personal mail group.
12354
12355 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12356 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12357 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12358 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12359 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12360 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12361
12362 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12363 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12364
12365 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12366 group as.
12367
12368 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12369 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12370 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12371 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12372 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12373
12374 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12375
12376 @menu
12377 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12378 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12379 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12380 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12381 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12382 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12383 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12384 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
12385 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12386 @end menu
12387
12388
12389 @node Server Buffer
12390 @section Server Buffer
12391
12392 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12393 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12394 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12395 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12396 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12397 back end represents a virtual server.
12398
12399 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12400 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12401 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12402 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12403
12404 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12405 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12406 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12407 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12408 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12409 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12410 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12411
12412 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12413 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12414
12415 @menu
12416 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12417 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12418 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12419 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12420 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12421 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12422 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12423 @end menu
12424
12425 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12426 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12427
12428
12429 @node Server Buffer Format
12430 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12431 @cindex server buffer format
12432
12433 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12434 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12435 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12436 variable, with some simple extensions:
12437
12438 @table @samp
12439
12440 @item h
12441 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12442
12443 @item n
12444 The name of this server.
12445
12446 @item w
12447 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12448
12449 @item s
12450 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12451
12452 @item a
12453 Whether this server is agentized.
12454 @end table
12455
12456 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12457 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12458 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12459 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12460
12461 @table @samp
12462 @item S
12463 Server name.
12464
12465 @item M
12466 Server method.
12467 @end table
12468
12469 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12470
12471
12472 @node Server Commands
12473 @subsection Server Commands
12474 @cindex server commands
12475
12476 @table @kbd
12477
12478 @item v
12479 @kindex v (Server)
12480 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
12481 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12482 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12483
12484 @item a
12485 @kindex a (Server)
12486 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12487 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12488
12489 @item e
12490 @kindex e (Server)
12491 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12492 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12493
12494 @item SPACE
12495 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12496 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12497 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12498
12499 @item q
12500 @kindex q (Server)
12501 @findex gnus-server-exit
12502 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12503
12504 @item k
12505 @kindex k (Server)
12506 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12507 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12508
12509 @item y
12510 @kindex y (Server)
12511 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12512 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12513
12514 @item c
12515 @kindex c (Server)
12516 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12517 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12518
12519 @item l
12520 @kindex l (Server)
12521 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12522 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12523
12524 @item s
12525 @kindex s (Server)
12526 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12527 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12528 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12529 servers.
12530
12531 @item g
12532 @kindex g (Server)
12533 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12534 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12535 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12536 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12537
12538 @end table
12539
12540
12541 @node Example Methods
12542 @subsection Example Methods
12543
12544 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12545
12546 @lisp
12547 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12548 @end lisp
12549
12550 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12551
12552 @lisp
12553 (nnspool "")
12554 @end lisp
12555
12556 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12557 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12558 will.
12559
12560 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12561 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12562
12563 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12564 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12565 look like then:
12566
12567 @lisp
12568 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12569 @end lisp
12570
12571 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12572 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12573
12574 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12575 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12576 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12577 your private mail:
12578
12579 @lisp
12580 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12581 @end lisp
12582
12583 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12584 that.)
12585
12586 Here's the method for a public spool:
12587
12588 @lisp
12589 (nnmh "public"
12590 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12591 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12592 @end lisp
12593
12594 @cindex proxy
12595 @cindex firewall
12596
12597 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12598 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12599 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12600 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12601 should probably look something like this:
12602
12603 @lisp
12604 (nntp "firewall"
12605 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12606 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12607 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12608 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12609 @end lisp
12610
12611 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12612 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12613 configuration to the example above:
12614
12615 @lisp
12616 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12617 @end lisp
12618
12619 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12620
12621 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12622 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12623 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12624
12625 @lisp
12626 (nntp "outside"
12627 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12628 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12629 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12630 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12631 @end lisp
12632
12633 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12634 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12635 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12636 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12637
12638
12639 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12640 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12641
12642 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12643 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12644
12645 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12646 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12647 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12648
12649 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12650
12651 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12652 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12653 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12654 will contain the following:
12655
12656 @lisp
12657 (nnml "cache")
12658 @end lisp
12659
12660 Change that to:
12661
12662 @lisp
12663 (nnml "cache"
12664 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12665 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12666 @end lisp
12667
12668 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12669 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12670 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12671
12672
12673 @node Server Variables
12674 @subsection Server Variables
12675 @cindex server variables
12676 @cindex server parameters
12677
12678 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12679 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12680 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12681 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12682 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12683
12684 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12685 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12686 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12687 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12688 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12689 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12690 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12691 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12692 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12693
12694 @lisp
12695 (nnml "public"
12696 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12697 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12698 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12699 @end lisp
12700
12701 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12702
12703 @node Servers and Methods
12704 @subsection Servers and Methods
12705
12706 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12707 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12708 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12709 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12710 over.
12711
12712
12713 @node Unavailable Servers
12714 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12715
12716 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12717 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12718 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12719 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12720 actually the case or not.
12721
12722 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12723 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12724 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12725 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12726 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12727 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12728 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12729 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12730
12731 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12732 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12733
12734 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12735 with the following commands:
12736
12737 @table @kbd
12738
12739 @item O
12740 @kindex O (Server)
12741 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12742 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12743 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12744
12745 @item C
12746 @kindex C (Server)
12747 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12748 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12749 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12750
12751 @item D
12752 @kindex D (Server)
12753 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12754 Mark the current server as unreachable
12755 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12756
12757 @item M-o
12758 @kindex M-o (Server)
12759 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12760 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12761 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12762
12763 @item M-c
12764 @kindex M-c (Server)
12765 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12766 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12767 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12768
12769 @item R
12770 @kindex R (Server)
12771 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12772 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12773 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12774
12775 @item L
12776 @kindex L (Server)
12777 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12778 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12779
12780 @end table
12781
12782
12783 @node Getting News
12784 @section Getting News
12785 @cindex reading news
12786 @cindex news back ends
12787
12788 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12789 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12790 or it can read from a local spool.
12791
12792 @menu
12793 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12794 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12795 @end menu
12796
12797
12798 @node NNTP
12799 @subsection NNTP
12800 @cindex nntp
12801
12802 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12803 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12804 server as the, uhm, address.
12805
12806 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12807 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12808 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12809 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12810
12811 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12812 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12813 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12814
12815 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12816 server:
12817
12818 @table @code
12819
12820 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12821 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12822 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12823 @cindex authinfo
12824 @cindex authentication
12825 @cindex nntp authentication
12826 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12827 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12828 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12829 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12830 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12831 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12832 present in this hook.
12833
12834 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12835 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12836 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12837 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12838 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12839 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12840 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12841 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12842 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12843 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12844 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12845 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12846
12847 @enumerate
12848 @item
12849 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12850
12851 @item
12852 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12853
12854 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12855 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12856 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12857 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12858 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12859 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12860 @samp{force} is explained below.
12861
12862 @end enumerate
12863
12864 Here's an example file:
12865
12866 @example
12867 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12868 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12869 @end example
12870
12871 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12872 have to be first, for instance.
12873
12874 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12875 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12876 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12877 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12878 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12879 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12880 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12881
12882 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12883 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12884
12885 @example
12886 default force yes
12887 @end example
12888
12889 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12890 previously mentioned.
12891
12892 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12893
12894 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12895 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12896 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12897 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12898 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12899
12900 @lisp
12901 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12902 '(("innd" (ding))))
12903 @end lisp
12904
12905 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12906
12907 The default value is
12908
12909 @lisp
12910 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12911 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12912 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12913 @end lisp
12914
12915 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12916 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12917
12918 @item nntp-maximum-request
12919 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12920 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12921 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12922 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12923 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12924 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12925 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12926
12927 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12928 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12929 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12930 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12931 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12932 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12933 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12934 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12935 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12936 no timeouts are done.
12937
12938 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12939 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12940 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12941 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12942 can be used.
12943
12944 @item nntp-xover-commands
12945 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12946 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12947 @cindex XOVER
12948 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12949 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12950 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12951
12952 @item nntp-nov-gap
12953 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12954 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12955 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12956 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12957 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12958 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12959 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12960 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12961 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12962 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12963 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12964
12965 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
12966 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
12967 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
12968 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
12969 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
12970 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
12971 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
12972 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
12973 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
12974 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
12975 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
12976 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
12977 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
12978 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
12979 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
12980 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
12981 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
12982
12983 @lisp
12984 (setq gnus-select-method
12985 '(nntp "newszilla"
12986 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
12987 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
12988 @dots{}))
12989 @end lisp
12990
12991 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
12992
12993 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12994 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12995 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12996
12997 @item nntp-record-commands
12998 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12999 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13000 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13001 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13002 that doesn't seem to work.
13003
13004 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13005 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13006 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13007 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13008 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13009 Six pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
13010 two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13011 indirect ones (two pre-made).
13012
13013 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13014 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13015 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13016 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13017 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13018 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13019 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13020 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13021 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13022
13023 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13024 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13025 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13026 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13027 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13028 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13029 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13030
13031 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13032 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13033 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13034 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13035 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13036 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13037 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13038
13039 @lisp
13040 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13041 @end lisp
13042
13043 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
13044 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13045
13046 @end table
13047
13048 @menu
13049 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13050 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13051 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13052 @end menu
13053
13054
13055 @node Direct Functions
13056 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13057 @cindex direct connection functions
13058
13059 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13060 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13061 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13062 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13063
13064 @table @code
13065 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13066 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13067 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13068 remote system.
13069
13070 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13071 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13072 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13073 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
13074 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13075
13076 @lisp
13077 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13078 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13079 ;;
13080 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13081 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13082 (nntp-port-number )
13083 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13084 @end lisp
13085
13086 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13087 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13088 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13089 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13090 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13091 then define a server as follows:
13092
13093 @lisp
13094 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13095 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13096 ;;
13097 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13098 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13099 (nntp-port-number 563)
13100 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13101 @end lisp
13102
13103 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13104 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13105 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
13106 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
13107 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13108 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13109 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13110 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13111
13112 @lisp
13113 (nntp "socksified"
13114 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13115 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13116 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13117 @end lisp
13118
13119 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13120 session, which is not a good idea.
13121 @end table
13122
13123
13124 @node Indirect Functions
13125 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13126 @cindex indirect connection functions
13127
13128 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13129 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13130 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13131 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13132 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13133 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13134
13135 @table @code
13136 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13137 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13138 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
13139 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13140 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13141
13142 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13143
13144 @table @code
13145 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13146 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13147 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13148 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13149
13150 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13151 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13152 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13153 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13154 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13155 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
13156 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13157 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13158 host.
13159 @end table
13160
13161 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13162 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13163 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13164 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13165
13166 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13167
13168 @table @code
13169 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13170 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13171 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13172 @samp{telnet}.
13173
13174 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13175 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13176 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13177 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13178
13179 @item nntp-via-user-password
13180 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13181 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13182
13183 @item nntp-via-envuser
13184 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13185 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13186 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13187 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13188
13189 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13190 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13191 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13192 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13193
13194 @end table
13195
13196 @end table
13197
13198
13199 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13200 functions:
13201
13202 @table @code
13203
13204 @item nntp-via-user-name
13205 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13206 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13207
13208 @item nntp-via-address
13209 @vindex nntp-via-address
13210 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13211
13212 @end table
13213
13214
13215 @node Common Variables
13216 @subsubsection Common Variables
13217
13218 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13219 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13220 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13221 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13222 variables individually).
13223
13224 @table @code
13225
13226 @item nntp-pre-command
13227 @vindex nntp-pre-command
13228 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
13229 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
13230 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
13231 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
13232
13233 @item nntp-address
13234 @vindex nntp-address
13235 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13236
13237 @item nntp-port-number
13238 @vindex nntp-port-number
13239 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13240 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
13241 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
13242 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
13243 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
13244 not work with named ports.
13245
13246 @item nntp-end-of-line
13247 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
13248 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
13249 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
13250 using a non native connection function.
13251
13252 @item nntp-telnet-command
13253 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13254 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
13255 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
13256 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13257 @samp{telnet}.
13258
13259 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13260 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13261 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
13262 is @samp{("-8")}.
13263
13264 @end table
13265
13266
13267 @node News Spool
13268 @subsection News Spool
13269 @cindex nnspool
13270 @cindex news spool
13271
13272 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13273 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13274 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13275 instance.
13276
13277 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13278 anything else) as the address.
13279
13280 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13281 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13282 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13283 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13284
13285 @table @code
13286
13287 @item nnspool-inews-program
13288 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13289 Program used to post an article.
13290
13291 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13292 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13293 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13294
13295 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13296 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13297 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13298 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13299
13300 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13301 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13302 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13303 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13304
13305 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13306 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13307 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13308
13309 @item nnspool-active-file
13310 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13311 The name of the active file.
13312
13313 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13314 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13315 The name of the group descriptions file.
13316
13317 @item nnspool-history-file
13318 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13319 The name of the news history file.
13320
13321 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13322 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13323 The name of the active date file.
13324
13325 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13326 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13327 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13328 that it finds.
13329
13330 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13331 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13332 @cindex sed
13333 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13334 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13335 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13336 there.
13337
13338 @end table
13339
13340
13341 @node Getting Mail
13342 @section Getting Mail
13343 @cindex reading mail
13344 @cindex mail
13345
13346 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13347 course.
13348
13349 @menu
13350 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13351 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13352 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13353 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13354 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13355 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13356 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13357 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13358 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13359 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13360 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13361 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13362 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13363 @end menu
13364
13365
13366 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13367 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13368
13369 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13370 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13371 of a culture shock.
13372
13373 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13374 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13375
13376 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13377 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13378 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13379 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13380
13381 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13382
13383 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13384 deleted? How awful!
13385
13386 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13387 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13388 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13389 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13390 Mail}.
13391
13392 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13393 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13394 they want to treat a message.
13395
13396 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13397 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13398 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13399 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13400 archived somewhere else.
13401
13402 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13403 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13404 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13405 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13406 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13407
13408 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13409 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13410 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13411
13412 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13413 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13414 differently.
13415
13416 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13417 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13418 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13419 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13420 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13421
13422 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13423 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13424 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13425 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13426 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13427 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13428 You Do.)
13429
13430
13431 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13432 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13433
13434 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13435 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13436 and things will happen automatically.
13437
13438 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13439 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13440
13441 @lisp
13442 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13443 @end lisp
13444
13445 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13446 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13447 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13448 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13449 like any other group.
13450
13451 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13452
13453 @lisp
13454 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13455 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13456 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13457 ("other" "")))
13458 @end lisp
13459
13460 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13461 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13462 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13463 last group.
13464
13465 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13466 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13467 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13468
13469
13470 @node Splitting Mail
13471 @subsection Splitting Mail
13472 @cindex splitting mail
13473 @cindex mail splitting
13474 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13475
13476 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13477 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13478 to be split into groups.
13479
13480 @lisp
13481 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13482 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13483 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13484 ("mail.other" "")))
13485 @end lisp
13486
13487 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13488 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13489 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13490 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13491 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13492 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13493 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13494
13495 @lisp
13496 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13497 @end lisp
13498
13499 @noindent
13500 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13501 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13502
13503 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13504 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13505 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13506 mail belongs in that group.
13507
13508 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13509 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13510 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13511 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13512 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13513 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13514 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13515 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13516 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13517 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13518
13519 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13520 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13521 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13522 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13523 thinks should carry this mail message.
13524
13525 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13526 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13527 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13528 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13529
13530 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13531 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13532 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13533 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13534 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13535
13536 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13537 @cindex crosspost
13538 @cindex links
13539 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13540 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13541 links. If that's the case for you, set
13542 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13543 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13544
13545 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13546 @findex nnmail-split-history
13547 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13548 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13549 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13550 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13551 Group Commands}).
13552
13553 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13554 Header lines longer than the value of
13555 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13556 function.
13557
13558 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13559 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13560 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
13561 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
13562 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
13563 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
13564 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
13565 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
13566 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
13567 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
13568 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
13569 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
13570
13571 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13572 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13573 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13574 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13575 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13576 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13577 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13578 other kinds of entries.)
13579
13580 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13581 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13582 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13583 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13584 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13585 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13586 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13587 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13588 month's rent money.
13589
13590
13591 @node Mail Sources
13592 @subsection Mail Sources
13593
13594 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13595 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13596 maildir, for instance.
13597
13598 @menu
13599 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13600 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13601 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13602 @end menu
13603
13604
13605 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13606 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13607 @cindex POP
13608 @cindex mail server
13609 @cindex procmail
13610 @cindex mail spool
13611 @cindex mail source
13612
13613 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13614 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13615
13616 Here's an example:
13617
13618 @lisp
13619 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13620 @end lisp
13621
13622 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13623 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13624 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13625 default values.
13626
13627 The following mail source types are available:
13628
13629 @table @code
13630 @item file
13631 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13632
13633 Keywords:
13634
13635 @table @code
13636 @item :path
13637 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13638 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13639 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13640
13641 @item :prescript
13642 @itemx :postscript
13643 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13644 @end table
13645
13646 An example file mail source:
13647
13648 @lisp
13649 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13650 @end lisp
13651
13652 Or using the default file name:
13653
13654 @lisp
13655 (file)
13656 @end lisp
13657
13658 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13659 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13660 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13661 mail spool while moving the mail.
13662
13663 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13664
13665 @lisp
13666 (setq mail-sources
13667 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13668 @end lisp
13669
13670 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13671
13672 @example
13673 #!/bin/sh
13674 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13675 # flu@@iki.fi
13676
13677 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13678 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13679 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13680 @end example
13681
13682 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
13683 file you want to use.
13684
13685
13686 @item directory
13687 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13688 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13689 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13690 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13691 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13692 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13693 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13694 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13695 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13696 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13697
13698 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13699 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13700 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13701 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13702
13703 Keywords:
13704
13705 @table @code
13706 @item :path
13707 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13708 value.
13709
13710 @item :suffix
13711 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13712 @samp{.spool}.
13713
13714 @item :predicate
13715 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13716 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13717 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13718 predicate are considered.
13719
13720 @item :prescript
13721 @itemx :postscript
13722 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13723
13724 @end table
13725
13726 An example directory mail source:
13727
13728 @lisp
13729 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13730 :suffix ".prcml")
13731 @end lisp
13732
13733 @item pop
13734 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13735
13736 Keywords:
13737
13738 @table @code
13739 @item :server
13740 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13741 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13742
13743 @item :port
13744 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13745 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13746 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13747 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13748 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13749
13750 @item :user
13751 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13752 name.
13753
13754 @item :password
13755 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13756 the user is prompted.
13757
13758 @item :program
13759 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13760 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13761
13762 @example
13763 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13764 @end example
13765
13766 The valid format specifier characters are:
13767
13768 @table @samp
13769 @item t
13770 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13771 included in this string.
13772
13773 @item s
13774 The name of the server.
13775
13776 @item P
13777 The port number of the server.
13778
13779 @item u
13780 The user name to use.
13781
13782 @item p
13783 The password to use.
13784 @end table
13785
13786 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13787 corresponding keywords.
13788
13789 @item :prescript
13790 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13791 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13792
13793 @item :postscript
13794 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13795 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13796
13797 @item :function
13798 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13799 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13800 mail should be moved to.
13801
13802 @item :authentication
13803 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13804 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13805 @code{password}.
13806
13807 @end table
13808
13809 @vindex pop3-movemail
13810 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13811 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13812 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
13813 is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
13814 after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
13815 maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
13816 believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
13817 do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
13818 apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13819
13820 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13821 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
13822 name, and default fetcher:
13823
13824 @lisp
13825 (pop)
13826 @end lisp
13827
13828 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13829
13830 @lisp
13831 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13832 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13833 @end lisp
13834
13835 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13836
13837 @lisp
13838 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13839 @end lisp
13840
13841 @item maildir
13842 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13843 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13844 contains exactly one mail.
13845
13846 Keywords:
13847
13848 @table @code
13849 @item :path
13850 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13851 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13852 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13853 @item :subdirs
13854 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13855 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13856
13857 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13858 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13859 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13860 @c below.
13861
13862 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13863 from locking problems).
13864
13865 @end table
13866
13867 Two example maildir mail sources:
13868
13869 @lisp
13870 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13871 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13872 @end lisp
13873
13874 @lisp
13875 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13876 :subdirs ("new"))
13877 @end lisp
13878
13879 @item imap
13880 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13881 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13882 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13883 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13884 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13885
13886 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13887 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13888
13889 Keywords:
13890
13891 @table @code
13892 @item :server
13893 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13894 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13895
13896 @item :port
13897 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13898 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13899
13900 @item :user
13901 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13902 name.
13903
13904 @item :password
13905 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13906 prompted.
13907
13908 @item :stream
13909 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13910 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13911 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13912 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13913
13914 @item :authentication
13915 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13916 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13917 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13918 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13919
13920 @item :program
13921 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13922 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13923 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13924
13925 @example
13926 ssh %s imapd
13927 @end example
13928
13929 The valid format specifier characters are:
13930
13931 @table @samp
13932 @item s
13933 The name of the server.
13934
13935 @item l
13936 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13937
13938 @item p
13939 The port number of the server.
13940 @end table
13941
13942 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13943 corresponding keywords.
13944
13945 @item :mailbox
13946 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13947 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13948
13949 @item :predicate
13950 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13951 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13952 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13953 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13954 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13955 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13956
13957 @item :fetchflag
13958 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13959 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13960 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13961 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13962
13963 @item :dontexpunge
13964 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13965 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13966
13967 @end table
13968
13969 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13970
13971 @lisp
13972 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13973 :stream kerberos4
13974 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13975 @end lisp
13976
13977 @item webmail
13978 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13979 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13980 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13981
13982 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13983 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13984
13985 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13986
13987 Keywords:
13988
13989 @table @code
13990 @item :subtype
13991 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13992 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13993
13994 @item :user
13995 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13996 name.
13997
13998 @item :password
13999 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
14000 prompted.
14001
14002 @item :dontexpunge
14003 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
14004 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
14005
14006 @end table
14007
14008 An example webmail source:
14009
14010 @lisp
14011 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
14012 :user "user-name"
14013 :password "secret")
14014 @end lisp
14015 @end table
14016
14017 @table @dfn
14018 @item Common Keywords
14019 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
14020
14021 Keywords:
14022
14023 @table @code
14024 @item :plugged
14025 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
14026 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
14027 example:
14028
14029 @lisp
14030 (setq mail-sources
14031 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
14032 :suffix ""
14033 :plugged t)))
14034 @end lisp
14035
14036 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
14037 useful when you use local mail and news.
14038
14039 @end table
14040 @end table
14041
14042 @subsubsection Function Interface
14043
14044 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
14045 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
14046 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
14047 consider the following mail-source setting:
14048
14049 @lisp
14050 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
14051 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
14052 @end lisp
14053
14054 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
14055 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
14056 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
14057 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
14058 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
14059
14060 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
14061
14062
14063 @node Mail Source Customization
14064 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
14065
14066 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
14067 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
14068 variables.
14069
14070 @table @code
14071 @item mail-source-crash-box
14072 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
14073 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
14074 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
14075
14076 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
14077 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
14078 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
14079 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
14080 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
14081 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
14082 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
14083 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
14084
14085 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
14086 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
14087 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
14088 files. This variable only applies when
14089 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
14090
14091 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
14092 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
14093 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
14094
14095 @item mail-source-directory
14096 @vindex mail-source-directory
14097 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
14098 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
14099 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
14100 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
14101
14102 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
14103 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
14104 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
14105 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
14106 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
14107 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
14108 number.
14109
14110 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
14111 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
14112 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
14113
14114 @item mail-source-movemail-program
14115 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
14116 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
14117 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
14118
14119 @end table
14120
14121
14122 @node Fetching Mail
14123 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
14124
14125 @vindex mail-sources
14126 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
14127 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
14128 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
14129 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
14130
14131 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
14132 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
14133 themselves.
14134
14135 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
14136 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
14137
14138 @lisp
14139 (setq mail-sources
14140 '((file)
14141 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
14142 :password "secret")))
14143 @end lisp
14144
14145 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
14146
14147 @lisp
14148 (setq mail-sources
14149 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
14150 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
14151 :user "user-name"
14152 :port "pop3"
14153 :password "secret")))
14154 @end lisp
14155
14156
14157 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
14158 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
14159 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
14160 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
14161 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
14162 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
14163
14164
14165
14166 @node Mail Back End Variables
14167 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
14168
14169 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
14170 mail back ends.
14171
14172 @table @code
14173 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
14174 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
14175 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
14176 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
14177
14178 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
14179 @item nnmail-split-hook
14180 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
14181 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
14182 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
14183 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
14184 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
14185 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
14186 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
14187 in the buffer will show up in any files.
14188 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
14189 to this hook.
14190
14191 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14192 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14193 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14194 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14195 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
14196 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
14197 starting to handle the new mail) and
14198 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
14199 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
14200 default file modes the new mail files get:
14201
14202 @lisp
14203 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14204 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
14205
14206 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14207 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
14208 @end lisp
14209
14210 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
14211 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
14212 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
14213 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
14214 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
14215 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
14216 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
14217
14218 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
14219 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
14220 @findex delete-file
14221 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
14222
14223 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14224 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14225 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
14226 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
14227 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
14228
14229 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14230 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14231 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
14232 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
14233 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
14234
14235 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
14236 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
14237 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
14238
14239 @end table
14240
14241
14242 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
14243 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
14244 @cindex mail splitting
14245 @cindex fancy mail splitting
14246
14247 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
14248 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
14249 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
14250 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
14251 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
14252 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
14253
14254 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
14255
14256 @lisp
14257 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
14258 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
14259 ;; @r{from real errors.}
14260 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
14261 "mail.misc"))
14262 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
14263 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
14264 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
14265 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
14266 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
14267 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
14268 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
14269 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
14270 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
14271 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
14272 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
14273 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
14274 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
14275 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14276 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14277 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14278 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14279 "misc.misc")
14280 @end lisp
14281
14282 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14283 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14284 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14285
14286 @table @code
14287
14288 @item group
14289 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14290 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14291
14292 @c Don't fold this line.
14293 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
14294 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
14295 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
14296 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
14297 @var{split}.
14298
14299 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
14300 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
14301 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
14302 @var{split} is processed.
14303
14304 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
14305 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
14306 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
14307 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14308
14309 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14310 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14311 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14312 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14313 stored in one or more groups.
14314
14315 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14316 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14317 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14318
14319 @item junk
14320 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14321 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14322
14323 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14324 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14325 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14326 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14327
14328 @cindex body split
14329 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14330 body of the messages:
14331
14332 @lisp
14333 (defun split-on-body ()
14334 (save-excursion
14335 (save-restriction
14336 (widen)
14337 (goto-char (point-min))
14338 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14339 "string.group"))))
14340 @end lisp
14341
14342 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14343 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14344 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14345 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14346 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14347 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14348 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14349
14350 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14351 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14352 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14353 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14354 should return a split.
14355
14356 @item nil
14357 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14358
14359 @end table
14360
14361 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14362
14363 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
14364 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
14365 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
14366 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
14367 for example,
14368
14369 @example
14370 (any "joe" "joemail")
14371 @end example
14372
14373 @noindent
14374 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
14375 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
14376 of the following three ways:
14377
14378 @enumerate
14379 @item
14380 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14381 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
14382 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
14383 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
14384 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
14385 @code{nil}.
14386
14387 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
14388
14389 @item
14390 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
14391 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
14392 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
14393 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
14394 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
14395
14396 @item
14397 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
14398 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
14399 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
14400 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14401 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
14402 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14403 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14404 @end enumerate
14405
14406 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14407 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14408 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14409 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14410 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14411 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14412 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14413
14414 @table @code
14415 @item from
14416 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14417 @item to
14418 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14419 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14420 @item any
14421 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14422 @end table
14423
14424 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14425 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14426 when all this splitting is performed.
14427
14428 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14429 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14430 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14431
14432 @example
14433 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14434 @end example
14435
14436 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14437 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14438
14439 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14440 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14441 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14442 groupings 1 through 9.
14443
14444 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14445 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14446 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14447 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14448 groups when users send to an address using different case
14449 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14450 is @code{t}.
14451
14452 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14453 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14454 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14455 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14456 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14457 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14458 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14459 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14460 it once per thread.
14461
14462 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14463 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14464 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14465 using the colon feature, like so:
14466 @lisp
14467 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14468 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14469 nnmail-split-fancy
14470 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14471 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14472 ))
14473 @end lisp
14474
14475 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14476 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14477 in the file specified by the variable
14478 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14479 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14480 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14481 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14482 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14483 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14484 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14485 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14486 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14487 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14488 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14489 300 kBytes in size.)
14490 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14491 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14492 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14493 messages goes into the new group.
14494
14495 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14496 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14497 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14498 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14499 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14500 ``outgoing'' group.
14501
14502
14503 @node Group Mail Splitting
14504 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14505 @cindex mail splitting
14506 @cindex group mail splitting
14507
14508 @findex gnus-group-split
14509 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14510 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14511 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14512 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14513 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14514 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14515 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14516 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14517
14518 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14519 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14520 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14521 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14522
14523 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14524 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14525 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14526 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14527 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14528 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14529 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14530
14531 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14532 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14533 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14534 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14535 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14536 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14537 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14538
14539 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14540 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14541 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14542 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14543 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14544 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14545 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14546 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14547 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14548 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14549 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14550 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14551 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14552
14553 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14554 been defined:
14555
14556 @example
14557 nnml:mail.bar:
14558 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14559 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14560 nnml:mail.foo:
14561 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14562 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14563 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14564 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14565 nnml:mail.others:
14566 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14567 @end example
14568
14569 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14570 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14571 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14572
14573 @lisp
14574 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14575 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14576 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14577 "mail.others")
14578 @end lisp
14579
14580 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14581 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14582 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14583 splits like this:
14584
14585 @lisp
14586 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14587 @end lisp
14588
14589 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14590 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14591 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14592 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14593 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14594 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14595 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14596 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14597 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14598
14599 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14600 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14601 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14602 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14603 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14604 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14605 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14606 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14607 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14608
14609 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14610 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14611 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14612 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14613 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14614 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14615
14616 @lisp
14617 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14618 @end lisp
14619
14620 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14621 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14622 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14623 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14624 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14625 value.
14626
14627 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14628 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14629 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14630 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14631
14632 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14633 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14634 @cindex incorporating old mail
14635 @cindex import old mail
14636
14637 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14638 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14639 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14640 your mail groups.
14641
14642 Doing so can be quite easy.
14643
14644 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14645 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14646 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14647 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14648 your @code{nnml} groups.
14649
14650 Here's how:
14651
14652 @enumerate
14653 @item
14654 Go to the group buffer.
14655
14656 @item
14657 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14658 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14659
14660 @item
14661 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14662
14663 @item
14664 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14665 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14666
14667 @item
14668 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14669 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14670 @end enumerate
14671
14672 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14673 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14674 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14675 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14676 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14677
14678 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14679 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14680 using the new mail back end.
14681
14682
14683 @node Expiring Mail
14684 @subsection Expiring Mail
14685 @cindex article expiry
14686 @cindex expiring mail
14687
14688 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14689 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14690 different approach to mail reading.
14691
14692 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14693 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14694 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14695 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14696 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14697 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14698 course.
14699
14700 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14701 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14702 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14703 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14704 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14705 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14706 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14707 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14708 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14709
14710 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14711 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14712 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14713 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14714 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14715 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14716 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14717 expirable.
14718
14719 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14720 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14721 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14722 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14723 into its own group.)
14724
14725 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14726 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14727 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14728 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14729 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14730 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14731 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14732 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14733 scoring.
14734
14735 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14736 Groups that match the regular expression
14737 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14738 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14739 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14740
14741 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14742 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14743 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14744 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14745 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14746
14747 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14748 @lisp
14749 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14750 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14751 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14752 @end lisp
14753
14754 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14755 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14756 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14757 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14758 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14759
14760 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14761 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14762
14763 @lisp
14764 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14765 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14766 @end lisp
14767
14768 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14769 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14770
14771 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14772 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14773 don't really mix very well.
14774
14775 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14776 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14777 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14778 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14779 days.
14780
14781 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14782 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14783 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14784 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14785 everywhere else:
14786
14787 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14788 @lisp
14789 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14790 (lambda (group)
14791 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14792 31)
14793 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14794 1)
14795 ((string= group "important")
14796 'never)
14797 (t
14798 6))))
14799 @end lisp
14800
14801 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14802 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14803
14804 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14805 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14806 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14807 @code{never}.
14808
14809 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14810 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14811
14812 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14813 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14814 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14815 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14816 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14817 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14818 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14819 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14820 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14821 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14822 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14823 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14824 name or @code{delete}.
14825
14826 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14827 @lisp
14828 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14829 @end lisp
14830
14831 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14832 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14833 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14834 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14835 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14836
14837 @lisp
14838 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14839 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14840 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14841 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14842 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14843 @end lisp
14844
14845 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14846 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14847 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14848 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14849 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14850 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14851
14852 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14853 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14854 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14855 easier for procmail users.
14856
14857 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14858 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14859 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14860 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14861 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14862 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14863 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14864 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14865 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14866 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14867 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14868 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14869 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14870 with! So there!
14871
14872 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14873
14874 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14875 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14876 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14877 auto-expire turned on.
14878
14879
14880 @node Washing Mail
14881 @subsection Washing Mail
14882 @cindex mail washing
14883 @cindex list server brain damage
14884 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14885
14886 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14887 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14888 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14889 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14890 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14891 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14892
14893 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14894 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14895 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14896 laugh.
14897
14898 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14899 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14900 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14901 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14902
14903 @table @code
14904 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14905 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14906 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14907 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14908 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14909
14910 @table @code
14911 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14912 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14913 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14914 Emacs running on MS machines.
14915
14916 @end table
14917
14918 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14919 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14920 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14921 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14922
14923 @table @code
14924 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14925 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14926 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14927 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14928
14929 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14930 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14931 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14932 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14933 into a feature by documenting it.)
14934
14935 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14936 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14937 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14938 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14939 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14940 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14941 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14942 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14943
14944 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14945 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14946
14947 @lisp
14948 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14949 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14950 @end lisp
14951
14952 This can also be done non-destructively with
14953 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14954
14955 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14956 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14957 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14958
14959 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14960 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14961 @cindex Eudora
14962 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14963 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14964 @code{References} headers.
14965
14966 @end table
14967
14968 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14969 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14970 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14971 include:
14972
14973 @table @code
14974 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14975 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14976 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14977
14978 @end table
14979 @end table
14980
14981
14982 @node Duplicates
14983 @subsection Duplicates
14984
14985 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14986 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14987 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14988 @cindex duplicate mails
14989 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14990 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14991 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14992 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14993 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14994 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14995 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14996 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14997 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14998 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14999 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
15000 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
15001 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
15002
15003 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
15004 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
15005 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
15006 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
15007
15008 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
15009 @code{nil}.
15010
15011 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
15012 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
15013 methods:
15014
15015 @lisp
15016 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
15017 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
15018 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
15019 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
15020 (any mail "mail.misc")
15021 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15022 [...] ))
15023 @end lisp
15024 @noindent
15025 Or something like:
15026 @lisp
15027 (setq nnmail-split-methods
15028 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
15029 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15030 [...]))
15031 @end lisp
15032
15033 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
15034 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
15035 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
15036 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
15037 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
15038
15039
15040 @node Not Reading Mail
15041 @subsection Not Reading Mail
15042
15043 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
15044 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
15045 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
15046
15047 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
15048 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
15049 mail, which should help.
15050
15051 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15052 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15053 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15054 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15055 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15056 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
15057 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
15058 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
15059 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
15060 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
15061 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
15062
15063 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
15064 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
15065 incoming mail.
15066
15067
15068 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
15069 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
15070
15071 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
15072 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
15073 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
15074
15075 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
15076 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
15077 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
15078 Spool}).
15079
15080 @menu
15081 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
15082 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
15083 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
15084 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
15085 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
15086 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
15087 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
15088 @end menu
15089
15090
15091 @node Unix Mail Box
15092 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
15093 @cindex nnmbox
15094 @cindex unix mail box
15095
15096 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
15097 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
15098 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
15099 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
15100 which group it belongs in.
15101
15102 Virtual server settings:
15103
15104 @table @code
15105 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
15106 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
15107 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
15108 @file{~/mbox}.
15109
15110 @item nnmbox-active-file
15111 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
15112 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
15113 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
15114
15115 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
15116 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15117 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
15118 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
15119 @end table
15120
15121
15122 @node Rmail Babyl
15123 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
15124 @cindex nnbabyl
15125 @cindex Rmail mbox
15126
15127 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
15128 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
15129 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
15130 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
15131 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
15132
15133 Virtual server settings:
15134
15135 @table @code
15136 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
15137 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
15138 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
15139
15140 @item nnbabyl-active-file
15141 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
15142 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
15143 @file{~/.rmail-active}
15144
15145 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15146 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15147 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
15148 @code{t}
15149 @end table
15150
15151
15152 @node Mail Spool
15153 @subsubsection Mail Spool
15154 @cindex nnml
15155 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
15156
15157 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
15158 format. It should be used with some caution.
15159
15160 @vindex nnml-directory
15161 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
15162 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
15163 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
15164 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
15165
15166 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
15167 care of all that.
15168
15169 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
15170 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
15171 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
15172 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
15173 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
15174 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
15175 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
15176 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
15177
15178 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
15179 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
15180 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
15181 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
15182
15183 @cindex self contained nnml servers
15184 @cindex marks
15185 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
15186 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15187 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15188 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
15189 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
15190 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
15191 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
15192 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
15193 directory).
15194
15195 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
15196 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
15197 them next time it starts.
15198
15199 Virtual server settings:
15200
15201 @table @code
15202 @item nnml-directory
15203 @vindex nnml-directory
15204 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
15205 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
15206 is @file{~/Mail}).
15207
15208 @item nnml-active-file
15209 @vindex nnml-active-file
15210 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
15211 @file{~/Mail/active}.
15212
15213 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
15214 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
15215 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15216 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
15217
15218 @item nnml-get-new-mail
15219 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15220 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
15221 @code{t}.
15222
15223 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
15224 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
15225 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15226 default is @code{nil}.
15227
15228 @item nnml-nov-file-name
15229 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
15230 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
15231
15232 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15233 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15234 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
15235
15236 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
15237 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
15238 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15239 default is @code{nil}.
15240
15241 @item nnml-marks-file-name
15242 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
15243 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
15244
15245 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
15246 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
15247 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
15248 files.
15249
15250 @end table
15251
15252 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
15253 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
15254 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
15255 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
15256 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
15257 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
15258 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
15259 Commands}).
15260
15261
15262 @node MH Spool
15263 @subsubsection MH Spool
15264 @cindex nnmh
15265 @cindex mh-e mail spool
15266
15267 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
15268 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
15269 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
15270 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
15271 for.
15272
15273 Virtual server settings:
15274
15275 @table @code
15276 @item nnmh-directory
15277 @vindex nnmh-directory
15278 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
15279 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
15280 @file{~/Mail})
15281
15282 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
15283 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15284 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
15285 @code{t}.
15286
15287 @item nnmh-be-safe
15288 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
15289 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
15290 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
15291 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
15292 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
15293 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
15294 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
15295 @end table
15296
15297
15298 @node Maildir
15299 @subsubsection Maildir
15300 @cindex nnmaildir
15301 @cindex maildir
15302
15303 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15304 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15305 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15306 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15307 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15308 within a maildir.
15309
15310 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15311 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15312 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15313 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15314 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15315 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15316 that appear as group in Gnus.
15317
15318 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15319 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15320 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15321
15322 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15323 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15324 another, and you will keep your marks.
15325
15326 Virtual server settings:
15327
15328 @table @code
15329 @item directory
15330 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15331 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15332 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15333 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15334 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15335 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15336 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15337 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15338 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15339 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15340
15341 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15342 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15343 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15344 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15345 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15346 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15347 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15348 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15349 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15350 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15351 value.
15352
15353 @item target-prefix
15354 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15355 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15356 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15357 closed.
15358
15359 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15360 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15361 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15362 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15363 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15364 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15365 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15366 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15367 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15368
15369 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15370 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15371 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15372 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15373 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15374
15375 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15376 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15377 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15378 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15379 @code{force} argument.
15380
15381 @item directory-files
15382 This should be a function with the same interface as
15383 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15384 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15385 parameter is optional; the default is
15386 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15387 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15388 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15389 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15390 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15391 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15392
15393 @item get-new-mail
15394 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15395 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15396 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15397 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15398 value is @code{nil}.
15399
15400 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15401 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15402 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15403 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15404 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15405 @end table
15406
15407 @subsubsection Group parameters
15408
15409 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15410 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15411 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15412 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15413 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15414 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15415 another back end.
15416
15417 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15418 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15419 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15420 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15421 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15422 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15423 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15424 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15425 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15426
15427 @table @code
15428 @item expire-age
15429 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15430 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15431 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15432 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15433 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15434 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15435 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15436 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15437 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15438 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15439 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15440 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15441 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15442
15443 @item expire-group
15444 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15445 @example
15446 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15447 @end example
15448 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15449 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15450 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15451 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15452 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15453 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15454 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15455 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15456 article. So that form can refer to
15457 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15458 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
15459 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15460 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15461
15462 @item read-only
15463 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15464 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15465 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15466 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15467 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15468 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15469 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15470 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15471 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15472 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15473 contain extra copies of the articles.
15474
15475 @item directory-files
15476 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15477 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15478 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15479 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15480
15481 @item distrust-Lines:
15482 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15483 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15484 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15485
15486 @item always-marks
15487 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15488 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15489 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15490 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15491 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15492 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15493
15494 @item never-marks
15495 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15496 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15497 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15498 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15499 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15500 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15501 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15502
15503 @item nov-cache-size
15504 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15505 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15506 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15507 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15508 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15509 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15510 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15511 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15512 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15513 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15514 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15515 @end table
15516
15517 @subsubsection Article identification
15518 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15519 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15520 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15521 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15522 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15523 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15524 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15525 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15526 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15527 request the article in the summary buffer.
15528
15529 @subsubsection NOV data
15530 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15531 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15532 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15533 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15534 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15535 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15536 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15537 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15538 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15539 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15540 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15541
15542 @subsubsection Article marks
15543 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15544 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15545 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15546 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15547 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15548 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15549 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15550 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15551
15552 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15553 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15554 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15555 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15556 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15557 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15558 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15559 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15560 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15561
15562
15563 @node Mail Folders
15564 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15565 @cindex nnfolder
15566 @cindex mbox folders
15567 @cindex mail folders
15568
15569 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15570 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15571 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15572 numbers and arrival dates.
15573
15574 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15575 @cindex marks
15576 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15577 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15578 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15579 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15580 Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15581 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15582 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15583 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15584 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15585 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15586
15587 Virtual server settings:
15588
15589 @table @code
15590 @item nnfolder-directory
15591 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15592 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15593 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15594 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15595
15596 @item nnfolder-active-file
15597 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15598 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15599
15600 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15601 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15602 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15603 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15604
15605 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15606 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15607 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15608 default is @code{t}
15609
15610 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15611 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15612 @cindex backup files
15613 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15614 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15615 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15616 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15617
15618 @lisp
15619 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15620 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15621
15622 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15623 @end lisp
15624
15625 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15626 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15627 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15628 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15629 extract some information from it before removing it.
15630
15631 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15632 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15633 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15634 default is @code{nil}.
15635
15636 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15637 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15638 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15639
15640 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15641 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15642 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15643 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15644
15645 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15646 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15647 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15648 default is @code{nil}.
15649
15650 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15651 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15652 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15653
15654 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15655 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15656 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15657 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15658
15659 @end table
15660
15661
15662 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15663 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15664 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15665 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15666 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15667 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15668 though.
15669
15670 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15671 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15672
15673 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15674 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15675 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15676 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15677 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15678
15679 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15680 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15681 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15682 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15683 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15684 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15685 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15686 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15687 via NFS).
15688
15689 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15690 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15691 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15692 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15693
15694 @table @code
15695 @item nnmbox
15696
15697 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15698 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15699 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15700 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15701 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15702 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15703 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15704 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15705 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15706 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15707 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15708 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15709 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15710 what's where.
15711
15712 @item nnbabyl
15713
15714 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15715 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15716 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15717 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15718 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15719 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15720 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15721 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15722 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15723 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15724 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15725 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15726 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15727 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15728
15729 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15730 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15731 look at your mail.
15732
15733 @item nnml
15734
15735 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15736 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15737 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15738 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15739 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15740 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15741 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15742 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15743 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15744 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15745 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15746 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15747 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15748 provided by the active file and overviews.
15749
15750 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15751 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15752 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15753 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15754 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15755 wins big.
15756
15757 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15758 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15759 tiny files.
15760
15761 @item nnmh
15762
15763 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15764 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15765 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15766 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15767 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15768 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15769 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15770
15771 @item nnfolder
15772
15773 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15774 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15775 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15776 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15777 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15778 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15779 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15780 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15781 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15782
15783 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15784 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15785 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15786 friendly mail back end all over.
15787
15788 @item nnmaildir
15789
15790 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15791 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15792 mail back ends.
15793
15794 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15795 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15796 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15797 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15798 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15799 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15800 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15801 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15802 file system.
15803
15804 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15805 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15806 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15807 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15808 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15809 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15810 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15811 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15812 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15813 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15814 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15815
15816 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15817 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15818 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15819 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15820 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15821 @code{nnmaildir}.
15822
15823 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15824 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15825 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15826 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15827 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15828 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15829 removed in the future.
15830
15831 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15832 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15833 on your file system.
15834
15835 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15836 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15837
15838 @end table
15839
15840
15841 @node Browsing the Web
15842 @section Browsing the Web
15843 @cindex web
15844 @cindex browsing the web
15845 @cindex www
15846 @cindex http
15847
15848 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15849 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15850 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15851 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15852 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15853 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15854 even know what a news group is.
15855
15856 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15857 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15858 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15859 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15860 you mad in the end.
15861
15862 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15863 to do it instead?
15864
15865 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15866 interfaces to these sources.
15867
15868 @menu
15869 * Archiving Mail::
15870 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15871 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15872 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15873 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15874 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15875 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
15876 @end menu
15877
15878 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
15879 alternatives to work.
15880
15881 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15882 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15883 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15884 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15885 though, you should be ok.
15886
15887 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15888 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15889 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15890 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15891 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15892
15893 @node Archiving Mail
15894 @subsection Archiving Mail
15895 @cindex archiving mail
15896 @cindex backup of mail
15897
15898 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15899 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15900 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15901 marks is fairly simple.
15902
15903 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15904 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15905 though.)
15906
15907 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15908 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15909 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15910 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15911 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15912 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15913 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15914 before you restore the data.
15915
15916 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15917 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15918 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15919 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15920 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15921 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15922 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15923 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15924 is unnecessary in that case.
15925
15926 @node Web Searches
15927 @subsection Web Searches
15928 @cindex nnweb
15929 @cindex Google
15930 @cindex dejanews
15931 @cindex gmane
15932 @cindex Usenet searches
15933 @cindex searching the Usenet
15934
15935 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15936 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15937 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15938 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15939 searches without having to use a browser.
15940
15941 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15942 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15943 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15944 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15945 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15946
15947 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15948 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15949 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15950 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15951 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15952 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15953 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15954 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15955 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15956 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15957 group as read.
15958
15959 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15960 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15961 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15962 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15963 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15964 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15965
15966 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
15967 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
15968 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
15969
15970 Virtual server variables:
15971
15972 @table @code
15973 @item nnweb-type
15974 @vindex nnweb-type
15975 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15976 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15977 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15978
15979 @item nnweb-search
15980 @vindex nnweb-search
15981 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15982
15983 @item nnweb-max-hits
15984 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15985 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15986 999.
15987
15988 @item nnweb-type-definition
15989 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15990 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15991 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15992 present:
15993
15994 @table @code
15995 @item article
15996 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15997 understands.
15998
15999 @item map
16000 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16001
16002 @item search
16003 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16004
16005 @item address
16006 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16007 to.
16008
16009 @item id
16010 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16011 @end table
16012
16013 @end table
16014
16015
16016 @node Slashdot
16017 @subsection Slashdot
16018 @cindex Slashdot
16019 @cindex nnslashdot
16020
16021 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
16022 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
16023 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
16024
16025 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
16026 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
16027
16028 @lisp
16029 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16030 '((nnslashdot "")))
16031 @end lisp
16032
16033 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
16034 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
16035 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
16036 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
16037 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
16038 Methods}).
16039
16040 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
16041 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
16042
16043 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
16044 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
16045 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
16046 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
16047 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
16048 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
16049 @acronym{HTML} forms.
16050
16051 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
16052
16053 @table @code
16054 @item nnslashdot-threaded
16055 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
16056 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
16057 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
16058 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
16059 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
16060 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
16061
16062 @item nnslashdot-login-name
16063 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
16064 The login name to use when posting.
16065
16066 @item nnslashdot-password
16067 @vindex nnslashdot-password
16068 The password to use when posting.
16069
16070 @item nnslashdot-directory
16071 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
16072 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
16073 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
16074
16075 @item nnslashdot-active-url
16076 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
16077 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
16078 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
16079 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
16080
16081 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
16082 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
16083 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
16084
16085 @item nnslashdot-article-url
16086 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
16087 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
16088 article. The default is
16089 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
16090
16091 @item nnslashdot-threshold
16092 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
16093 The score threshold. The default is -1.
16094
16095 @item nnslashdot-group-number
16096 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
16097 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
16098 updated. The default is 0.
16099
16100 @end table
16101
16102
16103
16104 @node Ultimate
16105 @subsection Ultimate
16106 @cindex nnultimate
16107 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
16108
16109 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
16110 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
16111 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
16112 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16113
16114 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
16115 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
16116 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
16117 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
16118 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
16119 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
16120 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
16121
16122 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
16123
16124 @table @code
16125 @item nnultimate-directory
16126 @vindex nnultimate-directory
16127 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
16128 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
16129 @end table
16130
16131
16132 @node Web Archive
16133 @subsection Web Archive
16134 @cindex nnwarchive
16135 @cindex Web Archive
16136
16137 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
16138 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
16139 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
16140 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
16141 groups updated.
16142
16143 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
16144 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
16145 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
16146 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
16147 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
16148 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
16149 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
16150 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
16151
16152 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
16153
16154 @table @code
16155 @item nnwarchive-directory
16156 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
16157 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
16158 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
16159
16160 @item nnwarchive-login
16161 @vindex nnwarchive-login
16162 The account name on the web server.
16163
16164 @item nnwarchive-passwd
16165 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
16166 The password for your account on the web server.
16167 @end table
16168
16169 @node RSS
16170 @subsection RSS
16171 @cindex nnrss
16172 @cindex RSS
16173
16174 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16175 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16176 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16177 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16178 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16179
16180 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16181 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16182
16183 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16184 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16185 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16186 group names.
16187
16188 @kindex G R (Group)
16189 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16190 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16191 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16192 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16193
16194 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16195 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16196 subscribe to groups.
16197
16198 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16199 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16200 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16201 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16202 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
16203 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
16204 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
16205 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
16206
16207 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16208 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16209 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16210
16211 @cindex OPML
16212 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16213 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16214 Markup Language).
16215
16216 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16217 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16218 file.
16219 @end defun
16220
16221 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16222 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16223 @acronym{OPML} format.
16224 @end defun
16225
16226 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16227
16228 @table @code
16229 @item nnrss-directory
16230 @vindex nnrss-directory
16231 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16232 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16233
16234 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16235 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16236 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16237 data files. The default is the value of
16238 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
16239 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
16240
16241 @item nnrss-use-local
16242 @vindex nnrss-use-local
16243 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
16244 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
16245 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
16246 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
16247 download script using @command{wget}.
16248
16249 @item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
16250 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
16251 parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
16252 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
16253 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
16254 to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
16255 simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
16256 @samp{text/html} parts.
16257 @end table
16258
16259 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
16260 the summary buffer.
16261
16262 @lisp
16263 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
16264 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
16265
16266 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
16267 (let ((descr
16268 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
16269 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
16270 @end lisp
16271
16272 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
16273 summary buffer.
16274
16275 @lisp
16276 (require 'browse-url)
16277
16278 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
16279 (interactive "p")
16280 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
16281 (mail-header-extra
16282 (gnus-data-header
16283 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
16284 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
16285 (if url
16286 (progn
16287 (browse-url (cdr url))
16288 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
16289 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
16290
16291 (eval-after-load "gnus"
16292 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
16293 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
16294 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
16295 @end lisp
16296
16297 Even if you have added @code{"text/html"} to the
16298 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
16299 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
16300 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
16301 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
16302 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
16303 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
16304 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
16305 @code{nnrss} groups:
16306
16307 @lisp
16308 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
16309 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
16310 '(add-to-list
16311 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
16312 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
16313 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
16314
16315 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
16316 (add-to-list
16317 'gnus-parameters
16318 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
16319 @end lisp
16320
16321
16322 @node Customizing W3
16323 @subsection Customizing W3
16324 @cindex W3
16325 @cindex html
16326 @cindex url
16327 @cindex Netscape
16328
16329 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
16330 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
16331 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
16332 users.
16333
16334 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
16335 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
16336 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
16337
16338 @lisp
16339 (eval-after-load "w3"
16340 '(progn
16341 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
16342 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
16343 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
16344 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16345 (browse-url url)
16346 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16347 @end lisp
16348
16349 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
16350 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16351 follow the link.
16352
16353
16354 @node IMAP
16355 @section IMAP
16356 @cindex nnimap
16357 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16358
16359 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16360 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16361 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16362 specify the network address of the server.
16363
16364 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16365 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16366 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16367 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16368 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16369 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16370
16371 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16372 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16373 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16374 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16375
16376 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16377 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16378 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16379 usage explained in this section.
16380
16381 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16382 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16383 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16384 see below.)
16385
16386 @lisp
16387 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16388 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16389 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16390 (nnimap "dolk"
16391 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16392 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16393 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16394 (nnimap "barbar"
16395 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16396 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16397 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16398 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16399 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16400 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16401 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16402 (nnimap-stream network))
16403 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16404 (nnimap "vic20"
16405 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16406 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16407 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16408 @end lisp
16409
16410 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16411 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16412 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16413 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16414
16415 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16416 server:
16417
16418 @table @code
16419
16420 @item nnimap-address
16421 @vindex nnimap-address
16422
16423 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16424 server name if not specified.
16425
16426 @item nnimap-server-port
16427 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16428 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16429
16430 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16431
16432 @lisp
16433 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16434 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16435 @end lisp
16436
16437 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16438 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16439 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16440 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16441 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16442 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16443 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16444
16445 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16446 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16447 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16448 mailbox.
16449
16450 Example server specification:
16451
16452 @lisp
16453 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16454 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16455 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16456 @end lisp
16457
16458 @item nnimap-stream
16459 @vindex nnimap-stream
16460 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16461 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16462 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16463 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16464 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16465
16466 Example server specification:
16467
16468 @lisp
16469 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16470 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16471 @end lisp
16472
16473 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16474
16475 @itemize @bullet
16476 @item
16477 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16478 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16479 @item
16480 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16481 @item
16482 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16483 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16484 @samp{starttls}.
16485 @item
16486 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16487 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16488 @item
16489 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16490 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16491 @item
16492 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16493 @item
16494 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16495 @end itemize
16496
16497 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16498 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16499 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16500 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16501 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16502 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16503 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16504 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16505 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16506 program.
16507
16508 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16509 needed. It is available from
16510 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16511
16512 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16513 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16514 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16515 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16516 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16517 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16518 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16519 tried.
16520
16521 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16522 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16523 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16524 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16525 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16526 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16527 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16528 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16529
16530 @vindex imap-shell-program
16531 @vindex imap-shell-host
16532 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16533 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16534
16535 @item nnimap-authenticator
16536 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16537
16538 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16539 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16540
16541 Example server specification:
16542
16543 @lisp
16544 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16545 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16546 @end lisp
16547
16548 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16549
16550 @itemize @bullet
16551 @item
16552 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16553 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16554 @item
16555 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16556 @code{imtest}.
16557 @item
16558 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16559 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16560 @item
16561 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16562 @item
16563 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16564 @item
16565 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16566 @end itemize
16567
16568 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16569 @cindex expunging
16570 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16571 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16572 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16573 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16574 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16575 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16576 similar).
16577
16578 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16579 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16580 running in circles yet?
16581
16582 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16583 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16584 variable.
16585
16586 The possible options are:
16587
16588 @table @code
16589
16590 @item always
16591 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16592 closing a mailbox.
16593 @item never
16594 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16595 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16596 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16597 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16598 @item ask
16599 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16600 articles or not.
16601
16602 @end table
16603
16604 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16605 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16606
16607 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16608 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16609 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16610 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16611 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16612 has only one.)
16613
16614 Probably the only reason for frobbing this would be if you're trying
16615 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16616
16617 @lisp
16618 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16619 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16620 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16621 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16622 @end lisp
16623
16624 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16625 as ticked for other users.
16626
16627 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16628 @cindex expunging
16629 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16630 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16631
16632 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16633 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16634 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16635 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16636
16637 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16638 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16639 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16640 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16641
16642 However, if @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}
16643 is true, this variable has no effect since the search logic
16644 is reversed, as described below.
16645
16646 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16647 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16648
16649 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16650 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16651 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16652 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16653
16654 @example
16655 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16656 @end example
16657
16658 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16659 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16660 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16661 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16662 @code{port imap}.
16663
16664 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16665 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16666
16667 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16668 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16669 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16670
16671 @item nnimap-nov-is-evil
16672 @vindex nnimap-nov-is-evil
16673 @cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
16674 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
16675
16676 Never generate or use a local @acronym{NOV} database. Defaults to the
16677 value of @code{gnus-agent}.
16678
16679 Using a @acronym{NOV} database usually makes header fetching much
16680 faster, but it uses the @code{UID SEARCH UID} command, which is very
16681 slow on some servers (notably some versions of Courier). Since the Gnus
16682 Agent caches the information in the @acronym{NOV} database without using
16683 the slow command, this variable defaults to true if the Agent is in use,
16684 and false otherwise.
16685
16686 @item nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
16687 @vindex nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
16688 @cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
16689 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16690
16691 Avoid the @code{UID SEARCH UID @var{message numbers} NOT SINCE
16692 @var{date}} command, which is slow on some @acronym{IMAP} servers
16693 (notably, some versions of Courier). Instead, use @code{UID SEARCH SINCE
16694 @var{date}} and prune the list of expirable articles within Gnus.
16695
16696 When Gnus expires your mail (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), it starts with a
16697 list of expirable articles and asks the IMAP server questions like ``Of
16698 these articles, which ones are older than a week?'' While this seems
16699 like a perfectly reasonable question, some IMAP servers take a long time
16700 to answer it, since they seemingly go looking into every old article to
16701 see if it is one of the expirable ones. Curiously, the question ``Of
16702 @emph{all} articles, which ones are newer than a week?'' seems to be
16703 much faster to answer, so setting this variable causes Gnus to ask this
16704 question and figure out the answer to the real question itself.
16705
16706 This problem can really sneak up on you: when you first configure Gnus,
16707 everything works fine, but once you accumulate a couple thousand
16708 messages, you start cursing Gnus for being so slow. On the other hand,
16709 if you get a lot of email within a week, setting this variable will
16710 cause a lot of network traffic between Gnus and the IMAP server.
16711
16712 @end table
16713
16714 @menu
16715 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16716 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16717 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16718 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16719 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16720 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16721 @end menu
16722
16723
16724
16725 @node Splitting in IMAP
16726 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16727 @cindex splitting imap mail
16728
16729 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16730 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16731 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16732 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16733 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16734
16735 And it does.
16736
16737 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16738 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16739 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16740
16741 Here are the variables of interest:
16742
16743 @table @code
16744
16745 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16746 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16747 @cindex crosspost
16748 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16749
16750 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16751 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16752 found will be used.
16753
16754 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16755
16756 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16757 @cindex splitting, inbox
16758 @cindex inbox
16759 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16760
16761 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16762 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16763 splitting is disabled!
16764
16765 @lisp
16766 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16767 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16768 @end lisp
16769
16770 No nnmail equivalent.
16771
16772 @item nnimap-split-rule
16773 @cindex splitting, rules
16774 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16775
16776 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16777 this variable.
16778
16779 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16780 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16781 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16782 Neither did I, we need examples.
16783
16784 @lisp
16785 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16786 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16787 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16788 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16789 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16790 @end lisp
16791
16792 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16793 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16794 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16795
16796 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16797 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16798 instance:
16799
16800 @lisp
16801 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16802 @end lisp
16803
16804 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16805 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16806
16807 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16808 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16809 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16810 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16811
16812 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16813 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16814 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16815 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16816 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16817 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16818
16819 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16820 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16821 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16822
16823 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16824 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16825 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16826
16827 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16828
16829 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16830 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16831 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16832
16833 @lisp
16834 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16835 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16836 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16837 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16838 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16839 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16840 @end lisp
16841
16842 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16843 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16844 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16845 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16846 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16847 group/function elements.
16848
16849 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16850
16851 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16852 @cindex splitting
16853 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16854
16855 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16856 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16857
16858 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16859 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16860 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16861 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16862
16863 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16864 @cindex splitting, fancy
16865 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16866 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16867
16868 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16869 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16870 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16871
16872 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16873 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16874 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16875 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16876
16877 Example:
16878
16879 @lisp
16880 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16881 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16882 @end lisp
16883
16884 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16885
16886 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16887 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16888 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16889
16890 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16891 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16892 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16893 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16894
16895 @end table
16896
16897 @node Expiring in IMAP
16898 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16899 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16900
16901 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16902 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16903 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16904 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16905 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16906 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16907 process.
16908
16909 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16910 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16911 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16912 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16913 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16914 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16915 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16916 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16917
16918 If expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail seems very slow, try setting the server
16919 variable @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}.
16920
16921 @table @code
16922
16923 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16924 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16925
16926 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16927 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16928
16929 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16930
16931 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16932 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16933 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16934 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16935
16936 @end table
16937
16938 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16939 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16940 @cindex editing imap acls
16941 @cindex Access Control Lists
16942 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16943 @kindex G l (Group)
16944 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16945
16946 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16947 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16948 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16949 doesn't.
16950
16951 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16952 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16953 editing window with detailed instructions.
16954
16955 Some possible uses:
16956
16957 @itemize @bullet
16958 @item
16959 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16960 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16961 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16962 @item
16963 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16964 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16965 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16966 INBOX.mailbox).
16967 @end itemize
16968
16969 @node Expunging mailboxes
16970 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16971 @cindex expunging
16972
16973 @cindex expunge
16974 @cindex manual expunging
16975 @kindex G x (Group)
16976 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16977
16978 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16979 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16980 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16981
16982 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16983 delete them.
16984
16985 @node A note on namespaces
16986 @subsection A note on namespaces
16987 @cindex IMAP namespace
16988 @cindex namespaces
16989
16990 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16991 by the following text in the RFC2060:
16992
16993 @display
16994 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16995
16996 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16997 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16998 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16999 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
17000
17001 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
17002 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
17003 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
17004 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
17005 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
17006 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
17007 @end display
17008
17009 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
17010 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
17011 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
17012
17013 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
17014 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
17015 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
17016 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
17017 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
17018 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
17019 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
17020 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
17021 Gnus.
17022
17023 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
17024 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
17025 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
17026
17027 @node Debugging IMAP
17028 @subsection Debugging IMAP
17029 @cindex IMAP debugging
17030 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
17031
17032 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
17033 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
17034 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
17035 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
17036
17037 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
17038 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
17039 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
17040 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
17041 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
17042 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
17043 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
17044
17045
17046 @vindex imap-log
17047 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
17048 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
17049 follows:
17050
17051 @lisp
17052 (setq imap-log t)
17053 @end lisp
17054
17055 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
17056 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
17057 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
17058 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
17059 data.
17060
17061 @node Other Sources
17062 @section Other Sources
17063
17064 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17065 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17066 newsgroups.
17067
17068 @menu
17069 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17070 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17071 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17072 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
17073 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17074 @end menu
17075
17076
17077 @node Directory Groups
17078 @subsection Directory Groups
17079 @cindex nndir
17080 @cindex directory groups
17081
17082 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17083 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17084 names, of course.
17085
17086 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17087 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17088 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17089 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17090
17091 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17092 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17093 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17094 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17095 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17096
17097 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17098
17099 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17100 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17101 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17102 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17103
17104
17105 @node Anything Groups
17106 @subsection Anything Groups
17107 @cindex nneething
17108
17109 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17110 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17111 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17112 true.
17113
17114 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17115 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17116 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17117 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17118 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17119 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17120 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17121 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
17122 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17123 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17124 elements.
17125
17126 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17127 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17128 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17129 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17130
17131 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17132 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17133 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17134 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17135
17136 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17137 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17138 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17139 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17140 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17141 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17142 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17143 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17144
17145 Some variables:
17146
17147 @table @code
17148 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17149 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17150 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17151 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17152
17153 @item nneething-exclude-files
17154 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17155 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17156 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17157
17158 @item nneething-include-files
17159 @vindex nneething-include-files
17160 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17161 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17162
17163 @item nneething-map-file
17164 @vindex nneething-map-file
17165 Name of the map files.
17166 @end table
17167
17168
17169 @node Document Groups
17170 @subsection Document Groups
17171 @cindex nndoc
17172 @cindex documentation group
17173 @cindex help group
17174
17175 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17176 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17177
17178 @table @code
17179 @cindex Babyl
17180 @cindex Rmail mbox
17181 @item babyl
17182 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
17183
17184 @cindex mbox
17185 @cindex Unix mbox
17186 @item mbox
17187 The standard Unix mbox file.
17188
17189 @cindex MMDF mail box
17190 @item mmdf
17191 The MMDF mail box format.
17192
17193 @item news
17194 Several news articles appended into a file.
17195
17196 @cindex rnews batch files
17197 @item rnews
17198 The rnews batch transport format.
17199
17200 @item nsmail
17201 Netscape mail boxes.
17202
17203 @item mime-parts
17204 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17205
17206 @item standard-digest
17207 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17208
17209 @item mime-digest
17210 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17211
17212 @item lanl-gov-announce
17213 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17214
17215 @cindex forwarded messages
17216 @item rfc822-forward
17217 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17218
17219 @item outlook
17220 The Outlook mail box.
17221
17222 @item oe-dbx
17223 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17224
17225 @item exim-bounce
17226 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17227
17228 @item forward
17229 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17230
17231 @item rfc934
17232 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17233
17234 @item mailman
17235 A mailman digest.
17236
17237 @item clari-briefs
17238 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17239
17240 @item slack-digest
17241 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17242
17243 @item mail-in-mail
17244 The last resort.
17245 @end table
17246
17247 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17248 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17249 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17250 file is.
17251
17252 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17253 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17254 group. And that's it.
17255
17256 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17257 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17258 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17259 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17260 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17261 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17262 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17263 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17264 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17265 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17266
17267 Virtual server variables:
17268
17269 @table @code
17270 @item nndoc-article-type
17271 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17272 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17273 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17274 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17275 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17276 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17277
17278 @item nndoc-post-type
17279 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17280 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17281 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17282 and @code{news}.
17283 @end table
17284
17285 @menu
17286 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17287 @end menu
17288
17289
17290 @node Document Server Internals
17291 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17292
17293 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17294 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17295 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17296 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17297
17298 First, here's an example document type definition:
17299
17300 @example
17301 (mmdf
17302 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17303 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17304 @end example
17305
17306 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17307 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17308 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17309 types can be defined with very few settings:
17310
17311 @table @code
17312 @item first-article
17313 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17314 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17315 totally ignored.
17316
17317 @item article-begin
17318 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17319 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17320 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17321 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17322
17323 @item article-begin-function
17324 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17325 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17326
17327 @item head-begin
17328 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17329 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17330 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17331
17332 @item head-begin-function
17333 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17334 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17335
17336 @item head-end
17337 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17338 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17339
17340 @item body-begin
17341 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17342 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17343 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17344
17345 @item body-begin-function
17346 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17347 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17348
17349 @item body-end
17350 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17351 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17352 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17353
17354 @item body-end-function
17355 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17356 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17357
17358 @item file-begin
17359 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17360 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17361
17362 @item file-end
17363 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17364 regexp will be totally ignored.
17365
17366 @end table
17367
17368 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17369 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17370 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17371 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17372 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17373
17374 @table @code
17375 @item prepare-body-function
17376 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17377 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17378 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17379
17380 @item article-transform-function
17381 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17382 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17383 body of the article.
17384
17385 @item generate-head-function
17386 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17387 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17388 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17389 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17390
17391 @item generate-article-function
17392 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17393 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17394 parameter when requesting all articles.
17395
17396 @item dissection-function
17397 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17398 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17399 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17400 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17401 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17402 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17403
17404 @end table
17405
17406 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17407 digests:
17408
17409 @example
17410 (standard-digest
17411 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17412 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17413 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17414 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17415 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17416 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17417 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17418 (subtype digest guess))
17419 @end example
17420
17421 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17422 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17423 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17424 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17425 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17426
17427 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17428 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17429 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17430 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17431 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17432 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17433 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17434 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17435 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17436 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17437 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17438 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17439
17440
17441 @node SOUP
17442 @subsection SOUP
17443 @cindex SOUP
17444 @cindex offline
17445
17446 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17447 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17448 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17449
17450 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17451 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17452 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17453 newsreaders.
17454
17455 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17456 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17457 that interested in doing things properly.
17458
17459 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17460 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17461 fiddly.
17462
17463 First some terminology:
17464
17465 @table @dfn
17466
17467 @item server
17468 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17469 get news and/or mail from.
17470
17471 @item home machine
17472 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17473 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17474
17475 @item packet
17476 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17477 of packets:
17478
17479 @table @dfn
17480 @item message packets
17481 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17482 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17483 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17484
17485 @item response packets
17486 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17487 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17488 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17489
17490 @end table
17491
17492 @end table
17493
17494
17495 @enumerate
17496
17497 @item
17498 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17499 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17500 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17501 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17502
17503 @item
17504 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17505
17506 @item
17507 You put the packet in your home directory.
17508
17509 @item
17510 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17511 the native or secondary server.
17512
17513 @item
17514 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17515 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17516
17517 @item
17518 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17519 packet.
17520
17521 @item
17522 You transfer this packet to the server.
17523
17524 @item
17525 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17526
17527 @item
17528 You then repeat until you die.
17529
17530 @end enumerate
17531
17532 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17533 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17534
17535 @menu
17536 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17537 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17538 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17539 @end menu
17540
17541
17542 @node SOUP Commands
17543 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17544
17545 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17546
17547 @table @kbd
17548 @item G s b
17549 @kindex G s b (Group)
17550 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17551 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17552 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17553 process/prefix convention.
17554
17555 @item G s w
17556 @kindex G s w (Group)
17557 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17558 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17559
17560 @item G s s
17561 @kindex G s s (Group)
17562 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17563 Send all replies from the replies packet
17564 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17565
17566 @item G s p
17567 @kindex G s p (Group)
17568 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17569 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17570
17571 @item G s r
17572 @kindex G s r (Group)
17573 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17574 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17575
17576 @item O s
17577 @kindex O s (Summary)
17578 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17579 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17580 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17581 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17582
17583 @end table
17584
17585
17586 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17587 thingies:
17588
17589 @table @code
17590
17591 @item gnus-soup-directory
17592 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17593 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17594 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17595
17596 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17597 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17598 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17599 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17600
17601 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17602 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17603 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17604 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17605
17606 @item gnus-soup-packer
17607 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17608 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17609 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17610
17611 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17612 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17613 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17614 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17615
17616 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17617 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17618 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17619
17620 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17621 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17622 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17623 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17624
17625 @end table
17626
17627
17628 @node SOUP Groups
17629 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17630 @cindex nnsoup
17631
17632 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17633 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17634 you can read them at leisure.
17635
17636 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17637
17638 @table @code
17639
17640 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17641 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17642 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17643 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17644
17645 @item nnsoup-directory
17646 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17647 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17648 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17649
17650 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17651 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17652 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17653 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17654
17655 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17656 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17657 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17658 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17659 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17660
17661 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17662 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17663 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17664 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17665
17666 @item nnsoup-active-file
17667 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17668 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17669 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17670 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17671 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17672
17673 @item nnsoup-packer
17674 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17675 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17676 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17677
17678 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17679 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17680 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17681 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17682
17683 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17684 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17685 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17686 @file{~/}.
17687
17688 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17689 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17690 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17691 @samp{Soupout}.
17692
17693 @item nnsoup-always-save
17694 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17695 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17696
17697 @end table
17698
17699
17700 @node SOUP Replies
17701 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17702
17703 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17704 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17705 more for that to happen.
17706
17707 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17708 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17709 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17710 @sc{soup} system.
17711
17712 In specific, this is what it does:
17713
17714 @lisp
17715 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17716 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17717 @end lisp
17718
17719 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17720 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17721 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17722
17723
17724 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17725 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17726 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17727 @cindex gateways
17728
17729 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17730 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17731 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17732
17733 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17734 used to post with.
17735
17736 Server variables:
17737
17738 @table @code
17739 @item nngateway-address
17740 @vindex nngateway-address
17741 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17742
17743 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17744 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17745 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17746 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17747 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17748 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17749 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17750 gateway address.
17751
17752 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17753 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17754 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17755
17756 @example
17757 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17758 @end example
17759
17760 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17761
17762 @example
17763 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17764 @end example
17765
17766 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17767
17768 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17769 @table @code
17770
17771 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17772 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17773 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17774
17775 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17776
17777 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17778 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17779 @code{nngateway-address}.
17780 @end table
17781
17782 @end table
17783
17784 Here's an example:
17785
17786 @lisp
17787 (setq gnus-post-method
17788 '(nngateway
17789 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17790 (nngateway-header-transformation
17791 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17792 @end lisp
17793
17794 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17795
17796 @lisp
17797 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17798 @end lisp
17799
17800
17801
17802 @node Combined Groups
17803 @section Combined Groups
17804
17805 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17806 groups.
17807
17808 @menu
17809 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17810 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17811 @end menu
17812
17813
17814 @node Virtual Groups
17815 @subsection Virtual Groups
17816 @cindex nnvirtual
17817 @cindex virtual groups
17818 @cindex merging groups
17819
17820 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17821 other groups.
17822
17823 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17824 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17825 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17826
17827 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17828 regexp to match component groups.
17829
17830 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17831 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17832 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17833 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17834 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17835 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17836 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17837 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17838
17839 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17840 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17841
17842 @lisp
17843 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17844 @end lisp
17845
17846 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17847 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17848
17849 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17850 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17851 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17852 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17853
17854 @example
17855 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17856 @end example
17857
17858 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17859 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17860 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17861
17862 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17863 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17864 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17865 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17866 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17867
17868 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17869 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17870 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17871
17872 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17873 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17874 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17875 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17876 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17877 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17878 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17879 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17880 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17881 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17882 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17883
17884 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17885 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17886 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17887 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17888 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17889 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17890 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17891
17892 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17893 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17894
17895 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17896 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17897 inherited.
17898
17899
17900 @node Kibozed Groups
17901 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17902 @cindex nnkiboze
17903 @cindex kibozing
17904
17905 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17906 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17907 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17908 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17909
17910 @kindex G k (Group)
17911 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17912 buffer.
17913
17914 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17915 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17916 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17917 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17918
17919 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17920 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17921 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17922
17923 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17924 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17925 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17926 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17927 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17928 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17929 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17930 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17931
17932 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17933 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17934 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17935 Stranger things have happened.
17936
17937 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17938 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17939
17940 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17941 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17942 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17943 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17944 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17945 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17946 component articles.
17947
17948 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17949 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17950
17951
17952 @node Email Based Diary
17953 @section Email Based Diary
17954 @cindex diary
17955 @cindex email based diary
17956 @cindex calendar
17957
17958 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17959 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17960 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17961 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17962 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17963 namely, as event reminders.
17964
17965 Here is a typical scenario:
17966
17967 @itemize @bullet
17968 @item
17969 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17970 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17971 @item
17972 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17973 @item
17974 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17975 @item
17976 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17977 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17978 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17979 @item
17980 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17981 of the night you're gonna have.
17982 @item
17983 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17984 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17985 @end itemize
17986
17987 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17988 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17989 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17990 explained in the sections below.
17991
17992 @menu
17993 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17994 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17995 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17996 @end menu
17997
17998
17999 @node The NNDiary Back End
18000 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
18001 @cindex nndiary
18002 @cindex the nndiary back end
18003
18004 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
18005 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
18006 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
18007 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
18008 directory per group.
18009
18010 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
18011 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
18012 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
18013 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
18014
18015 @menu
18016 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
18017 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
18018 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
18019 @end menu
18020
18021 @node Diary Messages
18022 @subsubsection Diary Messages
18023 @cindex nndiary messages
18024 @cindex nndiary mails
18025
18026 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
18027 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
18028 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
18029 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
18030 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
18031 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
18032 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
18033
18034 @itemize @bullet
18035 @item
18036 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
18037 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
18038 (separated by a comma).
18039 @item
18040 A field is either an integer, or a range.
18041 @item
18042 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
18043 @item
18044 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
18045 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
18046 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
18047 @item
18048 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
18049 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
18050 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
18051 @item
18052 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
18053 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
18054 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
18055 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
18056 list of available time zone values, see the variable
18057 @code{nndiary-headers}.
18058 @end itemize
18059
18060 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
18061 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
18062 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
18063 what to do then):
18064
18065 @example
18066 X-Diary-Minute: 0
18067 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
18068 X-Diary-Dom: 1
18069 X-Diary-Month: *
18070 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
18071 X-Diary-Dow: 1
18072 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
18073 @end example
18074
18075 @node Running NNDiary
18076 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
18077 @cindex running nndiary
18078 @cindex nndiary operation modes
18079
18080 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
18081 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
18082 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
18083 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
18084 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
18085 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
18086
18087 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
18088 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
18089 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
18090 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
18091 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
18092 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
18093 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
18094 mode.
18095
18096 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
18097 things to do:
18098
18099 @itemize @bullet
18100 @item
18101 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
18102 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
18103
18104 @lisp
18105 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
18106 @end lisp
18107 @item
18108 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
18109 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
18110 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
18111 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
18112 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
18113
18114 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
18115 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
18116
18117 @example
18118 :0 HD :
18119 * ^X-Diary
18120 .nndiary
18121 @end example
18122 @end itemize
18123
18124 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
18125 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
18126
18127 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
18128 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
18129 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
18130 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
18131 @end defvar
18132
18133 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
18134 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
18135 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
18136 @end defvar
18137
18138 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
18139 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
18140 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
18141
18142 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
18143 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
18144 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
18145 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
18146 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
18147
18148 @node Customizing NNDiary
18149 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
18150 @cindex customizing nndiary
18151 @cindex nndiary customization
18152
18153 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
18154 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
18155 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
18156 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
18157
18158 @defvar nndiary-reminders
18159 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
18160 appointments (e.g. 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
18161 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
18162 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
18163 mail.
18164 @end defvar
18165
18166 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
18167 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
18168 default).
18169 @end defvar
18170
18171
18172 @node The Gnus Diary Library
18173 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
18174 @cindex gnus-diary
18175 @cindex the gnus diary library
18176
18177 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
18178 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
18179 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
18180 useful things for you.
18181
18182 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
18183
18184 @lisp
18185 (require 'gnus-diary)
18186 @end lisp
18187
18188 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
18189 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
18190 (sorry if you used them before).
18191
18192
18193 @menu
18194 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
18195 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
18196 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
18197 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
18198 @end menu
18199
18200 @node Diary Summary Line Format
18201 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
18202 @cindex diary summary buffer line
18203 @cindex diary summary line format
18204
18205 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
18206 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
18207 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
18208 see the event's date.
18209
18210 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
18211 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
18212 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
18213 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximative remaining time until the
18214 next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
18215
18216 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
18217 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
18218 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
18219
18220 @example
18221 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
18222 @end example
18223
18224 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
18225 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
18226
18227 @lisp
18228 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
18229 @end lisp
18230
18231 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
18232 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
18233 with the following user options:
18234
18235 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
18236 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
18237 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
18238 diary groups'parameters.
18239 @end defvar
18240
18241 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18242 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18243 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18244 @end defvar
18245
18246 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18247 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18248 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18249 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18250 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18251 @end defvar
18252
18253 @node Diary Articles Sorting
18254 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18255 @cindex diary articles sorting
18256 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
18257 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18258 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18259 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
18260
18261 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18262 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18263 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18264 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18265 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18266
18267 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18268 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18269 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18270 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18271 Parameters}).
18272
18273 @node Diary Headers Generation
18274 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18275 @cindex diary headers generation
18276 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18277
18278 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18279 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18280 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18281 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18282 needed.
18283
18284 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18285 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18286 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c D c} in @code{message-mode}
18287 and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the process of converting
18288 a usual mail to a diary one.
18289
18290 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18291 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18292 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18293 instance.
18294
18295 @node Diary Group Parameters
18296 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18297 @cindex diary group parameters
18298
18299 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18300 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18301 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18302 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18303 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18304 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18305 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18306 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18307
18308 @node Sending or Not Sending
18309 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18310
18311 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18312 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18313
18314 @itemize @bullet
18315 @item
18316 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18317 messsages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18318 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18319 sending the diary message to them as well.
18320 @item
18321 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18322 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18323 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18324 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18325 @end itemize
18326
18327 @node Gnus Unplugged
18328 @section Gnus Unplugged
18329 @cindex offline
18330 @cindex unplugged
18331 @cindex agent
18332 @cindex Gnus agent
18333 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18334
18335 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18336 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18337 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18338 read news. Believe it or not.
18339
18340 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18341 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18342 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18343 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18344 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18345
18346 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18347 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18348 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18349 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18350 reading news on a machine.
18351
18352 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18353 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
18354
18355 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18356
18357 @menu
18358 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18359 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18360 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18361 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18362 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18363 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18364 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18365 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18366 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18367 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18368 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18369 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18370 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18371 @end menu
18372
18373
18374 @node Agent Basics
18375 @subsection Agent Basics
18376
18377 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18378
18379 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18380 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18381 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18382 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18383
18384 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18385 connected to the net continuously.
18386
18387 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18388 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18389
18390 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18391 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18392 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18393 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18394 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18395
18396 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18397 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18398 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18399 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18400 they're kinda like plugged always).
18401
18402 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18403 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18404 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18405 the culprit.
18406
18407 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18408 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18409 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18410 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18411 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18412
18413 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18414
18415 @itemize @bullet
18416
18417 @item
18418 @findex gnus-unplugged
18419 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18420 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18421 already fetched while in this mode.
18422
18423 @item
18424 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18425 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18426 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18427 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18428 Source Specifiers}).
18429
18430 @item
18431 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18432 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18433 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18434 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18435 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18436
18437 @item
18438 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18439 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18440 then you read the news offline.
18441
18442 @item
18443 And then you go to step 2.
18444 @end itemize
18445
18446 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18447 the Agent.
18448
18449 @itemize @bullet
18450
18451 @item
18452 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18453 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18454 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18455 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18456 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18457 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18458 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
18459 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
18460
18461 @item
18462 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18463 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18464 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18465 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18466
18467 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18468 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18469 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18470 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18471 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18472 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18473 configure them.
18474
18475 @item
18476 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18477 @end itemize
18478
18479
18480 @node Agent Categories
18481 @subsection Agent Categories
18482
18483 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18484 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18485 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18486 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18487 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18488 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18489 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18490
18491 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18492 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18493 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18494 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18495 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18496
18497 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18498 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18499 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18500 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18501 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18502 sink.
18503
18504 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18505 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18506 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18507 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18508 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18509 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18510 your settings.
18511
18512 @menu
18513 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18514 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18515 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18516 @end menu
18517
18518
18519 @node Category Syntax
18520 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18521
18522 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18523 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18524 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18525 listed below.
18526
18527 @cindex Agent Parameters
18528 @table @code
18529 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
18530 The name of the category.
18531
18532 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
18533 The list of groups that are in this category.
18534
18535 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
18536 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18537 are eligible for downloading; and
18538
18539 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
18540 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18541 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18542 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18543
18544 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
18545 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18546 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18547 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18548 only groups that should not be expired.
18549
18550 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
18551 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18552 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18553
18554 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
18555 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18556
18557 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
18558 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18559
18560 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
18561 an integer that overrides the value of
18562 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18563
18564 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
18565 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18566
18567 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
18568 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
18569 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
18570 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
18571 @c all other symbols disable them.
18572
18573 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
18574 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18575 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
18576 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
18577 all other symbols enable them.
18578 @end table
18579
18580 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18581 created.
18582
18583 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18584 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18585 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18586 category.
18587
18588 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18589 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18590 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18591 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18592
18593 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18594 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18595 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18596
18597 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18598 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18599 operators sprinkled in between.
18600
18601 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18602
18603 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18604 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18605
18606 @lisp
18607 short
18608 @end lisp
18609
18610 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18611 short (for some value of ``short'').
18612
18613 Here's a more complex predicate:
18614
18615 @lisp
18616 (or high
18617 (and
18618 (not low)
18619 (not long)))
18620 @end lisp
18621
18622 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18623 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18624 drift.
18625
18626 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18627 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18628 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18629
18630 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18631 you want to do, you can write your own.
18632
18633 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18634 bound to the value determined by calling
18635 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18636 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18637 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18638 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18639 predicate to individual groups.
18640
18641 @table @code
18642 @item short
18643 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18644 lines; default 100.
18645
18646 @item long
18647 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18648 lines; default 200.
18649
18650 @item low
18651 True if the article has a download score less than
18652 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18653
18654 @item high
18655 True if the article has a download score greater than
18656 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18657
18658 @item spam
18659 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18660 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18661 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18662
18663 @item true
18664 Always true.
18665
18666 @item false
18667 Always false.
18668 @end table
18669
18670 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18671 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18672 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18673 useful values.
18674
18675 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18676 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
18677 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18678 something along the lines of the following:
18679
18680 @lisp
18681 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18682 "Say whether an article is old."
18683 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18684 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18685 @end lisp
18686
18687 with the predicate then defined as:
18688
18689 @lisp
18690 (not my-article-old-p)
18691 @end lisp
18692
18693 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18694 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18695 wherever.
18696
18697 @lisp
18698 (require 'gnus-agent)
18699 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18700 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18701 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18702 @end lisp
18703
18704 and simply specify your predicate as:
18705
18706 @lisp
18707 (not old)
18708 @end lisp
18709
18710 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18711 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18712 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18713 just don't give a damn.
18714
18715 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18716 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18717 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18718 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18719 parameters like so:
18720
18721 @lisp
18722 (agent-predicate . short)
18723 @end lisp
18724
18725 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18726 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18727 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18728
18729 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18730
18731 @lisp
18732 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18733 @end lisp
18734
18735 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18736 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18737 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18738
18739
18740 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18741 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18742 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18743 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18744 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18745 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18746
18747 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18748 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18749 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18750 if it's to be specific to that group.
18751
18752 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18753 three forms:
18754
18755 @enumerate
18756 @item
18757 Score rule
18758
18759 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18760 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18761
18762 example:
18763
18764 @itemize @bullet
18765 @item
18766 Category specification
18767
18768 @lisp
18769 (("from"
18770 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18771 ("lines"
18772 (500 -100 nil <)))
18773 @end lisp
18774
18775 @item
18776 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18777
18778 @lisp
18779 (agent-score ("from"
18780 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18781 ("lines"
18782 (500 -100 nil <)))
18783 @end lisp
18784
18785 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18786 @end itemize
18787
18788 @item
18789 Agent score file
18790
18791 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18792 keywords stated above.
18793
18794 example:
18795
18796 @itemize @bullet
18797 @item
18798 Category specification
18799
18800 @lisp
18801 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18802 @end lisp
18803
18804 or perhaps
18805
18806 @lisp
18807 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18808 @end lisp
18809
18810 @item
18811 Group Parameter specification
18812
18813 @lisp
18814 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18815 @end lisp
18816
18817 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18818 about parenthesis?
18819 @end itemize
18820
18821 @item
18822 Use @code{normal} score files
18823
18824 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18825 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18826 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18827 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18828
18829 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18830 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18831 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18832 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18833
18834 @itemize @bullet
18835 @item
18836 Category Specification
18837
18838 @lisp
18839 file
18840 @end lisp
18841
18842 @item
18843 Group Parameter specification
18844
18845 @lisp
18846 (agent-score . file)
18847 @end lisp
18848 @end itemize
18849 @end enumerate
18850
18851 @node Category Buffer
18852 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18853
18854 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18855 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18856 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18857
18858 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18859
18860 @table @kbd
18861 @item q
18862 @kindex q (Category)
18863 @findex gnus-category-exit
18864 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18865
18866 @item e
18867 @kindex e (Category)
18868 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18869 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18870 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18871
18872 @item k
18873 @kindex k (Category)
18874 @findex gnus-category-kill
18875 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18876
18877 @item c
18878 @kindex c (Category)
18879 @findex gnus-category-copy
18880 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18881
18882 @item a
18883 @kindex a (Category)
18884 @findex gnus-category-add
18885 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18886
18887 @item p
18888 @kindex p (Category)
18889 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18890 Edit the predicate of the current category
18891 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18892
18893 @item g
18894 @kindex g (Category)
18895 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18896 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18897 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18898
18899 @item s
18900 @kindex s (Category)
18901 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18902 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18903 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18904
18905 @item l
18906 @kindex l (Category)
18907 @findex gnus-category-list
18908 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18909 @end table
18910
18911
18912 @node Category Variables
18913 @subsubsection Category Variables
18914
18915 @table @code
18916 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18917 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18918 Hook run in category buffers.
18919
18920 @item gnus-category-line-format
18921 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18922 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18923 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18924
18925 @table @samp
18926 @item c
18927 The name of the category.
18928
18929 @item g
18930 The number of groups in the category.
18931 @end table
18932
18933 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18934 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18935 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18936
18937 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18938 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18939 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18940
18941 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18942 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18943 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18944
18945 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18946 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18947 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18948 0.
18949
18950 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18951 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18952 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18953 0.
18954
18955 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18956 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18957 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18958 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18959 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18960 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18961 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18962 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18963 read.
18964 Default 7.
18965
18966 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18967 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18968 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18969 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18970 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18971 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18972 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18973
18974 @end table
18975
18976
18977 @node Agent Commands
18978 @subsection Agent Commands
18979 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18980 @kindex J j (Agent)
18981
18982 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18983 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18984 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18985
18986
18987 @menu
18988 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18989 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18990 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18991 @end menu
18992
18993
18994
18995
18996 @node Group Agent Commands
18997 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18998
18999 @table @kbd
19000 @item J u
19001 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
19002 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
19003 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
19004 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
19005
19006 @item J c
19007 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
19008 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
19009 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
19010
19011 @item J s
19012 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
19013 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
19014 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
19015 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
19016
19017 @item J S
19018 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
19019 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
19020 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
19021 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
19022
19023 @item J a
19024 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
19025 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
19026 Add the current group to an Agent category
19027 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
19028 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19029
19030 @item J r
19031 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
19032 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
19033 Remove the current group from its category, if any
19034 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
19035 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19036
19037 @item J Y
19038 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
19039 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19040 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
19041
19042
19043 @end table
19044
19045
19046 @node Summary Agent Commands
19047 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
19048
19049 @table @kbd
19050 @item J #
19051 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
19052 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
19053 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
19054
19055 @item J M-#
19056 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
19057 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
19058 Remove the downloading mark from the article
19059 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
19060
19061 @cindex %
19062 @item @@
19063 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
19064 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
19065 Toggle whether to download the article
19066 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
19067 default.
19068
19069 @item J c
19070 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
19071 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
19072 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
19073
19074 @item J S
19075 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
19076 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
19077 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
19078 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
19079
19080 @item J s
19081 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
19082 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
19083 Download all processable articles in this group.
19084 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
19085
19086 @item J u
19087 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
19088 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
19089 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
19090 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
19091
19092 @end table
19093
19094
19095 @node Server Agent Commands
19096 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
19097
19098 @table @kbd
19099 @item J a
19100 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
19101 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
19102 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
19103 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
19104
19105 @item J r
19106 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
19107 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
19108 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
19109 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
19110
19111 @end table
19112
19113
19114 @node Agent Visuals
19115 @subsection Agent Visuals
19116
19117 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
19118 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
19119 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
19120 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
19121 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
19122 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
19123 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
19124 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
19125 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
19126 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
19127
19128 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
19129 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
19130 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
19131 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
19132 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
19133 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
19134 the download status of each article so that you always know which
19135 articles will be available when unplugged.
19136
19137 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
19138 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
19139 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
19140 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
19141 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
19142 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
19143 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
19144 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
19145
19146 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
19147 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
19148 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
19149 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
19150 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
19151 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
19152 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
19153 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
19154 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
19155
19156 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
19157 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
19158 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
19159 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
19160 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
19161
19162 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
19163 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
19164 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
19165 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
19166 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
19167 disable the undownload faces by customizing
19168 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
19169 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
19170 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
19171 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
19172 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
19173 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
19174 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
19175
19176 @node Agent as Cache
19177 @subsection Agent as Cache
19178
19179 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
19180 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
19181 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
19182 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
19183 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
19184 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
19185 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
19186 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
19187 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
19188
19189 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
19190 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
19191 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
19192 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
19193 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
19194
19195 @node Agent Expiry
19196 @subsection Agent Expiry
19197
19198 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
19199 @findex gnus-agent-expire
19200 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
19201 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
19202 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
19203 @cindex agent expiry
19204 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
19205 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
19206
19207 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
19208 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
19209 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
19210 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
19211 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
19212 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
19213 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
19214 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
19215
19216 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
19217 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
19218 synchronized with the group.
19219
19220 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
19221 prevent expiration in selected groups.
19222
19223 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
19224 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
19225 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
19226 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
19227 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
19228 be kept indefinitely.
19229
19230 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
19231 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
19232 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
19233 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
19234
19235 @node Agent Regeneration
19236 @subsection Agent Regeneration
19237
19238 @cindex agent regeneration
19239 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
19240 @cindex regeneration
19241
19242 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19243 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19244 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19245 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19246 internal inconsistencies.
19247
19248 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19249 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19250 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19251 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19252 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19253 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
19254
19255 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19256 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19257 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19258 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19259 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19260 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
19261
19262 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19263 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19264 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19265 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19266 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19267 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19268 agent as unread.
19269
19270 @node Agent and IMAP
19271 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19272
19273 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19274 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19275 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19276 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19277
19278 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
19279 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
19280 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
19281 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
19282
19283 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
19284 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
19285 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
19286 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19287
19288 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19289 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19290 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19291 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19292 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19293 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19294
19295 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19296 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19297 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19298 in the group buffer.
19299
19300 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19301 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19302
19303 @itemize @bullet
19304
19305 @item
19306 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19307
19308 @item
19309 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19310
19311 @end itemize
19312
19313 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19314 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
19315 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19316 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
19317 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19318 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19319 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19320 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19321
19322
19323 @node Outgoing Messages
19324 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19325
19326 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
19327 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
19328 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19329
19330 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
19331 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
19332 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
19333 messages in the draft group.
19334
19335
19336
19337 @node Agent Variables
19338 @subsection Agent Variables
19339
19340 @table @code
19341 @item gnus-agent-directory
19342 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19343 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19344 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19345
19346 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19347 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19348 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19349 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19350 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19351 by default.
19352
19353 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19354 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19355 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19356
19357 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19358 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19359 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19360
19361 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19362 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19363 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19364
19365 @item gnus-agent-cache
19366 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19367 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19368 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19369 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19370
19371 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19372 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19373 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19374 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19375 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19376 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19377 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19378 online status.
19379
19380 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19381 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19382 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19383 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19384 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19385 read. The default is @code{t}.
19386
19387 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19388 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19389 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19390 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19391 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19392 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19393 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19394 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19395 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19396 over and over again.
19397
19398 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19399 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19400 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19401 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19402 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19403 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19404 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19405 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19406 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19407 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19408 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
19409 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19410 see any cycling.
19411
19412 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19413 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19414 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19415 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19416 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19417 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19418 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19419 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19420 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19421
19422 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19423 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19424 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19425 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19426 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19427 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19428
19429 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19430 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19431 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19432 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19433 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19434
19435 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19436 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19437 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19438 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19439 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19440 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19441 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19442 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19443 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19444 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19445 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
19446
19447 @end table
19448
19449
19450 @node Example Setup
19451 @subsection Example Setup
19452
19453 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19454 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19455 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19456
19457 @lisp
19458 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19459 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19460 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19461
19462 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19463 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19464 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19465
19466 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19467 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19468
19469 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19470 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19471 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19472 @end lisp
19473
19474 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19475 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19476 gnus}.
19477
19478 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19479 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19480 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19481 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19482 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19483 once.
19484
19485 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19486 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19487 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19488 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19489 back all the killed groups.)
19490
19491 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19492 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19493 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19494
19495
19496 @node Batching Agents
19497 @subsection Batching Agents
19498 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19499
19500 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19501 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19502 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19503
19504 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19505 following incantation:
19506
19507 @example
19508 #!/bin/sh
19509 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19510 @end example
19511
19512
19513 @node Agent Caveats
19514 @subsection Agent Caveats
19515
19516 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19517 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19518 may ask:
19519
19520 @table @dfn
19521 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19522
19523 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19524 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19525 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19526
19527 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19528 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19529
19530 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19531
19532 @end table
19533
19534 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19535 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19536 locally stored articles.
19537
19538
19539 @node Scoring
19540 @chapter Scoring
19541 @cindex scoring
19542
19543 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19544 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19545 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19546 attention!
19547
19548 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19549 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19550 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19551 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19552 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19553
19554 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19555 before generating the summary buffer.
19556
19557 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19558 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19559 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19560
19561 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19562 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19563 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19564 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19565
19566 @menu
19567 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19568 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19569 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19570 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19571 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19572 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19573 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19574 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19575 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19576 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19577 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19578 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19579 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19580 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19581 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
19582 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19583 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19584 @end menu
19585
19586
19587 @node Summary Score Commands
19588 @section Summary Score Commands
19589 @cindex score commands
19590
19591 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19592 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19593 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19594 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19595 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19596
19597 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19598 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19599 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19600 score file the current one.
19601
19602 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19603
19604 @table @kbd
19605
19606 @item V s
19607 @kindex V s (Summary)
19608 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19609 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19610
19611 @item V S
19612 @kindex V S (Summary)
19613 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19614 Display the score of the current article
19615 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19616
19617 @item V t
19618 @kindex V t (Summary)
19619 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19620 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19621 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19622 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19623 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19624 score file and edit it.
19625
19626 @item V w
19627 @kindex V w (Summary)
19628 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19629 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19630
19631 @item V R
19632 @kindex V R (Summary)
19633 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19634 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19635 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19636 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19637 effect you're having.
19638
19639 @item V c
19640 @kindex V c (Summary)
19641 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19642 Make a different score file the current
19643 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19644
19645 @item V e
19646 @kindex V e (Summary)
19647 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19648 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19649 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19650 File Editing}).
19651
19652 @item V f
19653 @kindex V f (Summary)
19654 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19655 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19656 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19657
19658 @item V F
19659 @kindex V F (Summary)
19660 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19661 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19662 after editing score files.
19663
19664 @item V C
19665 @kindex V C (Summary)
19666 @findex gnus-score-customize
19667 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19668 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19669
19670 @end table
19671
19672 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19673
19674 @table @kbd
19675
19676 @item V m
19677 @kindex V m (Summary)
19678 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19679 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19680 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19681
19682 @item V x
19683 @kindex V x (Summary)
19684 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19685 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19686 expunge all articles below this score
19687 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19688 @end table
19689
19690 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19691 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19692 them.)
19693
19694 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19695 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19696
19697 @enumerate
19698 @item
19699 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19700 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19701 @item
19702 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19703 keys are available:
19704 @table @kbd
19705
19706 @item a
19707 Score on the author name.
19708
19709 @item s
19710 Score on the subject line.
19711
19712 @item x
19713 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19714
19715 @item r
19716 Score on the @code{References} line.
19717
19718 @item d
19719 Score on the date.
19720
19721 @item l
19722 Score on the number of lines.
19723
19724 @item i
19725 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19726
19727 @item e
19728 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19729 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19730
19731 @item f
19732 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19733 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19734 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19735
19736 @item b
19737 Score on the body.
19738
19739 @item h
19740 Score on the head.
19741
19742 @item t
19743 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19744 files.)
19745
19746 @end table
19747
19748 @item
19749 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19750 what headers you are scoring on.
19751
19752 @table @code
19753
19754 @item strings
19755
19756 @table @kbd
19757
19758 @item e
19759 Exact matching.
19760
19761 @item s
19762 Substring matching.
19763
19764 @item f
19765 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19766
19767 @item r
19768 Regexp matching
19769 @end table
19770
19771 @item date
19772 @table @kbd
19773
19774 @item b
19775 Before date.
19776
19777 @item a
19778 After date.
19779
19780 @item n
19781 This date.
19782 @end table
19783
19784 @item number
19785 @table @kbd
19786
19787 @item <
19788 Less than number.
19789
19790 @item =
19791 Equal to number.
19792
19793 @item >
19794 Greater than number.
19795 @end table
19796 @end table
19797
19798 @item
19799 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19800 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19801 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19802 file.
19803 @table @kbd
19804
19805 @item t
19806 Temporary score entry.
19807
19808 @item p
19809 Permanent score entry.
19810
19811 @item i
19812 Immediately scoring.
19813 @end table
19814
19815 @item
19816 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19817 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19818 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19819
19820 @end enumerate
19821
19822 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19823 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19824 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19825 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19826
19827 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19828 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19829 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19830 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19831 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19832
19833 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19834 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19835 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19836 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19837 current score file.
19838
19839 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19840 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19841 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19842
19843
19844 @node Group Score Commands
19845 @section Group Score Commands
19846 @cindex group score commands
19847
19848 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19849
19850 @table @kbd
19851
19852 @item W f
19853 @kindex W f (Group)
19854 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19855 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19856 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19857 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19858
19859 @end table
19860
19861 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19862
19863 @findex gnus-batch-score
19864 @cindex batch scoring
19865 @example
19866 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19867 @end example
19868
19869
19870 @node Score Variables
19871 @section Score Variables
19872 @cindex score variables
19873
19874 @table @code
19875
19876 @item gnus-use-scoring
19877 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19878 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19879 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19880
19881 @item gnus-kill-killed
19882 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19883 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19884 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19885 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19886 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19887 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19888 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19889
19890 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19891 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19892 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19893 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19894 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19895
19896 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19897 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19898 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19899 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19900
19901 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19902 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19903 @cindex score cache
19904 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19905 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19906 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19907 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19908 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19909 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19910 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19911 be cached.
19912
19913 @item gnus-save-score
19914 @vindex gnus-save-score
19915 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19916 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19917 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19918
19919 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19920 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19921 across group visits.
19922
19923 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19924 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19925 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19926 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19927 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19928 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19929 manually entered data.
19930
19931 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19932 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19933 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19934
19935 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19936 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19937 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19938 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19939 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19940 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19941
19942 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19943 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19944 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19945 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19946
19947 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19948 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19949 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19950 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19951
19952 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19953 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19954 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19955 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19956
19957 Predefined functions available are:
19958 @table @code
19959
19960 @item gnus-score-find-single
19961 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19962 Only apply the group's own score file.
19963
19964 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19965 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19966 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19967 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19968 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19969 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19970 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19971 then a regexp match is done.
19972
19973 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19974 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19975
19976 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19977 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19978 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19979 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19980
19981 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19982 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19983 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19984 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19985 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19986 server.
19987
19988 @end table
19989 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19990 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19991 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19992 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19993 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19994 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19995 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19996 Phu.
19997
19998 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19999 overall score file, you could use the value
20000 @example
20001 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
20002 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
20003 @end example
20004
20005 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
20006 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
20007 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
20008 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
20009 are expired. It's 7 by default.
20010
20011 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
20012 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
20013 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
20014 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
20015 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
20016 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
20017 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
20018 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
20019
20020 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
20021 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
20022 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
20023
20024 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
20025 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
20026 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
20027 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
20028 threading---according to the current value of
20029 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
20030 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
20031 simplified in this manner.
20032
20033 @end table
20034
20035
20036 @node Score File Format
20037 @section Score File Format
20038 @cindex score file format
20039
20040 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
20041 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
20042 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
20043
20044 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
20045
20046 @lisp
20047 (("from"
20048 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
20049 ("Per Abrahamsen")
20050 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
20051 ("subject"
20052 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
20053 ("xref"
20054 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
20055 ("lines"
20056 (2 -100 nil <))
20057 (mark 0)
20058 (expunge -1000)
20059 (mark-and-expunge -10)
20060 (read-only nil)
20061 (orphan -10)
20062 (adapt t)
20063 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
20064 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
20065 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
20066 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
20067 (eval (ding)))
20068 @end lisp
20069
20070 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
20071 Scoring}, for a different approach.
20072
20073 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
20074 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
20075 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
20076
20077 Six keys are supported by this alist:
20078
20079 @table @code
20080
20081 @item STRING
20082 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
20083 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
20084 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
20085 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
20086 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
20087 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
20088 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
20089 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
20090 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
20091 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
20092 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
20093 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
20094 to articles that matches these score entries.
20095
20096 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
20097 score entry has one to four elements.
20098 @enumerate
20099
20100 @item
20101 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
20102 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
20103 integer.
20104
20105 @item
20106 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
20107 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
20108 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
20109 is successful. If this element is not present, the
20110 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
20111 instead. This is 1000 by default.
20112
20113 @item
20114 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
20115 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
20116 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
20117 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
20118 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
20119
20120 @item
20121 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
20122 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
20123 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
20124 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
20125 @table @dfn
20126
20127 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
20128 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
20129 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
20130 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
20131 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
20132 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
20133 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
20134 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
20135 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
20136 instead, if you feel like.
20137
20138 @item Extra
20139 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
20140 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
20141 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
20142 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
20143 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
20144 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
20145 overviews:
20146
20147 @lisp
20148 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
20149 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
20150 @end lisp
20151
20152 @item Lines, Chars
20153 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
20154 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
20155
20156 These predicates are true if
20157
20158 @example
20159 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
20160 @end example
20161
20162 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
20163 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
20164 following form:
20165
20166 @lisp
20167 (< header-value 4)
20168 @end lisp
20169
20170 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
20171 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
20172 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
20173 it's not. I think.)
20174
20175 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
20176 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
20177 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
20178 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
20179
20180 @item Date
20181 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
20182 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
20183 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
20184 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
20185 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
20186 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
20187 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
20188
20189 @cindex ISO8601
20190 @cindex date
20191 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
20192 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
20193 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20194 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20195 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20196 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20197 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20198 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20199 whole family, eh?)
20200
20201 @item Head, Body, All
20202 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
20203 header uses.
20204
20205 @item Followup
20206 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20207 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20208 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
20209 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
20210 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20211 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20212 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20213 files.)
20214
20215 @item Thread
20216 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20217 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20218 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20219 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20220 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20221 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20222 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20223 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20224 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20225 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20226 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20227 @end table
20228 @end enumerate
20229
20230 @cindex score file atoms
20231 @item mark
20232 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20233 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20234
20235 @item expunge
20236 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20237 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20238
20239 @item mark-and-expunge
20240 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20241 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20242 summary buffer.
20243
20244 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20245 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20246 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20247 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20248 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20249
20250 @item files
20251 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20252 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20253 this one was.
20254
20255 @item exclude-files
20256 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20257 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20258 other.
20259
20260 @item eval
20261 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
20262 ignored when handling global score files.
20263
20264 @item read-only
20265 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20266 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20267 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20268 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20269
20270 @item orphan
20271 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20272 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20273 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20274 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20275
20276 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20277
20278 @example
20279 (orphan -500)
20280 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20281 @end example
20282
20283 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20284 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20285 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
20286 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20287 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20288
20289 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20290 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20291 scoring rules exist.
20292
20293 @item adapt
20294 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20295 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20296 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20297 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20298 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20299 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20300 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20301 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20302 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20303 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20304 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20305 it.
20306
20307 @item adapt-file
20308 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20309 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20310 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20311 file for a number of groups.
20312
20313 @item local
20314 @cindex local variables
20315 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20316 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20317 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20318 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20319 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20320 be evaluated.
20321 @end table
20322
20323
20324 @node Score File Editing
20325 @section Score File Editing
20326
20327 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20328 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20329 with a mode for that.
20330
20331 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20332 additional commands:
20333
20334 @table @kbd
20335
20336 @item C-c C-c
20337 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20338 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
20339 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20340 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
20341
20342 @item C-c C-d
20343 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20344 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20345 Insert the current date in numerical format
20346 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20347 you were wondering.
20348
20349 @item C-c C-p
20350 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20351 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20352 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20353 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20354 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20355 you.
20356
20357 @end table
20358
20359 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20360
20361 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20362 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20363
20364 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20365 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20366
20367
20368 @node Adaptive Scoring
20369 @section Adaptive Scoring
20370 @cindex adaptive scoring
20371
20372 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20373 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20374 stupidity, to be precise.
20375
20376 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20377 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20378 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20379 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20380 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20381 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20382 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20383 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20384 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20385
20386 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20387 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20388 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20389 might look something like this:
20390
20391 @lisp
20392 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20393 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20394 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20395 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20396 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20397 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20398 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20399 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20400 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20401 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20402 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20403 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20404 @end lisp
20405
20406 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20407 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20408 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20409 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20410 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20411 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20412 entries.
20413
20414 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20415 will be applied to each article.
20416
20417 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20418 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20419 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20420 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20421
20422 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20423 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20424 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20425 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20426
20427 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20428 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20429 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20430 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20431
20432 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20433 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20434 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20435 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20436 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20437 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20438
20439 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20440 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20441 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20442
20443 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20444 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20445 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20446
20447 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20448 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20449 let you use different rules in different groups.
20450
20451 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20452 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20453 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20454 is @file{ADAPT}.
20455
20456 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20457 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20458 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20459 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20460 the length of the match is less than
20461 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20462 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20463 this problem.
20464
20465 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20466 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20467 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20468 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20469 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20470
20471 @lisp
20472 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20473 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20474 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20475 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20476 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20477 @end lisp
20478
20479 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20480 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20481 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20482 score with 30 points.
20483
20484 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20485 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20486 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20487 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20488 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20489
20490 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20491 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20492 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20493 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20494 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20495
20496 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20497 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20498 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20499 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20500
20501 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20502 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20503 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20504 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20505
20506 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20507 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20508 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20509 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20510 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20511
20512 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20513 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20514 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20515
20516 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20517 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20518 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20519 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20520
20521
20522 @node Home Score File
20523 @section Home Score File
20524
20525 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20526 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20527 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20528 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20529
20530 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20531 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20532 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20533
20534 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20535 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20536 be:
20537
20538 @enumerate
20539 @item
20540 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20541 groups.
20542
20543 @item
20544 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20545 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20546 parameter.
20547
20548 @item
20549 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20550
20551 @enumerate
20552 @item
20553 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20554 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20555
20556 @item
20557 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20558 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20559 name of the group as the parameter.
20560
20561 @item
20562 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20563 @end enumerate
20564
20565 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20566 for matches.
20567
20568 @end enumerate
20569
20570 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20571
20572 @lisp
20573 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20574 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20575 @end lisp
20576
20577 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20578 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20579
20580 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20581 @lisp
20582 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20583 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20584 @end lisp
20585
20586 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20587 Other functions include
20588
20589 @table @code
20590 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20591 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20592 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20593 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20594
20595 @end table
20596
20597 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20598 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20599 their own home score files:
20600
20601 @lisp
20602 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20603 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20604 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20605 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20606 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20607 @end lisp
20608
20609 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20610 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20611 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20612 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20613 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20614
20615 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20616 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20617 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20618 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20619 precedence over this variable.
20620
20621
20622 @node Followups To Yourself
20623 @section Followups To Yourself
20624
20625 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20626 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20627 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20628 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20629 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20630 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20631
20632 @table @code
20633
20634 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20635 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20636 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20637 article.
20638
20639 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20640 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20641 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20642 your own article.
20643 @end table
20644
20645 @vindex message-sent-hook
20646 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20647 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20648 @lisp
20649 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20650 @end lisp
20651
20652
20653 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20654 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20655 mine:
20656
20657 @example
20658 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20659 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20660 @end example
20661
20662 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20663 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20664 myself:
20665
20666 @lisp
20667 ("references"
20668 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20669 1000 nil r))
20670 @end lisp
20671
20672 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20673 is system-dependent.
20674
20675
20676 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20677 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20678 @cindex scoring on other headers
20679
20680 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20681 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20682 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20683 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20684 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20685
20686 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
20687 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20688 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20689 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20690 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20691
20692 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20693
20694 @lisp
20695 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20696 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20697 @end lisp
20698
20699 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20700 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20701 time if you have much mail.
20702
20703 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20704 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20705
20706 See? Simple.
20707
20708
20709 @node Scoring Tips
20710 @section Scoring Tips
20711 @cindex scoring tips
20712
20713 @table @dfn
20714
20715 @item Crossposts
20716 @cindex crossposts
20717 @cindex scoring crossposts
20718 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20719 the @code{Xref} header.
20720 @lisp
20721 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20722 @end lisp
20723
20724 @item Multiple crossposts
20725 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20726 more than, say, 3 groups:
20727 @lisp
20728 ("xref"
20729 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20730 -1000 nil r))
20731 @end lisp
20732
20733 @item Matching on the body
20734 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20735 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20736 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20737 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20738 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20739 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20740 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20741 the matches.
20742
20743 @item Marking as read
20744 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20745 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20746 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20747 @lisp
20748 ((mark -100))
20749 @end lisp
20750 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20751
20752 @item Negated character classes
20753 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20754 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20755 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20756 @end table
20757
20758
20759 @node Reverse Scoring
20760 @section Reverse Scoring
20761 @cindex reverse scoring
20762
20763 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20764 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20765 like this in your score file:
20766
20767 @lisp
20768 (("subject"
20769 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20770 (mark 1)
20771 (expunge 1))
20772 @end lisp
20773
20774 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20775 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20776
20777
20778 @node Global Score Files
20779 @section Global Score Files
20780 @cindex global score files
20781
20782 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20783 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20784 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20785
20786 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20787 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20788 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20789
20790 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20791 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20792 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20793 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20794 files are applicable to which group.
20795
20796 To use the score file
20797 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20798 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20799 say this:
20800
20801 @lisp
20802 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20803 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20804 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20805 @end lisp
20806
20807 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20808 @noindent
20809 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20810 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20811 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20812 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20813
20814 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20815 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20816
20817 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20818 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20819 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20820 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20821 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20822 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20823
20824 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20825 head:
20826
20827 @itemize @bullet
20828
20829 @item
20830 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20831 @item
20832 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20833 @item
20834 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20835 @item
20836 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20837 lowered out of existence.
20838 @item
20839 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20840 articles completely.
20841
20842 @item
20843 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20844 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20845 old articles for a long time.
20846 @end itemize
20847
20848 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20849 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20850 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20851 holding our breath yet?
20852
20853
20854 @node Kill Files
20855 @section Kill Files
20856 @cindex kill files
20857
20858 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20859 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20860 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20861
20862 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20863 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20864 files into score files.
20865
20866 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20867 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20868 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20869 that isn't a very good idea.
20870
20871 Normal kill files look like this:
20872
20873 @lisp
20874 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20875 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20876 (gnus-expunge "X")
20877 @end lisp
20878
20879 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20880 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20881
20882 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20883 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20884 interpreting it.
20885
20886 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20887
20888 @table @kbd
20889
20890 @item M-k
20891 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20892 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20893 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20894
20895 @item M-K
20896 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20897 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20898 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20899 @end table
20900
20901 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20902
20903 @table @kbd
20904
20905 @item M-k
20906 @kindex M-k (Group)
20907 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20908 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20909
20910 @item M-K
20911 @kindex M-K (Group)
20912 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20913 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20914 @end table
20915
20916 Kill file variables:
20917
20918 @table @code
20919 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20920 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20921 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20922 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20923 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20924 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20925 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20926
20927 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20928 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20929 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20930 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20931 kills.
20932
20933 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20934 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20935 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20936 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20937 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20938 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20939 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20940 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20941 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20942
20943 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20944 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20945 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20946
20947 @end table
20948
20949
20950 @node Converting Kill Files
20951 @section Converting Kill Files
20952 @cindex kill files
20953 @cindex converting kill files
20954
20955 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20956 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20957 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20958 by hand.
20959
20960 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20961 You can fetch it from
20962 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20963
20964 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20965 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20966 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20967 before.
20968
20969
20970 @node GroupLens
20971 @section GroupLens
20972 @cindex GroupLens
20973
20974 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20975 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20976
20977 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20978 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20979 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20980 news articles generated every day.
20981
20982 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20983 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20984 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20985 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20986 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20987 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20988 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20989 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20990 article.
20991
20992 @menu
20993 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20994 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20995 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20996 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20997 @end menu
20998
20999
21000 @node Using GroupLens
21001 @subsection Using GroupLens
21002
21003 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
21004 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
21005 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
21006
21007 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
21008
21009 @table @code
21010
21011 @item gnus-use-grouplens
21012 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
21013 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
21014 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
21015
21016 @item grouplens-pseudonym
21017 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
21018 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
21019 with the Better Bit Bureau.
21020
21021 @item grouplens-newsgroups
21022 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
21023 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
21024
21025 @end table
21026
21027 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
21028 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
21029 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
21030 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
21031 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
21032 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
21033
21034
21035 @node Rating Articles
21036 @subsection Rating Articles
21037
21038 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
21039 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
21040 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
21041 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
21042 like this one?''
21043
21044 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
21045
21046 @table @kbd
21047
21048 @item r
21049 @kindex r (GroupLens)
21050 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
21051 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
21052
21053 @item k
21054 @kindex k (GroupLens)
21055 @findex grouplens-score-thread
21056 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
21057 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
21058 threads in rec.humor.
21059
21060 @end table
21061
21062 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
21063 the score of the article you're reading.
21064
21065 @table @kbd
21066
21067 @item 1-5 n
21068 @kindex n (GroupLens)
21069 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
21070 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
21071
21072 @item 1-5 ,
21073 @kindex , (GroupLens)
21074 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
21075 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
21076
21077 @end table
21078
21079 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
21080 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
21081
21082
21083 @node Displaying Predictions
21084 @subsection Displaying Predictions
21085
21086 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
21087 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
21088 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
21089 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
21090 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
21091
21092 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
21093 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
21094 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
21095 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
21096 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
21097 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
21098 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
21099 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
21100 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
21101 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
21102 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
21103 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
21104 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
21105
21106 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
21107 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
21108 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
21109 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
21110
21111 The following are valid values for that variable.
21112
21113 @table @code
21114 @item prediction-spot
21115 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
21116 displayed.
21117
21118 @item confidence-interval
21119 A numeric confidence interval.
21120
21121 @item prediction-bar
21122 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
21123
21124 @item confidence-bar
21125 Numerical confidence.
21126
21127 @item confidence-spot
21128 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
21129
21130 @item prediction-num
21131 Plain-old numeric value.
21132
21133 @item confidence-plus-minus
21134 Prediction +/- confidence.
21135
21136 @end table
21137
21138
21139 @node GroupLens Variables
21140 @subsection GroupLens Variables
21141
21142 @table @code
21143
21144 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
21145 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
21146 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
21147 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
21148 %s\n}.
21149
21150 @item grouplens-bbb-host
21151 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
21152 default.
21153
21154 @item grouplens-bbb-port
21155 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
21156
21157 @item grouplens-score-offset
21158 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
21159 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
21160 default is 0.
21161
21162 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
21163 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
21164 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
21165
21166 @end table
21167
21168
21169 @node Advanced Scoring
21170 @section Advanced Scoring
21171
21172 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
21173 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
21174 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
21175 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
21176 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
21177
21178 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
21179 scoring patterns.
21180
21181 @menu
21182 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
21183 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
21184 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
21185 @end menu
21186
21187
21188 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
21189 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
21190
21191 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
21192 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
21193 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
21194 non-@code{nil} value.
21195
21196 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
21197 operator, and various match operators.
21198
21199 Logical operators:
21200
21201 @table @code
21202 @item &
21203 @itemx and
21204 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
21205 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
21206 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
21207 @code{true}.
21208
21209 @item |
21210 @itemx or
21211 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
21212 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
21213 then this operator will return @code{false}.
21214
21215 @item !
21216 @itemx not
21217 @itemx ¬
21218 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
21219 logical negation of the value of its argument.
21220
21221 @end table
21222
21223 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
21224 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
21225 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
21226 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
21227 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
21228 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
21229 the ancestry you want to go.
21230
21231 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
21232 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
21233 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
21234 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
21235 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
21236
21237
21238 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
21239 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
21240
21241 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
21242 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
21243 of parentheses.
21244
21245 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
21246 when he's talking about Gnus:
21247
21248 @example
21249 @group
21250 ((&
21251 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
21252 ("subject" "Gnus"))
21253 1000)
21254 @end group
21255 @end example
21256
21257 Quite simple, huh?
21258
21259 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
21260
21261 @example
21262 ((&
21263 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
21264 (|
21265 ("subject" "Gnus")
21266 ("lines" 100 >)))
21267 1000)
21268 @end example
21269
21270 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
21271 really don't want to read what he's written:
21272
21273 @example
21274 ((&
21275 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
21276 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
21277 -100000)
21278 @end example
21279
21280 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
21281 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
21282 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
21283 very interesting:
21284
21285 @example
21286 ((&
21287 (1-
21288 (&
21289 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
21290 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
21291 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
21292 ("body" "white.*socks"))
21293 1000)
21294 @end example
21295
21296 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
21297 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
21298 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
21299 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
21300
21301 @example
21302 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
21303 -200)
21304 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
21305 200)
21306 @end example
21307
21308 The possibilities are endless.
21309
21310 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
21311 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
21312
21313 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
21314 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
21315 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
21316 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
21317 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
21318 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
21319 @samp{subject}) first.
21320
21321 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
21322 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
21323 something like:
21324
21325 @example
21326 ...
21327 (1-
21328 (1-
21329 ("from" "lars")))
21330 ...
21331 @end example
21332
21333 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
21334 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
21335
21336 @example
21337 (1-
21338 (&
21339 ("from" "Lars")
21340 ("subject" "Gnus")))
21341 @end example
21342
21343 than it is to say:
21344
21345 @example
21346 (&
21347 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
21348 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
21349 @end example
21350
21351
21352 @node Score Decays
21353 @section Score Decays
21354 @cindex score decays
21355 @cindex decays
21356
21357 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
21358 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
21359 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
21360 use them in any sensible way.
21361
21362 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
21363 @findex gnus-decay-score
21364 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
21365 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
21366 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
21367 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
21368 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
21369 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
21370 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
21371 definition of that function:
21372
21373 @lisp
21374 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
21375 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
21376 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
21377 (let ((n (- score
21378 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
21379 (min (abs score)
21380 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
21381 (* (abs score)
21382 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
21383 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
21384 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
21385 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
21386 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
21387 (string-to-number
21388 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
21389 (floor n))))
21390 @end lisp
21391
21392 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
21393 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
21394 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
21395 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
21396
21397 @enumerate
21398 @item
21399 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
21400
21401 @item
21402 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
21403
21404 @item
21405 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21406 score.
21407 @end enumerate
21408
21409 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21410 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21411 the new score, which should be an integer.
21412
21413 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21414 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21415
21416 @iftex
21417 @iflatex
21418 @chapter Message
21419 @include message.texi
21420 @chapter Emacs MIME
21421 @include emacs-mime.texi
21422 @chapter Sieve
21423 @include sieve.texi
21424 @chapter PGG
21425 @include pgg.texi
21426 @end iflatex
21427 @end iftex
21428
21429 @node Various
21430 @chapter Various
21431
21432 @menu
21433 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
21434 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
21435 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
21436 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
21437 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
21438 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
21439 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
21440 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
21441 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
21442 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
21443 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
21444 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
21445 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
21446 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
21447 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
21448 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
21449 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
21450 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
21451 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
21452 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
21453 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
21454 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
21455 @end menu
21456
21457
21458 @node Process/Prefix
21459 @section Process/Prefix
21460 @cindex process/prefix convention
21461
21462 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
21463 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
21464
21465 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
21466 command to be performed on.
21467
21468 It goes like this:
21469
21470 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
21471 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
21472 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
21473 with the current one.
21474
21475 @vindex transient-mark-mode
21476 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
21477 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
21478
21479 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
21480 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
21481 the process mark.
21482
21483 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
21484 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
21485
21486 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
21487 are avoided.
21488
21489 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
21490 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
21491 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
21492 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
21493
21494 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
21495 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
21496 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
21497 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
21498 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
21499 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
21500 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
21501 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
21502
21503 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
21504 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
21505 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
21506 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
21507 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
21508
21509
21510 @node Interactive
21511 @section Interactive
21512 @cindex interaction
21513
21514 @table @code
21515
21516 @item gnus-novice-user
21517 @vindex gnus-novice-user
21518 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
21519 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
21520 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
21521 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
21522 default.
21523
21524 @item gnus-expert-user
21525 @vindex gnus-expert-user
21526 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
21527 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
21528 matter how strange.
21529
21530 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
21531 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
21532 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
21533 is @code{t} by default.
21534
21535 @item gnus-interactive-exit
21536 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
21537 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
21538 default.
21539 @end table
21540
21541
21542 @node Symbolic Prefixes
21543 @section Symbolic Prefixes
21544 @cindex symbolic prefixes
21545
21546 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
21547 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
21548 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
21549 rule of 900 to the current article.
21550
21551 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
21552 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
21553 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
21554 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
21555 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
21556 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
21557 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
21558
21559 @kindex M-i (Summary)
21560 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
21561 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
21562 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
21563 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
21564 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
21565 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
21566 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
21567 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
21568
21569 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
21570 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
21571 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
21572
21573 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
21574 Interactive}.
21575
21576
21577 @node Formatting Variables
21578 @section Formatting Variables
21579 @cindex formatting variables
21580
21581 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
21582 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
21583 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
21584 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
21585 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
21586 be annoyed by.
21587
21588 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
21589 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
21590 lots of percentages everywhere.
21591
21592 @menu
21593 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
21594 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
21595 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
21596 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
21597 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
21598 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
21599 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
21600 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
21601 @end menu
21602
21603 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
21604 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
21605 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
21606 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
21607 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
21608 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
21609 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
21610 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
21611
21612 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
21613 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
21614
21615 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
21616 @findex gnus-update-format
21617 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
21618 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
21619 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
21620 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
21621
21622
21623
21624 @node Formatting Basics
21625 @subsection Formatting Basics
21626
21627 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
21628 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
21629 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
21630
21631 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
21632 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
21633 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
21634 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
21635 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
21636 the right instead.
21637
21638 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
21639 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
21640 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
21641 less than 4 characters wide.
21642
21643 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
21644 @samp{%&user-date;}.
21645
21646
21647 @node Mode Line Formatting
21648 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
21649
21650 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
21651 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
21652 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
21653 with the following two differences:
21654
21655 @enumerate
21656
21657 @item
21658 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
21659
21660 @item
21661 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
21662 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
21663 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
21664 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
21665 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
21666 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
21667 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
21668
21669 @end enumerate
21670
21671
21672 @node Advanced Formatting
21673 @subsection Advanced Formatting
21674
21675 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
21676 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
21677 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
21678 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
21679
21680 These are the valid modifiers:
21681
21682 @table @code
21683 @item pad
21684 @itemx pad-left
21685 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
21686 length.
21687
21688 @item pad-right
21689 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
21690 length.
21691
21692 @item max
21693 @itemx max-left
21694 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
21695
21696 @item max-right
21697 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
21698 length.
21699
21700 @item cut
21701 @itemx cut-left
21702 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
21703
21704 @item cut-right
21705 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
21706
21707 @item ignore
21708 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
21709
21710 @item form
21711 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
21712 used.
21713
21714 Here's an example:
21715
21716 @lisp
21717 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
21718 @end lisp
21719
21720 @end table
21721
21722 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
21723 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
21724 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
21725 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
21726 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
21727 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
21728 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
21729
21730 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
21731 last operation, padding.
21732
21733 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
21734 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
21735 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
21736 @xref{Compilation}.
21737
21738
21739 @node User-Defined Specs
21740 @subsection User-Defined Specs
21741
21742 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
21743 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
21744 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
21745 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
21746 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
21747 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
21748 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
21749 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
21750 should protect against that.
21751
21752 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
21753 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
21754
21755 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
21756 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
21757 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
21758 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
21759 inserted.
21760
21761
21762 @node Formatting Fonts
21763 @subsection Formatting Fonts
21764
21765 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
21766 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
21767 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
21768 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
21769 over it.
21770
21771 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
21772 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
21773 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
21774 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
21775 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
21776 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
21777
21778 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
21779 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
21780 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
21781 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
21782 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
21783 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
21784 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
21785 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
21786 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
21787 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
21788 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
21789 paragraph.)
21790
21791 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
21792
21793 @lisp
21794 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
21795 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
21796 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
21797
21798 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
21799 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
21800 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
21801 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
21802 ;; @r{Set the color.}
21803 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
21804 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21805
21806 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21807 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21808 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21809 @end lisp
21810
21811 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21812 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21813
21814 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21815 mode-line variables.
21816
21817 @node Positioning Point
21818 @subsection Positioning Point
21819
21820 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21821 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21822 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21823
21824 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21825
21826 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21827 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21828 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21829
21830 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21831 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21832 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21833 place point there.
21834
21835
21836 @node Tabulation
21837 @subsection Tabulation
21838
21839 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21840 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21841 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21842 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21843
21844 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21845 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21846
21847 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21848 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21849 This is the soft tabulator.
21850
21851 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21852 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21853 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21854
21855
21856 @node Wide Characters
21857 @subsection Wide Characters
21858
21859 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21860 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21861 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21862
21863 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21864 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21865 these countries, that's not true.
21866
21867 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21868 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21869 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21870 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21871 for Emacs.
21872
21873
21874 @node Window Layout
21875 @section Window Layout
21876 @cindex window layout
21877
21878 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21879
21880 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21881 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21882 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21883 @code{t} by default.
21884
21885 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21886 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21887
21888 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21889 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21890 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21891
21892 @lisp
21893 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21894 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21895 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21896 (article 1.0))))
21897 @end lisp
21898
21899 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21900 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21901 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21902 possible names is listed below.
21903
21904 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21905 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21906
21907 @lisp
21908 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21909 (article 1.0)))
21910 @end lisp
21911
21912 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21913 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21914 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21915 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21916 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21917 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21918 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21919 size spec per split.
21920
21921 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21922 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21923 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21924 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21925 present) gets focus.
21926
21927 Here's a more complicated example:
21928
21929 @lisp
21930 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21931 (summary 0.25 point)
21932 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21933 (article 1.0)))
21934 @end lisp
21935
21936 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21937 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21938 occupy, not a percentage.
21939
21940 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21941 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21942 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21943 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21944 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21945 is non-@code{nil}.
21946
21947 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21948
21949 @lisp
21950 (article (horizontal 1.0
21951 (vertical 0.5
21952 (group 1.0)
21953 (gnus-carpal 4))
21954 (vertical 1.0
21955 (summary 0.25 point)
21956 (summary-carpal 4)
21957 (article 1.0))))
21958 @end lisp
21959
21960 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21961 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21962
21963 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21964 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21965 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21966 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21967 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21968
21969 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21970 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21971 lines from the splits.
21972
21973 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21974 may look like:
21975
21976 @example
21977 @group
21978 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21979 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21980 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21981 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21982 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21983 size = number | frame-params
21984 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21985 @end group
21986 @end example
21987
21988 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21989 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21990 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21991 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21992
21993 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21994 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21995 @cindex window height
21996 @cindex window width
21997 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21998 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21999 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22000 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22001 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22002 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22003
22004 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22005 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22006 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22007 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22008
22009 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22010 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22011 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22012 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22013 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22014 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22015 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22016 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22017 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22018 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22019 configuration list.
22020
22021 @lisp
22022 (gnus-configure-frame
22023 '(horizontal 1.0
22024 (vertical 10
22025 (group 1.0)
22026 (article 0.3 point))
22027 (vertical 1.0
22028 (article 1.0)
22029 (horizontal 4
22030 (group 1.0)
22031 (article 10)))))
22032 @end lisp
22033
22034 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22035 @code{frame} split:
22036
22037 @lisp
22038 (gnus-configure-frame
22039 '(frame 1.0
22040 (vertical 1.0
22041 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22042 (article 1.0))
22043 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22044 (user-position . t)
22045 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22046 (picon 1.0))))
22047
22048 @end lisp
22049
22050 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22051 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22052 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22053 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22054 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22055 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22056 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22057 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22058 is such a plist.
22059 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22060 be found in its default value.
22061
22062 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22063 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22064 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22065 might be used:
22066
22067 @lisp
22068 (message (horizontal 1.0
22069 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22070 (vertical 0.24
22071 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22072 '(summary 0.5))
22073 (group 1.0))))
22074 @end lisp
22075
22076 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22077 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22078 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22079
22080 @lisp
22081 (message
22082 (frame 1.0
22083 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22084 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22085 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22086 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22087 (name . "Message"))
22088 (message 1.0 point))))
22089 @end lisp
22090
22091 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22092 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22093 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22094 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22095 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22096
22097 @lisp
22098 (gnus-add-configuration
22099 '(article (vertical 1.0
22100 (group 4)
22101 (summary .25 point)
22102 (article 1.0))))
22103 @end lisp
22104
22105 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22106 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22107 Gnus has been loaded.
22108
22109 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22110 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22111 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22112 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22113 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22114
22115 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22116 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22117 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22118 windows resized.
22119
22120 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22121
22122 @itemize @bullet
22123 @item
22124 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22125 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22126
22127 @ifinfo
22128 @example
22129 +---+---------+
22130 | G | Summary |
22131 | r +---------+
22132 | o | |
22133 | u | Article |
22134 | p | |
22135 +---+---------+
22136 @end example
22137 @end ifinfo
22138
22139 @lisp
22140 (gnus-add-configuration
22141 '(article
22142 (horizontal 1.0
22143 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22144 (vertical 1.0
22145 (summary 0.16 point)
22146 (article 1.0)))))
22147
22148 (gnus-add-configuration
22149 '(summary
22150 (horizontal 1.0
22151 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22152 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22153 @end lisp
22154
22155 @end itemize
22156
22157
22158 @node Faces and Fonts
22159 @section Faces and Fonts
22160 @cindex faces
22161 @cindex fonts
22162 @cindex colors
22163
22164 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22165 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22166 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22167 interface.
22168
22169
22170 @node Compilation
22171 @section Compilation
22172 @cindex compilation
22173 @cindex byte-compilation
22174
22175 @findex gnus-compile
22176
22177 Remember all those line format specification variables?
22178 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
22179 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
22180 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
22181 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
22182 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
22183 course.)
22184
22185 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
22186 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
22187 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
22188 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
22189 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
22190 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
22191 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
22192
22193
22194 @node Mode Lines
22195 @section Mode Lines
22196 @cindex mode lines
22197
22198 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22199 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22200 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22201 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22202 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22203 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22204 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22205 quicker.
22206
22207 @cindex display-time
22208
22209 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22210 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22211 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22212 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
22213 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22214 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22215 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
22216 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
22217 this variable:
22218
22219 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
22220 @lisp
22221 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
22222 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
22223 (+ 21
22224 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
22225 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
22226 (length display-time-string)))))
22227 @end lisp
22228
22229 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
22230 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
22231 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
22232 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
22233 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
22234
22235
22236 @node Highlighting and Menus
22237 @section Highlighting and Menus
22238 @cindex visual
22239 @cindex highlighting
22240 @cindex menus
22241
22242 @vindex gnus-visual
22243 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
22244 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
22245 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
22246 file.
22247
22248 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
22249 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
22250
22251 @table @code
22252 @item group-highlight
22253 Do highlights in the group buffer.
22254 @item summary-highlight
22255 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
22256 @item article-highlight
22257 Do highlights in the article buffer.
22258 @item highlight
22259 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
22260 @item group-menu
22261 Create menus in the group buffer.
22262 @item summary-menu
22263 Create menus in the summary buffers.
22264 @item article-menu
22265 Create menus in the article buffer.
22266 @item browse-menu
22267 Create menus in the browse buffer.
22268 @item server-menu
22269 Create menus in the server buffer.
22270 @item score-menu
22271 Create menus in the score buffers.
22272 @item menu
22273 Create menus in all buffers.
22274 @end table
22275
22276 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
22277 buffers, you could say something like:
22278
22279 @lisp
22280 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
22281 @end lisp
22282
22283 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
22284
22285 @lisp
22286 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
22287 @end lisp
22288
22289 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
22290 in all Gnus buffers.
22291
22292 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
22293
22294 @table @code
22295 @item gnus-mouse-face
22296 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22297 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
22298 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
22299
22300 @end table
22301
22302 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
22303
22304 @table @code
22305
22306 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
22307 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
22308 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
22309
22310 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
22311 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
22312 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
22313
22314 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
22315 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
22316 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
22317
22318 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
22319 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
22320 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
22321
22322 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
22323 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
22324 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
22325
22326 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
22327 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
22328 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
22329
22330 @end table
22331
22332
22333 @node Buttons
22334 @section Buttons
22335 @cindex buttons
22336 @cindex mouse
22337 @cindex click
22338
22339 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
22340 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
22341 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
22342 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
22343 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
22344
22345 Right.
22346
22347 @vindex gnus-carpal
22348 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
22349 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
22350 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
22351
22352
22353 @table @code
22354
22355 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
22356 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
22357 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
22358
22359 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
22360 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
22361 Face used on buttons.
22362
22363 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
22364 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
22365 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
22366
22367 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
22368 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
22369 Buttons in the group buffer.
22370
22371 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
22372 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
22373 Buttons in the summary buffer.
22374
22375 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
22376 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
22377 Buttons in the server buffer.
22378
22379 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
22380 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
22381 Buttons in the browse buffer.
22382 @end table
22383
22384 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
22385 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
22386 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
22387
22388
22389 @node Daemons
22390 @section Daemons
22391 @cindex demons
22392 @cindex daemons
22393
22394 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
22395 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
22396 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
22397 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
22398 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
22399
22400 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
22401 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
22402 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
22403
22404 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
22405 been idle for thirty minutes:
22406
22407 @lisp
22408 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
22409 @end lisp
22410
22411 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
22412 Emacs is idle:
22413
22414 @lisp
22415 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
22416 @end lisp
22417
22418 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
22419 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
22420 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
22421
22422 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
22423 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
22424 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
22425 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
22426
22427 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
22428 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
22429 @var{idle} minutes.
22430
22431 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
22432 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
22433 minutes.
22434
22435 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
22436 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
22437 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
22438
22439 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
22440 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
22441 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
22442 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
22443
22444 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
22445 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22446
22447 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
22448 @lisp
22449 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
22450 @end lisp
22451
22452 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
22453 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
22454 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
22455 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
22456 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
22457 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
22458 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
22459 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
22460 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
22461 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
22462 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
22463
22464 @findex gnus-demon-init
22465 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
22466 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
22467 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
22468 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
22469 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
22470
22471 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
22472 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
22473 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
22474 behave.
22475
22476
22477 @node NoCeM
22478 @section NoCeM
22479 @cindex nocem
22480 @cindex spam
22481
22482 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
22483 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
22484
22485 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
22486 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
22487 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
22488 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
22489 away.
22490
22491 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
22492 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
22493 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
22494 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
22495
22496 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
22497 this will make spam disappear.
22498
22499 There are some variables to customize, of course:
22500
22501 @table @code
22502 @item gnus-use-nocem
22503 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
22504 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
22505 by default.
22506
22507 You can also set this variable to a positive number as a group level.
22508 In that case, Gnus scans NoCeM messages when checking new news if this
22509 value is not exceeding a group level that you specify as the prefix
22510 argument to some commands, e.g. @code{gnus},
22511 @code{gnus-group-get-new-news}, etc. Otherwise, Gnus does not scan
22512 NoCeM messages if you specify a group level to those commands. For
22513 example, if you use 1 or 2 on the mail groups and the levels on the news
22514 groups remain the default, 3 is the best choice.
22515
22516 @item gnus-nocem-groups
22517 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
22518 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
22519 default is
22520 @lisp
22521 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
22522 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
22523 @end lisp
22524
22525 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
22526 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
22527 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
22528 people you want to listen to. The default is
22529 @lisp
22530 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
22531 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
22532 @end lisp
22533 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
22534
22535 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
22536 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
22537
22538 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
22539 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
22540 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
22541 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
22542 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
22543 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
22544 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
22545 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
22546 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
22547 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
22548
22549 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
22550 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
22551
22552 @lisp
22553 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
22554 @end lisp
22555
22556 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
22557 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
22558
22559 @lisp
22560 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
22561 @end lisp
22562
22563 The specs are applied left-to-right.
22564
22565
22566 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
22567 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
22568 @findex pgg-verify
22569 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
22570 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
22571 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
22572 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
22573 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
22574 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
22575
22576 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
22577 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
22578 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
22579 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
22580
22581 @item gnus-nocem-directory
22582 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
22583 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
22584 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
22585
22586 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
22587 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
22588 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
22589 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
22590 might then see old spam.
22591
22592 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
22593 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
22594 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
22595 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
22596 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
22597 issuers.
22598
22599 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
22600 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
22601 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
22602 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
22603
22604 @end table
22605
22606 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
22607 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
22608 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
22609 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
22610
22611
22612 @node Undo
22613 @section Undo
22614 @cindex undo
22615
22616 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
22617 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
22618 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
22619
22620 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
22621 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
22622 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
22623 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
22624 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
22625 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
22626 @code{undo} function.
22627
22628 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
22629 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
22630 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
22631 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
22632 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
22633 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
22634 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
22635 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
22636 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
22637 never be totally undoable.
22638
22639 @findex gnus-undo-mode
22640 @vindex gnus-use-undo
22641 @findex gnus-undo
22642 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
22643 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
22644 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
22645 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
22646 command.
22647
22648
22649 @node Predicate Specifiers
22650 @section Predicate Specifiers
22651 @cindex predicate specifiers
22652
22653 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
22654 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
22655 to type all that much.
22656
22657 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
22658
22659 Here's an example:
22660
22661 @lisp
22662 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
22663 gnus-article-unread-p)
22664 @end lisp
22665
22666 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
22667 functions all take one parameter.
22668
22669 @findex gnus-make-predicate
22670 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
22671 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
22672 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
22673 specifier.
22674
22675
22676 @node Moderation
22677 @section Moderation
22678 @cindex moderation
22679
22680 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
22681 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
22682 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
22683 get a copy.
22684
22685 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
22686 buffers. Put
22687
22688 @lisp
22689 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
22690 @end lisp
22691
22692 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
22693
22694 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
22695 supposed to work:
22696
22697 @enumerate
22698 @item
22699 You split your incoming mail by matching on
22700 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
22701 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
22702
22703 @item
22704 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
22705 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
22706
22707 @item
22708 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
22709 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
22710 @kbd{c} command.
22711 @end enumerate
22712
22713 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
22714
22715 @lisp
22716 (setq gnus-moderated-list
22717 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
22718 @end lisp
22719
22720
22721 @node Fetching a Group
22722 @section Fetching a Group
22723 @cindex fetching a group
22724
22725 @findex gnus-fetch-group
22726 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
22727 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
22728 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
22729 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
22730 It takes the group name as a parameter.
22731
22732
22733 @node Image Enhancements
22734 @section Image Enhancements
22735
22736 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
22737 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
22738 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
22739
22740 @menu
22741 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
22742 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
22743 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
22744 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
22745 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
22746 @end menu
22747
22748
22749 @node X-Face
22750 @subsection X-Face
22751 @cindex x-face
22752
22753 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
22754 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
22755 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
22756 readers.
22757
22758 @cindex x-face
22759 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
22760 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
22761 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
22762 @iftex
22763 @iflatex
22764 \include{xface}
22765 @end iflatex
22766 @end iftex
22767 @c @anchor{X-Face}
22768
22769 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
22770 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
22771 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
22772 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
22773 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
22774 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
22775 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
22776 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
22777 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
22778 @code{display} program.
22779
22780 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
22781 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
22782 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
22783 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
22784 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
22785 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
22786 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
22787 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
22788
22789 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
22790 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
22791 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
22792 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
22793 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
22794 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
22795
22796 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
22797 @code{xface}).
22798
22799 @noindent
22800 Face and variable:
22801
22802 @table @code
22803 @item gnus-x-face
22804 @vindex gnus-x-face
22805 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
22806 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
22807 default colors are black and white.
22808 @end table
22809
22810 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
22811 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
22812 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
22813 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
22814 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
22815 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
22816
22817 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22818 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22819 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22820 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22821 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22822 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22823 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22824 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22825 header data as a string.
22826
22827 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22828 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22829 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22830 randomly generated data.
22831
22832 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22833 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22834 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22835 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22836 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22837
22838 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22839 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22840
22841 @lisp
22842 (setq message-required-news-headers
22843 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22844 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22845 @end lisp
22846
22847 Using the last function would be something like this:
22848
22849 @lisp
22850 (setq message-required-news-headers
22851 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22852 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22853 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22854 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22855 @end lisp
22856
22857
22858 @node Face
22859 @subsection Face
22860 @cindex face
22861
22862 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
22863
22864 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22865 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22866 represent the author of the message.
22867
22868 @cindex face
22869 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22870 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22871 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22872 specifications.
22873
22874 Viewing an @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
22875 PNG images.
22876 @c Maybe add this:
22877 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
22878 @c (featurep 'png)
22879 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
22880
22881 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22882 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22883
22884 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22885 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22886 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22887
22888 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22889 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22890 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22891 converts the file to Face format by using the
22892 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22893
22894 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22895 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22896
22897 @lisp
22898 (setq message-required-news-headers
22899 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22900 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22901 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22902 @end lisp
22903
22904
22905 @node Smileys
22906 @subsection Smileys
22907 @cindex smileys
22908
22909 @iftex
22910 @iflatex
22911 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22912 \input{smiley}
22913 @end iflatex
22914 @end iftex
22915
22916 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22917 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22918
22919 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22920 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22921
22922 @lisp
22923 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22924 @end lisp
22925
22926 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22927 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22928 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22929 text and maps that to file names.
22930
22931 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22932 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22933 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22934 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22935 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22936 displayed.
22937
22938 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22939 files:
22940
22941 @table @code
22942
22943 @item smiley-data-directory
22944 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22945 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22946
22947 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22948 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22949 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22950
22951 @end table
22952
22953
22954 @node Picons
22955 @subsection Picons
22956
22957 @iftex
22958 @iflatex
22959 \include{picons}
22960 @end iflatex
22961 @end iftex
22962
22963 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22964 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22965 over your shoulder as you read news.
22966
22967 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22968
22969 @iftex
22970 @iflatex
22971 \margindex{}
22972 @end iflatex
22973 @end iftex
22974
22975 @quotation
22976 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22977 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22978 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22979 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22980 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22981 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22982 @code{GIF} formats.
22983 @end quotation
22984
22985 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22986 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22987 point your Web browser at
22988 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22989
22990 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22991 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22992
22993 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22994 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22995 Picons databases.
22996
22997 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22998
22999 @table @code
23000
23001 @item gnus-picon-databases
23002 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23003 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23004 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23005 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23006 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23007
23008 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23009 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23010 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23011 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23012
23013 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23014 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23015 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23016 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23017
23018 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23019 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23020 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23021 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23022 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23023
23024 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23025 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23026 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23027 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23028
23029 @end table
23030
23031
23032 @node XVarious
23033 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23034
23035 @table @code
23036 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23037 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23038 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23039 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23040 unusual directory structure.
23041
23042 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23043 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23044 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23045 default.
23046
23047 @end table
23048
23049 @subsubsection Toolbar
23050
23051 @table @code
23052
23053 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23054 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23055 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23056 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23057 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23058 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23059 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23060 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23061
23062 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23063 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23064 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23065 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23066 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23067 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23068
23069 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23070 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23071 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23072
23073 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23074 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23075 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23076
23077 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23078 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23079 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23080
23081 @end table
23082
23083 @iftex
23084 @iflatex
23085 \margindex{}
23086 @end iflatex
23087 @end iftex
23088
23089
23090 @node Fuzzy Matching
23091 @section Fuzzy Matching
23092 @cindex fuzzy matching
23093
23094 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23095 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23096
23097 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23098 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23099 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23100
23101 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23102 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23103 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23104 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23105 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23106
23107
23108 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23109 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23110 @cindex email spam
23111 @cindex spam
23112 @cindex UCE
23113 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23114
23115 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23116 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23117 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23118 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23119 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23120 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23121 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23122 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23123 in the end.
23124
23125 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23126 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23127 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23128 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23129 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23130 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23131
23132 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23133
23134 @menu
23135 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23136 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23137 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23138 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23139 @end menu
23140
23141 @node The problem of spam
23142 @subsection The problem of spam
23143 @cindex email spam
23144 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23145 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23146 @cindex UCE
23147 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23148
23149 First, some background on spam.
23150
23151 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23152 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23153 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23154 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23155 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23156 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23157 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23158 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23159 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23160
23161 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23162 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23163 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23164 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23165 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23166 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23167 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23168 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23169 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23170 and processing.
23171
23172 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23173 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23174 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23175 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23176 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23177 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23178 from Bulgarian IPs.
23179
23180 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23181 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23182 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
23183 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23184
23185 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23186 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23187 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23188 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23189
23190 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23191 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23192 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23193 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23194 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23195 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23196 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23197 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23198 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23199
23200 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23201 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23202 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23203 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23204 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23205 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23206 down for some time because of the incident.
23207
23208 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23209 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23210 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23211 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23212 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23213 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23214 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23215 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23216 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23217 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23218 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23219
23220 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23221 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23222 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23223 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23224 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23225 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23226 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23227 spam plague.
23228
23229 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23230 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23231 @cindex email spam
23232 @cindex spam
23233 @cindex UCE
23234 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23235
23236 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23237 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23238
23239 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23240 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23241 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23242 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23243 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23244 part of the mail address.)
23245
23246 @lisp
23247 (setq message-default-news-headers
23248 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23249 @end lisp
23250
23251 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23252 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23253
23254 @lisp
23255 (...
23256 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23257 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23258 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23259 "spam"))
23260 ...)
23261 @end lisp
23262
23263 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23264 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23265 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23266 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23267
23268 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23269 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23270 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23271 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23272 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23273 your fancy split rule in this way:
23274
23275 @lisp
23276 (
23277 ...
23278 (to "larsi" "misc")
23279 "spam")
23280 @end lisp
23281
23282 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23283 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23284 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23285 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23286 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23287
23288 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23289 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23290 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23291 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23292
23293 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23294
23295
23296 @node SpamAssassin
23297 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23298 @cindex SpamAssassin
23299 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23300 @cindex DCC
23301
23302 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23303 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23304 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23305 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23306 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23307 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23308 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23309
23310 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23311 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
23312 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
23313 recipes.
23314
23315 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
23316 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
23317 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
23318 Specifiers}) follow.
23319
23320 @lisp
23321 (setq mail-sources
23322 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
23323 (pop :user "jrl"
23324 :server "pophost"
23325 :postscript
23326 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
23327 @end lisp
23328
23329 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
23330 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
23331 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
23332
23333 @lisp
23334 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
23335 ...))
23336 @end lisp
23337
23338 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23339
23340 @lisp
23341 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
23342 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
23343 ...))
23344 @end lisp
23345
23346 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
23347 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
23348 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
23349 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
23350
23351 @lisp
23352 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
23353 ...))
23354 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
23355 (save-excursion
23356 (save-restriction
23357 (widen)
23358 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
23359 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
23360 "spam"))))
23361 @end lisp
23362
23363 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
23364 downloaded by default. You need to set
23365 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
23366 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
23367
23368 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
23369 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
23370 spam. And here is the nifty function:
23371
23372 @lisp
23373 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
23374 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
23375 (interactive)
23376 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
23377 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
23378 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
23379 @end lisp
23380
23381 @node Hashcash
23382 @subsection Hashcash
23383 @cindex hashcash
23384
23385 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
23386 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
23387 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
23388 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
23389 in smaller communities.
23390
23391 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
23392 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
23393 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
23394 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
23395 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
23396 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
23397 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
23398 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
23399 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
23400 one of them separately.
23401
23402 @cindex X-Hashcash
23403 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
23404 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
23405 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
23406 header. For more details, and for the external application
23407 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
23408 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
23409 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
23410
23411 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
23412 like:
23413
23414 @lisp
23415 (require 'hashcash)
23416 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
23417 @end lisp
23418
23419 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
23420 contrib directory or at
23421 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
23422
23423 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
23424
23425 @table @code
23426
23427 @item hashcash-default-payment
23428 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
23429 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
23430 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
23431 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
23432
23433 @item hashcash-payment-alist
23434 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
23435 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
23436 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
23437 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
23438 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
23439 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
23440 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
23441 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
23442
23443 @item hashcash
23444 @vindex hashcash
23445 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
23446
23447 @end table
23448
23449 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
23450 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
23451 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
23452 a useful contribution, however.
23453
23454 @node Spam Package
23455 @section Spam Package
23456 @cindex spam filtering
23457 @cindex spam
23458
23459 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
23460 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
23461 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
23462 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
23463
23464 @menu
23465 * Spam Package Introduction::
23466 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
23467 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
23468 * Spam and Ham Processors::
23469 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
23470 * Spam Back Ends::
23471 * Extending the Spam package::
23472 * Spam Statistics Package::
23473 @end menu
23474
23475 @node Spam Package Introduction
23476 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
23477 @cindex spam filtering
23478 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
23479 @cindex spam
23480
23481 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
23482 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
23483
23484 @cindex spam-initialize
23485 @vindex spam-use-stat
23486 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
23487 @code{spam-initialize}:
23488
23489 @example
23490 (spam-initialize)
23491 @end example
23492
23493 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
23494 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
23495 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
23496 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
23497 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
23498
23499 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
23500 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
23501
23502 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
23503 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
23504
23505 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
23506 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
23507 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
23508 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
23509 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
23510
23511 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
23512 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
23513 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
23514 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
23515 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
23516 Groups}.
23517
23518 @cindex spam back ends
23519 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
23520 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
23521 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
23522 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
23523 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
23524
23525 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
23526 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
23527
23528 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
23529 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
23530 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
23531 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
23532 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
23533 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
23534 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
23535
23536 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
23537 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
23538 point, the Spam package does several things:
23539
23540 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
23541 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
23542 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
23543 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
23544 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
23545 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
23546 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
23547 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
23548 Ham Processors}.
23549
23550 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
23551 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
23552 group:
23553
23554 @table @kbd
23555 @item M-d
23556 @itemx M s x
23557 @itemx S x
23558 @kindex M-d
23559 @kindex S x
23560 @kindex M s x
23561 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
23562 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
23563 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
23564 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
23565 @end table
23566
23567 @noindent
23568 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
23569 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
23570
23571 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
23572 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
23573 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
23574 to be processed as ham by setting
23575 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
23576 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
23577
23578 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23579 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23580 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
23581 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
23582 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
23583 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
23584 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
23585 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
23586 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
23587 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
23588 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
23589 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
23590
23591 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
23592 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
23593 want each article to be processed only once, load the
23594 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
23595 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
23596 Configuration Examples}.
23597
23598 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
23599 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
23600 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
23601 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
23602
23603 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
23604 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
23605
23606 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
23607 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
23608 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
23609
23610 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
23611 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
23612 @cindex spam filtering
23613 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
23614 @cindex spam
23615
23616 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
23617 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
23618 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
23619 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
23620 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
23621
23622 @example
23623 (: spam-split)
23624 @end example
23625
23626 @vindex spam-split-group
23627 @noindent
23628 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
23629 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
23630 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
23631 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
23632 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
23633 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
23634 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
23635 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
23636 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
23637
23638 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
23639
23640 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
23641 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
23642 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
23643 you should also set set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body}
23644 to @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can
23645 ``scan'' the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only
23646 retrieves the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells
23647 it to retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by
23648 default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
23649 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Splitting
23650 in IMAP}.
23651
23652 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
23653 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
23654 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
23655 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
23656 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
23657 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
23658 ends, and the following split rule:
23659
23660 @example
23661 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23662 (any "ding" "ding")
23663 (: spam-split)
23664 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23665 "mail")
23666 @end example
23667
23668 @noindent
23669 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
23670 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
23671 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
23672 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
23673 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
23674 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
23675
23676 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
23677 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
23678 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
23679 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
23680
23681 @example
23682 nnimap-split-fancy
23683 '(|
23684 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
23685 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23686 (any "ding" "ding")
23687 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
23688 (: spam-split)
23689 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23690 "mail")
23691 @end example
23692
23693 @noindent
23694 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
23695 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
23696 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
23697 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
23698 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
23699 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
23700 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
23701
23702 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23703 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23704 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23705 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
23706
23707 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
23708 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
23709 @c don't.}
23710
23711 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
23712 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
23713
23714 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
23715 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
23716 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
23717 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
23718
23719 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23720 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23721 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23722 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
23723
23724 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
23725 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
23726 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
23727
23728 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
23729 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
23730 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
23731 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
23732 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
23733 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
23734 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
23735
23736 @node Spam and Ham Processors
23737 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
23738 @cindex spam filtering
23739 @cindex spam filtering variables
23740 @cindex spam variables
23741 @cindex spam
23742
23743 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
23744 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
23745 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
23746 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
23747 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
23748 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
23749 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
23750
23751 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
23752 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
23753 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
23754 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
23755
23756 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23757 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
23758 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
23759 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
23760 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
23761 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
23762 by customizing the corresponding variable
23763 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
23764 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
23765 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
23766 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
23767 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
23768 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
23769 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
23770 default.
23771
23772 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
23773 @cindex $
23774 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
23775 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
23776 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
23777 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
23778 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
23779 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
23780 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
23781 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
23782 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
23783 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
23784 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
23785 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
23786 processor which will study them as spam samples.
23787
23788 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
23789 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
23790 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
23791 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
23792 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
23793 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
23794 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
23795 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
23796
23797 @defvar ham-marks
23798 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23799 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
23800 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
23801 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
23802 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
23803 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
23804 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
23805 happy for you.
23806 @end defvar
23807
23808 @defvar spam-marks
23809 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23810 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
23811 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
23812 you really want to.
23813 @end defvar
23814
23815 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23816 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23817 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23818 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23819 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23820 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23821 and nothing else.
23822
23823 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23824 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23825 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23826 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23827 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23828 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23829 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23830 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23831 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23832 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23833 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23834 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23835 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23836 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23837 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23838
23839 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23840 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23841
23842 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23843 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23844 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23845
23846 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23847 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23848
23849 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23850 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23851 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23852 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23853 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23854
23855 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23856 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23857 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23858 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23859 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23860 it there.
23861
23862 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23863 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23864 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23865 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23866 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23867 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23868 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23869 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23870 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23871 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23872 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23873 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23874 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23875
23876 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23877 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23878
23879 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23880 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23881 training} groups.
23882
23883 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23884 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23885 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23886 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23887 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23888 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23889 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23890
23891 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23892 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23893 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23894 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23895
23896 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23897 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23898 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23899 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23900 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23901 from the mail server.
23902
23903 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23904 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23905 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23906 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23907
23908 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
23909 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
23910 @cindex spam filtering
23911 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23912 @cindex spam configuration examples
23913 @cindex spam
23914
23915 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23916
23917 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23918 @example
23919 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23920 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23921 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23922 (spam-initialize)
23923
23924 (setq
23925 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23926 spam-use-BBDB t
23927 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23928 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23929 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23930 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23931 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23932 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23933 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23934 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23935 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23936 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23937 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23938 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23939 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23940 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23941 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23942 (any "ding" "ding")
23943 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23944 (: spam-split)
23945 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23946 "mail"))
23947
23948 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23949
23950 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23951 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23952 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23953 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23954
23955 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23956
23957 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23958 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23959 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23960 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23961 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23962
23963 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23964 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23965
23966 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23967
23968 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23969 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23970
23971 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23972 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23973 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23974
23975 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23976
23977 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23978 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23979
23980 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23981 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23982 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23983 (ham-marks
23984 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23985 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23986 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23987 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23988
23989 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23990 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23991 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23992
23993 @end example
23994
23995 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23996 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23997
23998 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23999 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24000 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24001 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24002 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24003 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24004 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24005 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24006 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24007
24008 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24009 does most of the job for me:
24010
24011 @lisp
24012 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24013 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24014 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24015 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24016 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24017 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24018 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24019 @end lisp
24020
24021 @itemize
24022
24023 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24024
24025 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24026 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24027 bogofilter or DCC).
24028
24029 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24030 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24031 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24032 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24033 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24034 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24035 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24036
24037 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24038 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24039 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
24040 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24041 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24042 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24043
24044 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24045
24046 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24047 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24048 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24049 @samp{training.ham}.
24050 @end itemize
24051
24052 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24053
24054 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24055
24056 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24057 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24058 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24059
24060 @lisp
24061 ("^gmane\\."
24062 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24063 @end lisp
24064
24065 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24066 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24067 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
24068 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24069 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24070
24071 @node Spam Back Ends
24072 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24073 @cindex spam back ends
24074
24075 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24076 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24077 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24078 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24079 Processors}).
24080
24081 @menu
24082 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24083 * BBDB Whitelists::
24084 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24085 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24086 * Blackholes::
24087 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24088 * Bogofilter::
24089 * ifile spam filtering::
24090 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24091 * SpamOracle::
24092 @end menu
24093
24094 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24095 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24096 @cindex spam filtering
24097 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24098 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24099 @cindex spam
24100
24101 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24102
24103 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24104 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24105 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24106 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24107 be spammers.
24108
24109 @end defvar
24110
24111 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24112
24113 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24114 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24115 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24116 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24117 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24118
24119 @end defvar
24120
24121 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24122
24123 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24124 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24125 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24126
24127 @end defvar
24128
24129 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24130
24131 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24132 customizing the group parameters or the
24133 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24134 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24135 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24136
24137 @emph{WARNING}
24138
24139 Instead of the obsolete
24140 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24141 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24142 the same way, we promise.
24143
24144 @end defvar
24145
24146 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24147
24148 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24149 customizing the group parameters or the
24150 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24151 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24152 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24153 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
24154 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24155
24156 @emph{WARNING}
24157
24158 Instead of the obsolete
24159 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24160 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24161 the same way, we promise.
24162
24163 @end defvar
24164
24165 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24166 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24167 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24168 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24169 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24170
24171 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24172 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24173 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24174 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24175
24176 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24177 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24178 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24179 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24180 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24181 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24182
24183 @node BBDB Whitelists
24184 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24185 @cindex spam filtering
24186 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24187 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24188 @cindex spam
24189
24190 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24191
24192 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24193 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24194 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24195 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24196 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24197 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24198 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24199
24200 @end defvar
24201
24202 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24203
24204 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24205 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24206 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
24207 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24208 classified as spammers.
24209
24210 @end defvar
24211
24212 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24213
24214 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24215 customizing the group parameters or the
24216 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24217 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24218 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24219 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
24220 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24221
24222 @emph{WARNING}
24223
24224 Instead of the obsolete
24225 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24226 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24227 the same way, we promise.
24228
24229 @end defvar
24230
24231 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24232 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24233 @cindex spam reporting
24234 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24235 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24236 @cindex spam
24237
24238 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24239
24240 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24241 customizing the group parameters or the
24242 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24243 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24244 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24245 HTTP request.
24246
24247 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24248
24249 @emph{WARNING}
24250
24251 Instead of the obsolete
24252 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24253 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24254 same way, we promise.
24255
24256 @end defvar
24257
24258 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24259
24260 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24261 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24262 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24263 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24264 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
24265 Gmane provides.
24266
24267 @end defvar
24268
24269 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24270 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24271 @cindex spam filtering
24272 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24273 @cindex spam
24274
24275 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24276
24277 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24278 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24279 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
24280 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
24281 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
24282 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
24283 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
24284 ham.
24285
24286 @end defvar
24287
24288 @node Blackholes
24289 @subsubsection Blackholes
24290 @cindex spam filtering
24291 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24292 @cindex spam
24293
24294 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
24295
24296 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
24297 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
24298 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
24299 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
24300 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
24301 contains outdated servers.
24302
24303 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
24304 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
24305 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
24306 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
24307 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
24308 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
24309
24310 @end defvar
24311
24312 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
24313
24314 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
24315
24316 @end defvar
24317
24318 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
24319
24320 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
24321 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
24322
24323 @end defvar
24324
24325 @defvar spam-use-dig
24326
24327 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
24328 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
24329
24330 @end defvar
24331
24332 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
24333 ham processor for blackholes.
24334
24335 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
24336 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
24337 @cindex spam filtering
24338 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
24339 @cindex spam
24340
24341 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
24342
24343 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
24344 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
24345 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
24346 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
24347 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
24348 message is spam or ham, respectively.
24349
24350 @end defvar
24351
24352 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
24353
24354 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24355 the message, positively identify it as spam.
24356
24357 @end defvar
24358
24359 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
24360
24361 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24362 the message, positively identify it as ham.
24363
24364 @end defvar
24365
24366 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
24367 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
24368
24369 @node Bogofilter
24370 @subsubsection Bogofilter
24371 @cindex spam filtering
24372 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
24373 @cindex spam
24374
24375 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
24376
24377 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
24378 speedy Bogofilter.
24379
24380 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
24381 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
24382 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
24383 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
24384 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
24385 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
24386
24387 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
24388 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
24389 documentation.
24390
24391 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
24392 processing will be turned off.
24393
24394 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
24395
24396 @end defvar
24397
24398 @table @kbd
24399 @item M s t
24400 @itemx S t
24401 @kindex M s t
24402 @kindex S t
24403 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
24404 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
24405 @end table
24406
24407 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
24408
24409 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
24410 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
24411 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
24412 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
24413 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
24414 installation documents for details.
24415
24416 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
24417
24418 @end defvar
24419
24420 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
24421 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24422 customizing the group parameters or the
24423 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24424 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
24425 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
24426
24427 @emph{WARNING}
24428
24429 Instead of the obsolete
24430 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
24431 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
24432 the same way, we promise.
24433 @end defvar
24434
24435 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
24436 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24437 customizing the group parameters or the
24438 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24439 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
24440 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
24441 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
24442 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24443
24444 @emph{WARNING}
24445
24446 Instead of the obsolete
24447 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
24448 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
24449 the same way, we promise.
24450 @end defvar
24451
24452 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
24453
24454 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
24455 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
24456 database directory.
24457
24458 @end defvar
24459
24460 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
24461 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
24462 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
24463 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
24464 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
24465 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
24466
24467 @node ifile spam filtering
24468 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
24469 @cindex spam filtering
24470 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
24471 @cindex spam
24472
24473 @defvar spam-use-ifile
24474
24475 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
24476 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
24477
24478 @end defvar
24479
24480 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
24481
24482 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
24483 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
24484 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
24485
24486 @end defvar
24487
24488 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
24489
24490 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
24491 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
24492 the default value of @samp{spam}.
24493 @end defvar
24494
24495 @defvar spam-ifile-database
24496
24497 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
24498 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
24499
24500 @end defvar
24501
24502 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
24503 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
24504 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
24505 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
24506 functionality.
24507
24508 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
24509 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
24510 @cindex spam filtering
24511 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
24512 @cindex spam-stat
24513 @cindex spam
24514
24515 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
24516 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
24517 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
24518 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
24519 spam-stat dictionary}.
24520
24521 @defvar spam-use-stat
24522
24523 @end defvar
24524
24525 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
24526 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24527 customizing the group parameters or the
24528 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24529 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24530 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
24531
24532 @emph{WARNING}
24533
24534 Instead of the obsolete
24535 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
24536 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
24537 the same way, we promise.
24538 @end defvar
24539
24540 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
24541 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24542 customizing the group parameters or the
24543 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24544 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
24545 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
24546 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
24547 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24548
24549 @emph{WARNING}
24550
24551 Instead of the obsolete
24552 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
24553 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
24554 the same way, we promise.
24555 @end defvar
24556
24557 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
24558 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
24559 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
24560 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
24561 @code{spam-split} are provided.
24562
24563 @node SpamOracle
24564 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
24565 @cindex spam filtering
24566 @cindex SpamOracle
24567 @cindex spam
24568
24569 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
24570 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
24571 installed separately.
24572
24573 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
24574 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
24575 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
24576 mail as a spam mail or not.
24577
24578 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
24579 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
24580 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
24581
24582 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
24583 call SpamOracle.
24584
24585 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
24586 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
24587 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
24588 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
24589 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
24590 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
24591 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
24592 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
24593
24594 @example
24595 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
24596 spam-split-group "Junk"
24597 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
24598 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
24599 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
24600 @end example
24601
24602 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
24603 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
24604 SpamOracle.
24605 @end defvar
24606
24607 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
24608 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
24609 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
24610 can be customized.
24611 @end defvar
24612
24613 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
24614 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
24615 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
24616 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
24617 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
24618 database to live somewhere special, set
24619 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
24620 @end defvar
24621
24622 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
24623 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
24624 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
24625 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
24626 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
24627 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
24628 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
24629 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
24630 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
24631 @xref{Spam Package}.
24632
24633 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
24634 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24635 customizing the group parameter or the
24636 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24637 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
24638 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
24639
24640 @emph{WARNING}
24641
24642 Instead of the obsolete
24643 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24644 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24645 the same way, we promise.
24646 @end defvar
24647
24648 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
24649 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24650 customizing the group parameter or the
24651 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24652 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
24653 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
24654 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
24655 @emph{unclassified} groups.
24656
24657 @emph{WARNING}
24658
24659 Instead of the obsolete
24660 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24661 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24662 the same way, we promise.
24663 @end defvar
24664
24665 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
24666 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
24667 messages.
24668 @example
24669 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
24670 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
24671 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
24672 @end example
24673 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
24674 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
24675 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
24676 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
24677 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
24678 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
24679
24680 @node Extending the Spam package
24681 @subsection Extending the Spam package
24682 @cindex spam filtering
24683 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
24684 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
24685
24686 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
24687 incoming mail, provide the following:
24688
24689 @enumerate
24690
24691 @item
24692 Code
24693
24694 @lisp
24695 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
24696 "True if blackbox should be used.")
24697 @end lisp
24698
24699 Add
24700 @lisp
24701 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
24702 @end lisp
24703 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
24704
24705 Add
24706 @lisp
24707 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
24708 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
24709 @end lisp
24710
24711 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
24712
24713 Add
24714 @lisp
24715 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
24716 nil
24717 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
24718 nil)
24719 @end lisp
24720
24721 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
24722 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
24723 start, or other register/unregister routines more appropriate to
24724 Blackbox.
24725
24726 @item
24727 Functionality
24728
24729 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
24730 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
24731 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
24732 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
24733 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
24734
24735 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
24736 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
24737 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
24738
24739 @end enumerate
24740
24741 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
24742
24743 @enumerate
24744
24745 @item
24746 Code
24747
24748 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
24749 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
24750
24751 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
24752 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
24753 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
24754 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
24755
24756 @lisp
24757 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
24758 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
24759 Only applicable to spam groups.")
24760
24761 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
24762 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
24763 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
24764
24765 @end lisp
24766
24767 @item
24768 Gnus parameters
24769
24770 Add
24771 @lisp
24772 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
24773 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
24774 @end lisp
24775 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
24776 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
24777 variable customization.
24778
24779 Add
24780 @lisp
24781 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
24782 @end lisp
24783 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
24784 @code{gnus.el}.
24785
24786 @end enumerate
24787
24788 @node Spam Statistics Package
24789 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
24790 @cindex Paul Graham
24791 @cindex Graham, Paul
24792 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
24793 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
24794 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
24795
24796 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
24797 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
24798 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
24799 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
24800 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
24801 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
24802 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
24803 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
24804 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
24805 or not.
24806
24807 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
24808 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
24809 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
24810 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
24811 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
24812 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
24813 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
24814 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
24815
24816 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
24817 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
24818 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
24819
24820 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
24821 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
24822 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
24823 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
24824 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
24825
24826 @menu
24827 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
24828 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
24829 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
24830 @end menu
24831
24832 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24833 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24834
24835 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
24836 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
24837 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
24838 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
24839 need several hundred emails in both collections.
24840
24841 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
24842 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
24843 per mail. Use the following:
24844
24845 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24846 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24847 is treated as one spam mail.
24848 @end defun
24849
24850 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24851 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24852 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24853 @end defun
24854
24855 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24856 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
24857 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24858 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24859 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
24860 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24861
24862 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24863 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24864 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24865 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24866 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24867
24868 @defvar spam-stat
24869 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24870 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24871 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24872 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24873 @end defvar
24874
24875 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24876 reset the dictionary.
24877
24878 @defun spam-stat-reset
24879 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24880 @end defun
24881
24882 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24883 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24884 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24885 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24886 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24887 only non-spam mails.
24888
24889 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24890 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24891 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24892 @end defun
24893
24894 @defun spam-stat-save
24895 Save the dictionary.
24896 @end defun
24897
24898 @defvar spam-stat-file
24899 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24900 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24901 @end defvar
24902
24903 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24904 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24905
24906 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
24907 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
24908
24909 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24910
24911 @lisp
24912 (require 'spam-stat)
24913 (spam-stat-load)
24914 @end lisp
24915
24916 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24917 created.
24918
24919 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24920 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24921 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24922 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24923
24924 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24925 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24926 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24927 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24928
24929 @lisp
24930 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24931 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24932 "mail.misc"))
24933 @end lisp
24934
24935 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24936 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24937 @end defvar
24938
24939 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24940 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24941 expression are considered potential spam.
24942
24943 @lisp
24944 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24945 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24946 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24947 "mail.misc"))
24948 @end lisp
24949
24950 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24951 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24952 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24953 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24954 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24955
24956 @lisp
24957 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24958 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24959 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24960 "mail.misc"))
24961 @end lisp
24962
24963 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24964 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24965 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24966 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24967 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24968 dictionary!
24969
24970 @lisp
24971 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24972 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24973 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24974 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24975 "mail.misc"))
24976 @end lisp
24977
24978
24979 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24980 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24981
24982 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24983
24984 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24985 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24986 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24987 @end defun
24988
24989 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24990 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24991 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24992 @end defun
24993
24994 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24995 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24996 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24997 already been processed as non-spam.
24998 @end defun
24999
25000 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25001 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25002 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25003 been processed as spam.
25004 @end defun
25005
25006 @defun spam-stat-save
25007 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25008 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25009 @end defun
25010
25011 @defun spam-stat-load
25012 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25013 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25014 @end defun
25015
25016 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25017 Return the spam score for a word.
25018 @end defun
25019
25020 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25021 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25022 @end defun
25023
25024 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25025 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25026 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25027 @end defun
25028
25029 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25030 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25031
25032 @lisp
25033 (require 'spam-stat)
25034 (spam-stat-load)
25035 @end lisp
25036
25037 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25038
25039 @smallexample
25040 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25041 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25042 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25043 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25044 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25045 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25046 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25047 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25048 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25049 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25050 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25051 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25052 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25053 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25054 @end smallexample
25055
25056 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25057
25058 @smallexample
25059 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25060 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25061 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25062 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25063 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25064 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25065 @end smallexample
25066
25067 @node Other modes
25068 @section Interaction with other modes
25069
25070 @subsection Dired
25071 @cindex dired
25072
25073 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
25074 buffers. It is enabled with
25075 @lisp
25076 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
25077 @end lisp
25078
25079 @table @kbd
25080 @item C-c C-m C-a
25081 @findex gnus-dired-attach
25082 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
25083 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
25084 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
25085
25086 @item C-c C-m C-l
25087 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
25088 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
25089 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
25090 buffer.
25091
25092 @item C-c C-m C-p
25093 @findex gnus-dired-print
25094 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
25095 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
25096 @end table
25097
25098 @node Various Various
25099 @section Various Various
25100 @cindex mode lines
25101 @cindex highlights
25102
25103 @table @code
25104
25105 @item gnus-home-directory
25106 @vindex gnus-home-directory
25107 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
25108 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
25109
25110 @item gnus-directory
25111 @vindex gnus-directory
25112 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
25113 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
25114 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
25115
25116 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
25117 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
25118 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
25119 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
25120
25121 @item gnus-default-directory
25122 @vindex gnus-default-directory
25123 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
25124 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
25125 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
25126 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
25127 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
25128 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
25129
25130 @item gnus-verbose
25131 @vindex gnus-verbose
25132 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
25133 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
25134 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
25135 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
25136 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
25137
25138 @item gnus-verbose-backends
25139 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
25140 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
25141 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
25142
25143 @item nnheader-max-head-length
25144 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
25145 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
25146 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
25147 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
25148 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
25149 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
25150 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
25151 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
25152 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
25153
25154 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
25155 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
25156 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
25157 read when doing the operation described above.
25158
25159 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
25160 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
25161 @cindex file names
25162 @cindex invalid characters in file names
25163 @cindex characters in file names
25164 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
25165 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
25166 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
25167
25168 @lisp
25169 @group
25170 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
25171 '((?: . ?_)))
25172 @end group
25173 @end lisp
25174
25175 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
25176 Windows (phooey) systems.
25177
25178 @item gnus-hidden-properties
25179 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
25180 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
25181 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
25182 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
25183
25184 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
25185 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
25186 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
25187 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
25188 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
25189
25190 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
25191 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
25192 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
25193
25194 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
25195 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
25196
25197 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
25198 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
25199 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
25200 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
25201 group).
25202
25203 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
25204
25205
25206 @end table
25207
25208 @node The End
25209 @chapter The End
25210
25211 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
25212 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
25213
25214 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
25215
25216 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
25217
25218 @quotation
25219 @strong{Te Deum}
25220
25221 @sp 1
25222 Not because of victories @*
25223 I sing,@*
25224 having none,@*
25225 but for the common sunshine,@*
25226 the breeze,@*
25227 the largess of the spring.
25228
25229 @sp 1
25230 Not for victory@*
25231 but for the day's work done@*
25232 as well as I was able;@*
25233 not for a seat upon the dais@*
25234 but at the common table.@*
25235 @end quotation
25236
25237
25238 @node Appendices
25239 @chapter Appendices
25240
25241 @menu
25242 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
25243 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
25244 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
25245 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
25246 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
25247 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
25248 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
25249 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
25250 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
25251 @end menu
25252
25253
25254 @node XEmacs
25255 @section XEmacs
25256 @cindex XEmacs
25257 @cindex installing under XEmacs
25258
25259 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
25260 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
25261 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
25262 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
25263 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
25264 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
25265
25266
25267 @node History
25268 @section History
25269
25270 @cindex history
25271 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
25272 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
25273
25274 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
25275 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
25276 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
25277 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
25278 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
25279
25280 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
25281 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
25282 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
25283 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
25284 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
25285 appropriate name, don't you think?)
25286
25287 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
25288 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
25289 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
25290 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
25291
25292 @menu
25293 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
25294 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
25295 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
25296 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
25297 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
25298 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
25299 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
25300 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
25301 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
25302 @end menu
25303
25304
25305 @node Gnus Versions
25306 @subsection Gnus Versions
25307 @cindex ding Gnus
25308 @cindex September Gnus
25309 @cindex Red Gnus
25310 @cindex Quassia Gnus
25311 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
25312 @cindex Oort Gnus
25313 @cindex No Gnus
25314 @cindex Gnus versions
25315
25316 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
25317 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
25318 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
25319
25320 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
25321 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
25322
25323 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
25324 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
25325
25326 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
25327 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
25328
25329 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
25330 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
25331 1999.
25332
25333 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
25334 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
25335
25336 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
25337
25338 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
25339 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
25340 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
25341 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
25342 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
25343 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
25344
25345
25346 @node Other Gnus Versions
25347 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
25348 @cindex Semi-gnus
25349
25350 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
25351 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
25352 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
25353 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
25354
25355 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
25356 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
25357 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
25358 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
25359 Japanese users.
25360
25361
25362 @node Why?
25363 @subsection Why?
25364
25365 What's the point of Gnus?
25366
25367 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
25368 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
25369 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
25370 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
25371 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
25372 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
25373 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
25374 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
25375 keep track of millions of people who post?
25376
25377 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
25378 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
25379 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
25380 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
25381 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
25382 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
25383 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
25384 every one of you to explore and invent.
25385
25386 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
25387 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
25388
25389
25390 @node Compatibility
25391 @subsection Compatibility
25392
25393 @cindex compatibility
25394 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
25395 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
25396 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
25397
25398 Our motto is:
25399 @quotation
25400 @cartouche
25401 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
25402 @end cartouche
25403 @end quotation
25404
25405 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
25406 their names.
25407
25408 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
25409 Articles}.
25410
25411 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
25412 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
25413 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
25414 important variables have their values copied into their global
25415 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
25416 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
25417
25418 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
25419 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
25420 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
25421 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
25422 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
25423 peculiar results.
25424
25425 @cindex hilit19
25426 @cindex highlighting
25427 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
25428 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
25429 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
25430 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
25431 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
25432 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
25433 Away!
25434
25435 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
25436 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
25437 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
25438 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
25439
25440 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
25441 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
25442 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
25443 to stop doing it the old way.
25444
25445 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
25446
25447 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
25448 @findex gnus-bug
25449 @cindex reporting bugs
25450 @cindex bugs
25451 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
25452 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
25453 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
25454
25455 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
25456 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
25457 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
25458 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
25459 up at you.
25460
25461
25462 @node Conformity
25463 @subsection Conformity
25464
25465 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
25466 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
25467 with, of course.
25468
25469 @table @strong
25470
25471 @item RFC (2)822
25472 @cindex RFC 822
25473 @cindex RFC 2822
25474 There are no known breaches of this standard.
25475
25476 @item RFC 1036
25477 @cindex RFC 1036
25478 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
25479
25480 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
25481 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
25482 We do have some breaches to this one.
25483
25484 @table @emph
25485
25486 @item X-Newsreader
25487 @itemx User-Agent
25488 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
25489 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
25490 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
25491 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
25492 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
25493 @end table
25494
25495 @item USEFOR
25496 @cindex USEFOR
25497 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
25498 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
25499 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
25500 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
25501
25502 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
25503 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
25504 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
25505
25506 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
25507 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
25508
25509 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
25510 @cindex RFC 1991
25511 @cindex RFC 2440
25512 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
25513 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
25514 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
25515 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
25516 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
25517 decryption).
25518
25519 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
25520 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
25521 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
25522 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
25523
25524 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
25525 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
25526
25527 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
25528 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
25529 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
25530 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
25531 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
25532 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
25533 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
25534 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
25535
25536 @end table
25537
25538 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
25539 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
25540 know.
25541
25542
25543 @node Emacsen
25544 @subsection Emacsen
25545 @cindex Emacsen
25546 @cindex XEmacs
25547 @cindex Mule
25548 @cindex Emacs
25549
25550 Gnus should work on:
25551
25552 @itemize @bullet
25553
25554 @item
25555 Emacs 21.1 and up.
25556
25557 @item
25558 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
25559
25560 @end itemize
25561
25562 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
25563 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
25564 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
25565 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
25566
25567 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
25568 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
25569 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
25570 Emacsen.
25571
25572
25573 @node Gnus Development
25574 @subsection Gnus Development
25575
25576 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
25577 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
25578 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
25579 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
25580 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
25581 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
25582 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
25583 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
25584
25585 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
25586 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
25587 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
25588 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
25589 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
25590
25591 @cindex Incoming*
25592 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
25593 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
25594 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
25595 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
25596 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
25597
25598 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
25599 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
25600 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
25601 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
25602 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
25603 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
25604 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
25605 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
25606 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
25607 can't be assumed to do so.
25608
25609
25610
25611 @node Contributors
25612 @subsection Contributors
25613 @cindex contributors
25614
25615 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
25616 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
25617 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
25618 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
25619 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
25620 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
25621 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
25622 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
25623 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
25624 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
25625
25626 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
25627 wrong show.
25628
25629 @itemize @bullet
25630
25631 @item
25632 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
25633
25634 @item
25635 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
25636 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
25637 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
25638 functionality and stuff.
25639
25640 @item
25641 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
25642 well as numerous other things).
25643
25644 @item
25645 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
25646
25647 @item
25648 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
25649
25650 @item
25651 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
25652
25653 @item
25654 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
25655
25656 @item
25657 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
25658 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
25659
25660 @item
25661 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
25662
25663 @item
25664 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
25665 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25666
25667 @item
25668 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
25669
25670 @item
25671 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
25672
25673 @item
25674 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
25675
25676 @item
25677 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
25678
25679 @item
25680 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
25681 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
25682
25683 @item
25684 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
25685
25686 @item
25687 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
25688
25689 @item
25690 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
25691
25692 @item
25693 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
25694 .newsrc files.
25695
25696 @item
25697 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
25698
25699 @item
25700 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
25701
25702 @item
25703 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
25704
25705 @item
25706 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
25707 well as autoconf support.
25708
25709 @end itemize
25710
25711 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
25712 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
25713
25714 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
25715
25716 Christopher Davis,
25717 Andrew Eskilsson,
25718 Kai Grossjohann,
25719 Kevin Greiner,
25720 Jesper Harder,
25721 Paul Jarc,
25722 Simon Josefsson,
25723 David KÃ¥gedal,
25724 Richard Pieri,
25725 Fabrice Popineau,
25726 Daniel Quinlan,
25727 Michael Shields,
25728 Reiner Steib,
25729 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
25730 Jack Vinson,
25731 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
25732 and
25733 Teodor Zlatanov.
25734
25735 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
25736
25737 Jari Aalto,
25738 Adrian Aichner,
25739 Vladimir Alexiev,
25740 Russ Allbery,
25741 Peter Arius,
25742 Matt Armstrong,
25743 Marc Auslander,
25744 Miles Bader,
25745 Alexei V. Barantsev,
25746 Frank Bennett,
25747 Robert Bihlmeyer,
25748 Chris Bone,
25749 Mark Borges,
25750 Mark Boyns,
25751 Lance A. Brown,
25752 Rob Browning,
25753 Kees de Bruin,
25754 Martin Buchholz,
25755 Joe Buehler,
25756 Kevin Buhr,
25757 Alastair Burt,
25758 Joao Cachopo,
25759 Zlatko Calusic,
25760 Massimo Campostrini,
25761 Castor,
25762 David Charlap,
25763 Dan Christensen,
25764 Kevin Christian,
25765 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
25766 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
25767 Laura Conrad,
25768 Michael R. Cook,
25769 Glenn Coombs,
25770 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
25771 Neil Crellin,
25772 Frank D. Cringle,
25773 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
25774 Andre Deparade,
25775 Ulrik Dickow,
25776 Dave Disser,
25777 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
25778 Joev Dubach,
25779 Michael Welsh Duggan,
25780 Dave Edmondson,
25781 Paul Eggert,
25782 Mark W. Eichin,
25783 Karl Eichwalder,
25784 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
25785 Michael Ernst,
25786 Luc Van Eycken,
25787 Sam Falkner,
25788 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
25789 Sigbjorn Finne,
25790 Sven Fischer,
25791 Paul Fisher,
25792 Decklin Foster,
25793 Gary D. Foster,
25794 Paul Franklin,
25795 Guy Geens,
25796 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
25797 David S. Goldberg,
25798 Michelangelo Grigni,
25799 Dale Hagglund,
25800 D. Hall,
25801 Magnus Hammerin,
25802 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
25803 Raja R. Harinath,
25804 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
25805 P. E. Jareth Hein,
25806 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
25807 Scott Hofmann,
25808 Marc Horowitz,
25809 Gunnar Horrigmo,
25810 Richard Hoskins,
25811 Brad Howes,
25812 Miguel de Icaza,
25813 François Felix Ingrand,
25814 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
25815 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
25816 Lee Iverson,
25817 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
25818 Rajappa Iyer,
25819 Andreas Jaeger,
25820 Adam P. Jenkins,
25821 Randell Jesup,
25822 Fred Johansen,
25823 Gareth Jones,
25824 Greg Klanderman,
25825 Karl Kleinpaste,
25826 Michael Klingbeil,
25827 Peter Skov Knudsen,
25828 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
25829 Petr Konecny,
25830 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
25831 Thor Kristoffersen,
25832 Jens Lautenbacher,
25833 Martin Larose,
25834 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
25835 Joerg Lenneis,
25836 Carsten Leonhardt,
25837 James LewisMoss,
25838 Christian Limpach,
25839 Markus Linnala,
25840 Dave Love,
25841 Mike McEwan,
25842 Tonny Madsen,
25843 Shlomo Mahlab,
25844 Nat Makarevitch,
25845 Istvan Marko,
25846 David Martin,
25847 Jason R. Mastaler,
25848 Gordon Matzigkeit,
25849 Timo Metzemakers,
25850 Richard Mlynarik,
25851 Lantz Moore,
25852 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25853 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25854 Hrvoje Niksic,
25855 Andy Norman,
25856 Fred Oberhauser,
25857 C. R. Oldham,
25858 Alexandre Oliva,
25859 Ken Olstad,
25860 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25861 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
25862 Ettore Perazzoli,
25863 William Perry,
25864 Stephen Peters,
25865 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25866 Ulrich Pfeifer,
25867 Matt Pharr,
25868 Andy Piper,
25869 John McClary Prevost,
25870 Bill Pringlemeir,
25871 Mike Pullen,
25872 Jim Radford,
25873 Colin Rafferty,
25874 Lasse Rasinen,
25875 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25876 Joe Reiss,
25877 Renaud Rioboo,
25878 Roland B. Roberts,
25879 Bart Robinson,
25880 Christian von Roques,
25881 Markus Rost,
25882 Jason Rumney,
25883 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25884 Jay Sachs,
25885 Dewey M. Sasser,
25886 Conrad Sauerwald,
25887 Loren Schall,
25888 Dan Schmidt,
25889 Ralph Schleicher,
25890 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25891 Andreas Schwab,
25892 Randal L. Schwartz,
25893 Danny Siu,
25894 Matt Simmons,
25895 Paul D. Smith,
25896 Jeff Sparkes,
25897 Toby Speight,
25898 Michael Sperber,
25899 Darren Stalder,
25900 Richard Stallman,
25901 Greg Stark,
25902 Sam Steingold,
25903 Paul Stevenson,
25904 Jonas Steverud,
25905 Paul Stodghill,
25906 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25907 Kurt Swanson,
25908 Samuel Tardieu,
25909 Teddy,
25910 Chuck Thompson,
25911 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25912 Philippe Troin,
25913 James Troup,
25914 Trung Tran-Duc,
25915 Jack Twilley,
25916 Aaron M. Ucko,
25917 Aki Vehtari,
25918 Didier Verna,
25919 Vladimir Volovich,
25920 Jan Vroonhof,
25921 Stefan Waldherr,
25922 Pete Ware,
25923 Barry A. Warsaw,
25924 Christoph Wedler,
25925 Joe Wells,
25926 Lee Willis,
25927 and
25928 Lloyd Zusman.
25929
25930
25931 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25932 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25933 (550kB and counting).
25934
25935 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25936 sure.
25937
25938 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25939 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25940
25941
25942 @node New Features
25943 @subsection New Features
25944 @cindex new features
25945
25946 @menu
25947 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25948 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25949 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25950 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25951 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25952 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25953 @end menu
25954
25955 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25956 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25957 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25958
25959 @node ding Gnus
25960 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25961
25962 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25963
25964 @itemize @bullet
25965
25966 @item
25967 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25968 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25969
25970 @item
25971 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25972 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25973
25974 @item
25975 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25976
25977 @item
25978 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25979 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25980 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25981
25982 @item
25983 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25984 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25985 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25986 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25987
25988 @item
25989 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25990 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25991
25992 @item
25993 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25994 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25995 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25996
25997 @item
25998 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25999 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
26000
26001 @item
26002 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
26003 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
26004 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
26005
26006 @item
26007 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
26008 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
26009 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
26010
26011 @item
26012 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
26013 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
26014
26015 @item
26016 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
26017 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
26018
26019 @item
26020 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
26021 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
26022
26023 @item
26024 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
26025 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
26026
26027 @item
26028 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
26029 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
26030
26031 @item
26032 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
26033 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
26034
26035 @item
26036 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
26037
26038 @item
26039 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
26040 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
26041
26042 @item
26043 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
26044 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
26045
26046 @item
26047 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
26048 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
26049
26050 @item
26051 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
26052
26053 @item
26054 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
26055 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
26056
26057 @item
26058 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
26059 Articles}).
26060
26061 @item
26062 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
26063 Buttons}).
26064
26065 @item
26066 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
26067 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
26068
26069 @item
26070 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
26071 (@pxref{Buttons}).
26072
26073 @end itemize
26074
26075
26076 @node September Gnus
26077 @subsubsection September Gnus
26078
26079 @iftex
26080 @iflatex
26081 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
26082 @end iflatex
26083 @end iftex
26084
26085 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
26086
26087 @itemize @bullet
26088
26089 @item
26090 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
26091 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
26092 now obsolete.
26093
26094 @item
26095 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
26096 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
26097 Threading}).
26098
26099 @lisp
26100 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
26101 @end lisp
26102
26103 @item
26104 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
26105 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
26106
26107 @item
26108 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
26109 referred.
26110
26111 @item
26112 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
26113
26114 @item
26115 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
26116
26117 @item
26118 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
26119
26120 @lisp
26121 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
26122 @end lisp
26123
26124 @item
26125 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
26126 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
26127
26128 @lisp
26129 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
26130 @end lisp
26131
26132 @item
26133 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
26134 Groups}).
26135
26136 @item
26137 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
26138 Topics}).
26139
26140 @lisp
26141 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
26142 @end lisp
26143
26144 @item
26145 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
26146
26147 @item
26148 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
26149 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
26150
26151 @lisp
26152 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
26153 @end lisp
26154
26155 @item
26156 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
26157 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
26158
26159 @item
26160 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
26161
26162 @item
26163 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
26164 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
26165 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
26166
26167 @item
26168 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
26169 (@pxref{SOUP}).
26170
26171 @item
26172 The Gnus cache is much faster.
26173
26174 @item
26175 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
26176 Groups}).
26177
26178 @item
26179 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
26180 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
26181
26182 @item
26183 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
26184 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
26185
26186 @item
26187 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
26188 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
26189
26190 @item
26191 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
26192 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
26193 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
26194
26195 @item
26196 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
26197 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
26198
26199 @item
26200 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
26201
26202 @item
26203 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
26204
26205 @item
26206 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
26207
26208 @item
26209 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
26210
26211 @item
26212 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
26213 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
26214
26215 @item
26216 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
26217 Layout}).
26218
26219 @item
26220 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
26221 @iftex
26222 @iflatex
26223 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
26224 @end iflatex
26225 @end iftex
26226
26227 @item
26228 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
26229
26230 @lisp
26231 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
26232 @end lisp
26233
26234 @item
26235 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
26236
26237 @lisp
26238 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
26239 @end lisp
26240
26241 @item
26242 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
26243
26244 @item
26245 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
26246
26247 @item
26248 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
26249 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
26250
26251 @lisp
26252 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
26253 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
26254 @end lisp
26255
26256 @item
26257 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
26258 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
26259
26260 @lisp
26261 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
26262 @end lisp
26263
26264 @item
26265 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
26266 buffer to allow easier treatment.
26267
26268 @item
26269 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
26270
26271 @item
26272 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
26273 Articles}).
26274
26275 @lisp
26276 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
26277 @end lisp
26278
26279 @item
26280 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
26281 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
26282
26283 @lisp
26284 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
26285 @end lisp
26286
26287 @item
26288 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
26289 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
26290
26291 @item
26292 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
26293 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
26294
26295 @lisp
26296 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
26297 @end lisp
26298
26299 @item
26300 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
26301
26302 @item
26303 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
26304
26305 @item
26306 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
26307
26308 @end itemize
26309
26310
26311 @node Red Gnus
26312 @subsubsection Red Gnus
26313
26314 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
26315
26316 @iftex
26317 @iflatex
26318 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
26319 @end iflatex
26320 @end iftex
26321
26322 @itemize @bullet
26323
26324 @item
26325 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
26326
26327 @item
26328 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
26329 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
26330
26331 @item
26332 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
26333 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
26334 Scoring}).
26335
26336 @item
26337 Article washing status can be displayed in the
26338 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
26339
26340 @item
26341 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
26342
26343 @item
26344 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
26345 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
26346
26347 @lisp
26348 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
26349 @end lisp
26350
26351 @item
26352 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
26353 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
26354 been added.
26355
26356 @item
26357 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
26358 Server Internals}).
26359
26360 @item
26361 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
26362 Parameters}).
26363
26364 @item
26365 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
26366
26367 @item
26368 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
26369 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
26370
26371 @item
26372 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
26373 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
26374 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
26375
26376 @item
26377 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
26378 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
26379
26380 @item
26381 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
26382 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
26383
26384 @item
26385 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
26386 (@pxref{Undo}).
26387
26388 @item
26389 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
26390 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
26391
26392 @item
26393 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
26394 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
26395
26396 @lisp
26397 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
26398 @end lisp
26399
26400 @item
26401 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
26402
26403 @lisp
26404 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
26405 @end lisp
26406
26407 @item
26408 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
26409 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
26410
26411 @item
26412 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
26413 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
26414
26415 @item
26416 A new command for reading collections of documents
26417 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
26418 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
26419
26420 @item
26421 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
26422 Marks}).
26423
26424 @item
26425 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
26426 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
26427
26428 @item
26429 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
26430 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
26431 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
26432
26433 @item
26434 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
26435 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
26436 Sorting}).
26437
26438 @item
26439 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
26440 Groups}).
26441
26442 @item
26443 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
26444 Commands}).
26445 @iftex
26446 @iflatex
26447 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
26448 @end iflatex
26449 @end iftex
26450
26451 @item
26452 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
26453 Variables}).
26454
26455 @item
26456 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
26457 Mail}).
26458
26459 @item
26460 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
26461 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
26462
26463 @item
26464 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
26465
26466 @end itemize
26467
26468
26469 @node Quassia Gnus
26470 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
26471
26472 New features in Gnus 5.6:
26473
26474 @itemize @bullet
26475
26476 @item
26477 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
26478 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
26479 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
26480
26481 @item
26482 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
26483 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
26484 group, which is created automatically.
26485
26486 @item
26487 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
26488 values.
26489
26490 @item
26491 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
26492
26493 @item
26494 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
26495 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
26496
26497 @item
26498 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
26499 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
26500
26501 @item
26502 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
26503
26504 @item
26505 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
26506 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
26507
26508 @item
26509 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
26510
26511 @item
26512 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
26513 details.
26514
26515 @item
26516 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
26517 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
26518
26519 @item
26520 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
26521 control over simplification.
26522
26523 @item
26524 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
26525
26526 @item
26527 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
26528 limit.
26529
26530 @item
26531 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
26532
26533 @item
26534 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
26535
26536 @item
26537 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
26538 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
26539 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
26540
26541 @item
26542 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
26543 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
26544
26545 @item
26546 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
26547 text---@kbd{W d}.
26548
26549 @item
26550 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
26551 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
26552
26553 @item
26554 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
26555 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
26556
26557 @item
26558 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
26559 has been added.
26560
26561 @item
26562 A history of where mails have been split is available.
26563
26564 @item
26565 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
26566
26567 @item
26568 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
26569 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
26570
26571 @item
26572 A new function for citing in Message has been
26573 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
26574
26575 @item
26576 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
26577
26578 @item
26579 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
26580 been added.
26581
26582 @item
26583 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
26584 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
26585
26586 @item
26587 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
26588 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
26589
26590 @item
26591 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
26592
26593 @item
26594 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
26595
26596 @end itemize
26597
26598 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
26599 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
26600
26601 New features in Gnus 5.8:
26602
26603 @itemize @bullet
26604
26605 @item
26606 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
26607 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
26608
26609 If you used procmail like in
26610
26611 @lisp
26612 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
26613 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
26614 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
26615 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
26616 @end lisp
26617
26618 this now has changed to
26619
26620 @lisp
26621 (setq mail-sources
26622 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
26623 :suffix ".in")))
26624 @end lisp
26625
26626 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
26627
26628 @item
26629 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
26630 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
26631
26632 @item
26633 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
26634 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
26635
26636 @item
26637 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
26638 called to position point.
26639
26640 @item
26641 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
26642 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
26643
26644 @item
26645 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
26646 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
26647
26648 @item
26649 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
26650 subtly different manner.
26651
26652 @item
26653 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
26654 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
26655 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
26656
26657 @item
26658 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
26659
26660 @end itemize
26661
26662 @node Oort Gnus
26663 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
26664 @cindex Oort Gnus
26665
26666 New features in Gnus 5.10:
26667
26668 @itemize @bullet
26669
26670 @item Installation changes
26671 @c ***********************
26672
26673 @itemize @bullet
26674 @item
26675 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
26676
26677 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
26678 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
26679 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
26680 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
26681 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
26682 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
26683 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
26684 isn't save in general.
26685
26686 @item
26687 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
26688 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
26689 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
26690 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
26691 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
26692 remove-installed-shadows}.
26693
26694 @item
26695 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
26696
26697 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
26698 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
26699 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
26700 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
26701 the second parameter.
26702
26703 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
26704 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
26705 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
26706 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
26707 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
26708 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
26709 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
26710 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
26711 cycle used under Unix systems.
26712
26713 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
26714 superfluous, so they have been removed.
26715
26716 @item
26717 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26718
26719 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26720 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26721 hierarchy.
26722
26723 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
26724 @c CVS. We should find a better place for this item.
26725 @item
26726 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26727
26728 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26729 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26730 lisp directory into load-path.
26731
26732 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26733 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26734
26735 @end itemize
26736
26737 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
26738 @c *****************************************
26739
26740 @itemize @bullet
26741
26742 @item
26743 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
26744 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
26745
26746 @item
26747 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
26748
26749 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
26750 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
26751 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
26752 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
26753
26754 @item
26755 Improved anti-spam features.
26756
26757 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26758 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26759 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26760 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26761 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26762 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
26763
26764 @item
26765 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26766
26767 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26768 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26769 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26770 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26771 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26772
26773 @end itemize
26774
26775 @item Changes in group mode
26776 @c ************************
26777
26778 @itemize @bullet
26779
26780 @item
26781 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
26782 using @kbd{G M}.
26783
26784 @item
26785 Retrieval of charters and control messages
26786
26787 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
26788 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
26789
26790 @item
26791 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26792
26793 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26794 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26795 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26796 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26797 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26798 parameters, a'la:
26799 @lisp
26800 (setq gnus-parameters
26801 '(("mail\\..*"
26802 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26803 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26804 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26805 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26806 @end lisp
26807
26808 @item
26809 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26810
26811 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26812 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26813 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26814 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26815 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26816 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26817 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26818 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26819 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26820
26821 @item
26822 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26823
26824 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26825 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26826 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26827
26828 @item
26829 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26830 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26831
26832 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26833 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26834 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26835 @lisp
26836 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26837 @end lisp
26838
26839 @end itemize
26840
26841 @item Changes in summary and article mode
26842 @c **************************************
26843
26844 @itemize @bullet
26845
26846 @item
26847 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
26848 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
26849 region if the region is active.
26850
26851 @item
26852 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
26853 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
26854
26855 @item
26856 Article Buttons
26857
26858 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
26859 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
26860 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
26861 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
26862
26863 @item
26864 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
26865
26866 @item
26867 Picons
26868
26869 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
26870 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
26871
26872 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
26873 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
26874 @xref{Picons}.
26875
26876 @item
26877 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
26878 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
26879
26880 @item
26881 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
26882
26883 @item
26884 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
26885 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
26886
26887 @item
26888 Warn about email replies to news
26889
26890 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
26891 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
26892 you.
26893
26894 @item
26895 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
26896 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
26897 built.
26898
26899 @item
26900 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
26901 opposed to old but unread messages).
26902
26903 @item
26904 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
26905 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
26906
26907 @item
26908 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
26909 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
26910
26911 @item
26912 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
26913 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
26914
26915 @item
26916 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
26917
26918 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
26919 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
26920 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
26921 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
26922 citations.
26923
26924 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
26925 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
26926 Outlook (Express) articles.
26927
26928 @item
26929 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26930
26931 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26932 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26933 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26934 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26935
26936 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26937 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26938 message cited below.
26939
26940 @item
26941 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
26942 Emacs too.
26943
26944 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
26945 disable it.
26946
26947 @item
26948 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
26949
26950 @item
26951 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26952 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26953
26954 @item
26955 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26956
26957 @item
26958 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26959
26960 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26961 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26962 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26963 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26964 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26965 groups.
26966
26967 @item
26968 Deleting of attachments.
26969
26970 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26971 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26972 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26973 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26974 that support editing.
26975
26976 @item
26977 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26978
26979 The default value is determined from the
26980 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26981 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26982 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26983
26984 @item
26985 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26986
26987 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26988 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26989 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26990
26991 @item
26992 Extended format specs.
26993
26994 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26995 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26996 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26997 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26998 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26999 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
27000
27001 @item
27002 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
27003 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
27004
27005 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
27006 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
27007 out other articles.
27008
27009 @item
27010 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
27011
27012 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
27013 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
27014 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
27015 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
27016
27017 @item
27018 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
27019
27020 @end itemize
27021
27022 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
27023 @c ****************************************************
27024
27025 @itemize @bullet
27026
27027 @item
27028 Delayed articles
27029
27030 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
27031 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
27032 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
27033
27034 @item
27035 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
27036 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
27037
27038 @item
27039 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
27040 Gcc articles as read.
27041
27042 @item
27043 Externalizing of attachments
27044
27045 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
27046 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
27047 local files as external parts.
27048
27049 @item
27050 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
27051 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
27052
27053 @item
27054 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
27055
27056 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
27057 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
27058 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
27059 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
27060 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
27061 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
27062 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
27063 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
27064 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
27065
27066 @item
27067 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
27068
27069 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
27070 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
27071 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
27072 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
27073 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
27074 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
27075
27076 @item
27077 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
27078 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
27079 @code{nil}.
27080
27081 @item
27082 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
27083
27084 @item
27085 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
27086
27087 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
27088 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
27089 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
27090 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
27091 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
27092 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
27093 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
27094 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
27095 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
27096 was inserted directly.
27097
27098 @item
27099 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
27100
27101 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
27102 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
27103 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
27104 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
27105
27106 @item
27107 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
27108
27109 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
27110 @lisp
27111 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
27112 'bbdb-complete-name)
27113 @end lisp
27114
27115 @item
27116 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
27117
27118 Add a new format of match like
27119 @lisp
27120 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
27121 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
27122 @end lisp
27123 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
27124 @lisp
27125 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
27126 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
27127 @end lisp
27128
27129 @item
27130 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
27131
27132 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
27133 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
27134 need add those two headers too.
27135
27136 @item
27137 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
27138 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
27139 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
27140 versions.
27141
27142 @item
27143 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
27144 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
27145 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
27146 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
27147 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
27148
27149 @item
27150 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
27151
27152 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
27153
27154 @item
27155 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
27156
27157 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
27158 the valid values.
27159
27160 @item
27161 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
27162
27163 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
27164 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
27165 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
27166 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
27167 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
27168 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
27169 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
27170 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
27171
27172 @item
27173 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
27174 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
27175
27176 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
27177 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
27178 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
27179 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
27180
27181 @item
27182 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
27183 C-m}.
27184
27185 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
27186 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
27187
27188 @item
27189 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
27190 @code{best}.
27191
27192 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
27193 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
27194 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
27195 invalidate the digital signature.
27196
27197 @item
27198 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
27199 decompressed when activated.
27200 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
27201
27202 @item
27203 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
27204
27205 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
27206 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
27207 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
27208 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
27209 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
27210 controls this.
27211
27212 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
27213 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
27214 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
27215 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11
27216
27217 @end itemize
27218
27219 @item Changes in back ends
27220 @c ***********************
27221
27222 @itemize @bullet
27223 @item
27224 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
27225
27226 @item
27227 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
27228
27229 @item
27230 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
27231
27232 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
27233
27234 @item
27235 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
27236
27237 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
27238 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
27239 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
27240 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
27241 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
27242 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
27243 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
27244 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
27245 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
27246 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
27247 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
27248
27249 @end itemize
27250
27251 @item Appearance
27252 @c *************
27253
27254 @itemize @bullet
27255
27256 @item
27257 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
27258 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
27259
27260 @item
27261 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
27262 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
27263 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
27264 message, Message Manual}).
27265
27266 @item
27267 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
27268 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars. This is a new
27269 feature in Gnus 5.10.9. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
27270
27271 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
27272 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
27273 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
27274 in Gnus 5.10.9.
27275 @end itemize
27276
27277
27278 @item Miscellaneous changes
27279 @c ************************
27280
27281 @itemize @bullet
27282
27283 @item
27284 @code{gnus-agent}
27285
27286 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
27287 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
27288 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
27289 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
27290 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
27291 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
27292 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
27293 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
27294 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
27295 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
27296 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
27297 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
27298 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
27299 is not needed any more.
27300
27301 @item
27302 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
27303
27304 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
27305 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
27306 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
27307
27308 @item
27309 Dired integration
27310
27311 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
27312 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
27313 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
27314 entry.
27315
27316 @item
27317 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
27318
27319 @item
27320 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
27321
27322 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
27323
27324 @end itemize
27325
27326 @end itemize
27327
27328 @iftex
27329
27330 @page
27331 @node The Manual
27332 @section The Manual
27333 @cindex colophon
27334 @cindex manual
27335
27336 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
27337 either @code{texi2dvi}
27338 @iflatex
27339 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
27340 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
27341 @end iflatex
27342 to get what you hold in your hands now.
27343
27344 The following conventions have been used:
27345
27346 @enumerate
27347
27348 @item
27349 This is a @samp{string}
27350
27351 @item
27352 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
27353
27354 @item
27355 This is a @file{file}
27356
27357 @item
27358 This is a @code{symbol}
27359
27360 @end enumerate
27361
27362 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
27363 mean:
27364
27365 @lisp
27366 (setq flargnoze "yes")
27367 @end lisp
27368
27369 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
27370
27371 @lisp
27372 (setq flumphel 'yes)
27373 @end lisp
27374
27375 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
27376 ever get them confused.
27377
27378 @iflatex
27379 @c @head
27380 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
27381 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
27382 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
27383 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
27384 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
27385 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
27386 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
27387 @end iflatex
27388
27389 @end iftex
27390
27391
27392 @node On Writing Manuals
27393 @section On Writing Manuals
27394
27395 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
27396 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
27397 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
27398 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
27399 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
27400 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
27401 in hand.
27402
27403 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
27404 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
27405 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
27406 started with Gnus.
27407
27408 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
27409 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
27410
27411
27412 @page
27413 @node Terminology
27414 @section Terminology
27415
27416 @cindex terminology
27417 @table @dfn
27418
27419 @item news
27420 @cindex news
27421 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
27422 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
27423 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
27424 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
27425 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
27426
27427 @item mail
27428 @cindex mail
27429 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
27430 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
27431 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
27432 not posting, and replying is not following up.
27433
27434 @item reply
27435 @cindex reply
27436 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
27437
27438 @item follow up
27439 @cindex follow up
27440 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
27441 are reading.
27442
27443 @item back end
27444 @cindex back end
27445 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
27446 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
27447 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
27448 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
27449 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
27450 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
27451 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
27452 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
27453 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
27454 number 4711''.
27455
27456 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
27457 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
27458 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
27459 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
27460 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
27461 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
27462
27463 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
27464 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
27465 access the articles.
27466
27467 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
27468 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
27469 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
27470 confusing.
27471
27472 @item native
27473 @cindex native
27474 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
27475 default, way of getting news.
27476
27477 @item foreign
27478 @cindex foreign
27479 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
27480 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
27481 news.
27482
27483 @item secondary
27484 @cindex secondary
27485 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
27486 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
27487
27488 @item article
27489 @cindex article
27490 A message that has been posted as news.
27491
27492 @item mail message
27493 @cindex mail message
27494 A message that has been mailed.
27495
27496 @item message
27497 @cindex message
27498 A mail message or news article
27499
27500 @item head
27501 @cindex head
27502 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
27503 put.
27504
27505 @item body
27506 @cindex body
27507 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
27508 body.
27509
27510 @item header
27511 @cindex header
27512 A line from the head of an article.
27513
27514 @item headers
27515 @cindex headers
27516 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
27517 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
27518
27519 @item @acronym{NOV}
27520 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
27521 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
27522 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
27523 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
27524 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
27525 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
27526
27527 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
27528 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
27529 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
27530 normal @sc{head} format.
27531
27532 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
27533 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
27534 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
27535 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
27536 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
27537 references, etc.
27538
27539 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
27540 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
27541 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
27542 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
27543 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
27544 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
27545 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
27546
27547 @item level
27548 @cindex levels
27549 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
27550 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
27551 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
27552 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
27553 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
27554 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
27555
27556 @item killed groups
27557 @cindex killed groups
27558 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
27559 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
27560
27561 @item zombie groups
27562 @cindex zombie groups
27563 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
27564
27565 @item active file
27566 @cindex active file
27567 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
27568 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
27569 is rather large, as you might surmise.
27570
27571 @item bogus groups
27572 @cindex bogus groups
27573 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
27574 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
27575 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
27576
27577 @item activating
27578 @cindex activating groups
27579 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
27580 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
27581 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
27582
27583 @item spool
27584 @cindex spool
27585 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
27586 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
27587 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
27588
27589 @item server
27590 @cindex server
27591 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
27592
27593 @item select method
27594 @cindex select method
27595 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
27596 server settings.
27597
27598 @item virtual server
27599 @cindex virtual server
27600 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
27601 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
27602 whole is a virtual server.
27603
27604 @item washing
27605 @cindex washing
27606 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
27607 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
27608 original.
27609
27610 @item ephemeral groups
27611 @cindex ephemeral groups
27612 @cindex temporary groups
27613 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
27614 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
27615 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
27616
27617 @item solid groups
27618 @cindex solid groups
27619 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
27620 group buffer are solid groups.
27621
27622 @item sparse articles
27623 @cindex sparse articles
27624 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
27625 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
27626
27627 @item threading
27628 @cindex threading
27629 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
27630 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
27631
27632 @item root
27633 @cindex root
27634 @cindex thread root
27635 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
27636 articles in the thread.
27637
27638 @item parent
27639 @cindex parent
27640 An article that has responses.
27641
27642 @item child
27643 @cindex child
27644 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
27645
27646 @item digest
27647 @cindex digest
27648 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
27649 specified by RFC 1153.
27650
27651 @item splitting
27652 @cindex splitting, terminology
27653 @cindex mail sorting
27654 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
27655 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
27656 incorrectly called mail filtering.
27657
27658 @end table
27659
27660
27661 @page
27662 @node Customization
27663 @section Customization
27664 @cindex general customization
27665
27666 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
27667 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
27668 for some quite common situations.
27669
27670 @menu
27671 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
27672 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
27673 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
27674 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
27675 @end menu
27676
27677
27678 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
27679 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
27680
27681 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
27682 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
27683 Gnus has to get from the server.
27684
27685 @table @code
27686
27687 @item gnus-read-active-file
27688 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
27689 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
27690 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27691 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
27692 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
27693
27694 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
27695 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
27696 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
27697 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
27698 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
27699 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
27700 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
27701 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
27702 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
27703 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
27704 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
27705
27706 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
27707 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
27708 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
27709 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}, and
27710 @code{nnwarchive-nov-is-evil}. Note that a non-@code{nil} value for
27711 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those variables.@footnote{Although
27712 the back ends @code{nnkiboze}, @code{nnslashdot}, @code{nnultimate}, and
27713 @code{nnwfm} don't have their own nn*-nov-is-evil.}
27714 @end table
27715
27716
27717 @node Slow Terminal Connection
27718 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
27719
27720 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
27721 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
27722 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
27723
27724 @table @code
27725
27726 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
27727 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
27728 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
27729 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
27730 horizontal and vertical recentering.
27731
27732 @item gnus-visible-headers
27733 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
27734 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
27735 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
27736 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
27737
27738 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
27739 @lisp
27740 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
27741 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
27742 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
27743 @end lisp
27744
27745 @item gnus-use-full-window
27746 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
27747 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
27748 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
27749 want to read them anyway.
27750
27751 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
27752 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
27753 hidden initially.
27754
27755
27756 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
27757 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
27758 lines, which might save some time.
27759 @end table
27760
27761
27762 @node Little Disk Space
27763 @subsection Little Disk Space
27764 @cindex disk space
27765
27766 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
27767 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
27768
27769 @table @code
27770
27771 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
27772 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
27773 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27774 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27775 default.
27776
27777 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
27778 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
27779 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27780 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27781 default.
27782
27783 @item gnus-save-killed-list
27784 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
27785 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
27786 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
27787 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
27788
27789 @end table
27790
27791
27792 @node Slow Machine
27793 @subsection Slow Machine
27794 @cindex slow machine
27795
27796 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
27797 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
27798
27799 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27800 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
27801
27802 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
27803 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
27804 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
27805
27806
27807 @page
27808 @node Troubleshooting
27809 @section Troubleshooting
27810 @cindex troubleshooting
27811
27812 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
27813 problems, really.
27814
27815 Ahem.
27816
27817 @enumerate
27818
27819 @item
27820 Make sure your computer is switched on.
27821
27822 @item
27823 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
27824 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
27825 Gnus will work.
27826
27827 @item
27828 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
27829 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
27830 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
27831
27832 @item
27833 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
27834 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
27835
27836 @item
27837 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
27838 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
27839 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
27840 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
27841 something like that.
27842 @end enumerate
27843
27844 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
27845
27846 @cindex bugs
27847 @cindex reporting bugs
27848
27849 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
27850 @findex gnus-bug
27851 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
27852 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
27853 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
27854 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
27855
27856 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
27857 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
27858 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
27859 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
27860 time.
27861
27862 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
27863 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
27864 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
27865 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
27866 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
27867 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
27868
27869 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
27870 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
27871 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
27872 the bug report.
27873
27874 @cindex patches
27875 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
27876 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
27877
27878 @cindex edebug
27879 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
27880 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
27881 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
27882 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
27883 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
27884 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
27885 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
27886 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
27887 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
27888 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
27889 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
27890 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
27891 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
27892 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
27893
27894 @cindex elp
27895 @cindex profile
27896 @cindex slow
27897 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
27898 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
27899 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
27900 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
27901 helps isolating the real problem areas).
27902
27903 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
27904 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
27905 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
27906 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
27907 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
27908 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
27909 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
27910 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
27911 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
27912 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
27913 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
27914 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
27915 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
27916 work perfectly.
27917
27918 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
27919 @cindex ding mailing list
27920 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
27921 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
27922 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
27923 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
27924
27925
27926 @page
27927 @node Gnus Reference Guide
27928 @section Gnus Reference Guide
27929
27930 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
27931 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
27932 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
27933 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
27934 it.
27935
27936 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
27937 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
27938 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
27939 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
27940 and general methods of operation.
27941
27942 @menu
27943 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
27944 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
27945 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
27946 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
27947 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
27948 * Group Info:: The group info format.
27949 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
27950 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
27951 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
27952 @end menu
27953
27954
27955 @node Gnus Utility Functions
27956 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
27957 @cindex Gnus utility functions
27958 @cindex utility functions
27959 @cindex functions
27960 @cindex internal variables
27961
27962 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
27963 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
27964 Below is a list of the most common ones.
27965
27966 @table @code
27967
27968 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
27969 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
27970 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
27971
27972 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
27973 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
27974 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
27975
27976 @item gnus-group-real-name
27977 @findex gnus-group-real-name
27978 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
27979 name.
27980
27981 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
27982 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
27983 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
27984 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
27985
27986 @item gnus-get-info
27987 @findex gnus-get-info
27988 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
27989
27990 @item gnus-group-unread
27991 @findex gnus-group-unread
27992 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
27993 unknown.
27994
27995 @item gnus-active
27996 @findex gnus-active
27997 The active entry for @var{group}.
27998
27999 @item gnus-set-active
28000 @findex gnus-set-active
28001 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
28002
28003 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
28004 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
28005 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
28006 exit.
28007
28008 @item gnus-continuum-version
28009 @findex gnus-continuum-version
28010 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
28011 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
28012 versions.
28013
28014 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
28015 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
28016 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
28017
28018 @item gnus-news-group-p
28019 @findex gnus-news-group-p
28020 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
28021
28022 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
28023 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
28024 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
28025
28026 @item gnus-server-to-method
28027 @findex gnus-server-to-method
28028 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
28029
28030 @item gnus-server-equal
28031 @findex gnus-server-equal
28032 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
28033
28034 @item gnus-group-native-p
28035 @findex gnus-group-native-p
28036 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
28037
28038 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
28039 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
28040 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
28041
28042 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
28043 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
28044 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
28045
28046 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
28047 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
28048 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
28049 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
28050
28051 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
28052 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
28053 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
28054
28055 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
28056 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
28057 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
28058
28059 @item gnus-check-backend-function
28060 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
28061 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
28062 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
28063
28064 @lisp
28065 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
28066 @result{} t
28067 @end lisp
28068
28069 @item gnus-read-method
28070 @findex gnus-read-method
28071 Prompts the user for a select method.
28072
28073 @end table
28074
28075
28076 @node Back End Interface
28077 @subsection Back End Interface
28078
28079 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
28080 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
28081 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
28082 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
28083 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
28084 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
28085
28086 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
28087 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
28088 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
28089 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
28090 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
28091 been opened, the function should fail.
28092
28093 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
28094 name. Take this example:
28095
28096 @lisp
28097 (nntp "odd-one"
28098 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
28099 (nntp-port-number 4324))
28100 @end lisp
28101
28102 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
28103 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
28104
28105 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
28106 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
28107 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
28108
28109 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
28110 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
28111 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
28112
28113 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
28114 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
28115 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
28116 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
28117 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
28118 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
28119 return value.
28120
28121 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
28122 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
28123 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
28124 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
28125 more.
28126
28127 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
28128 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
28129 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
28130 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
28131 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
28132 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
28133 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
28134 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
28135 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
28136 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
28137
28138 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
28139 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
28140 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
28141 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
28142 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
28143 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
28144 of numbers as long as possible.
28145
28146 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
28147 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
28148 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
28149
28150 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
28151 @code{nnchoke}.
28152
28153 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
28154
28155 @menu
28156 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
28157 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
28158 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
28159 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
28160 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
28161 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
28162 @end menu
28163
28164
28165 @node Required Back End Functions
28166 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
28167
28168 @table @code
28169
28170 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
28171
28172 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
28173 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
28174 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
28175 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
28176
28177 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
28178 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
28179 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
28180 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
28181
28182 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
28183 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
28184 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
28185 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
28186 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
28187 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
28188 number, do maximum fetches.
28189
28190 Here's an example HEAD:
28191
28192 @example
28193 221 1056 Article retrieved.
28194 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
28195 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
28196 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
28197 Subject: Re: Something very droll
28198 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
28199 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
28200 Lines: 26
28201 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
28202 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
28203 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
28204 .
28205 @end example
28206
28207 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
28208 these in the data buffer.
28209
28210 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
28211
28212 @example
28213 headers = *head
28214 head = error / valid-head
28215 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
28216 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
28217 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
28218 header = <text> eol
28219 @end example
28220
28221 @cindex BNF
28222 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
28223
28224 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
28225 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
28226 separated by tabs.
28227
28228 @example
28229 nov-buffer = *nov-line
28230 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
28231 field = <text except TAB>
28232 @end example
28233
28234 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
28235 @pxref{Headers}.
28236
28237
28238 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
28239
28240 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
28241 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
28242
28243 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
28244 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
28245 server. In fact, it should do so.
28246
28247 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
28248 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
28249
28250
28251 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
28252
28253 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
28254 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
28255 reason.
28256
28257 There should be no data returned.
28258
28259
28260 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
28261
28262 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
28263 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
28264 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
28265 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
28266
28267 There should be no data returned.
28268
28269
28270 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
28271
28272 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
28273 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
28274 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
28275 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
28276
28277 There should be no data returned.
28278
28279
28280 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
28281
28282 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
28283
28284 There should be no data returned.
28285
28286
28287 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
28288
28289 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
28290 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
28291 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
28292 it would be nice if that were possible.
28293
28294 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
28295 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
28296 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
28297 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
28298 into its article buffer.
28299
28300 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
28301 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
28302 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
28303 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
28304 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
28305 on successful article retrieval.
28306
28307
28308 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
28309
28310 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
28311 making @var{group} the current group.
28312
28313 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
28314 the current group.
28315
28316 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
28317
28318 @example
28319 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
28320 @end example
28321
28322 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
28323 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
28324 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
28325 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
28326 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
28327 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
28328 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
28329 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
28330 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
28331 highest as 0.
28332
28333 @example
28334 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
28335 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
28336 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
28337 @end example
28338
28339
28340 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
28341
28342 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
28343 a no-op on most back ends.
28344
28345 There should be no data returned.
28346
28347
28348 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
28349
28350 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
28351 @emph{all}.
28352
28353 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
28354
28355 @example
28356 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
28357 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
28358 @end example
28359
28360 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
28361 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
28362 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
28363 and the highest as 0.
28364
28365 @example
28366 active-file = *active-line
28367 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
28368 name = <string>
28369 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
28370 @end example
28371
28372 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
28373 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
28374 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
28375
28376
28377 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
28378
28379 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
28380 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
28381 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
28382 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
28383 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
28384 clear if the posting could not be completed.
28385
28386 There should be no result data from this function.
28387
28388 @end table
28389
28390
28391 @node Optional Back End Functions
28392 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
28393
28394 @table @code
28395
28396 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
28397
28398 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
28399 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
28400 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
28401
28402 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
28403 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
28404 former is in the same format as the data from
28405 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
28406 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
28407
28408 @example
28409 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
28410 @end example
28411
28412
28413 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
28414
28415 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
28416 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
28417 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
28418 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
28419 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
28420
28421 There should be no result data from this function.
28422
28423
28424 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
28425
28426 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
28427 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
28428 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
28429 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
28430 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
28431 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
28432 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
28433 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
28434
28435 There should be no result data from this function.
28436
28437
28438 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
28439
28440 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
28441 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
28442 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
28443 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
28444 propagate the mark information to the server.
28445
28446 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
28447
28448 @example
28449 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
28450 @end example
28451
28452 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
28453 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
28454 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
28455 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
28456 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
28457 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
28458 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
28459 possible, not limit itself to these.
28460
28461 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
28462 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
28463 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
28464 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
28465
28466 An example action list:
28467
28468 @example
28469 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
28470 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
28471 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
28472 @end example
28473
28474 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
28475 mark on (currently not used for anything).
28476
28477 There should be no result data from this function.
28478
28479 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
28480
28481 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
28482 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
28483 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
28484 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
28485 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
28486
28487 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
28488 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
28489 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
28490 expirable.
28491
28492 There should be no result data from this function.
28493
28494
28495 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
28496
28497 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
28498 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
28499 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
28500 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
28501 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
28502 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
28503 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
28504 local if that's practical.
28505
28506 There should be no result data from this function.
28507
28508
28509 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
28510
28511 The result data from this function should be a description of
28512 @var{group}.
28513
28514 @example
28515 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
28516 name = <string>
28517 description = <text>
28518 @end example
28519
28520 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
28521
28522 The result data from this function should be the description of all
28523 groups available on the server.
28524
28525 @example
28526 description-buffer = *description-line
28527 @end example
28528
28529
28530 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
28531
28532 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
28533 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
28534 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
28535 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
28536 in the active buffer format.
28537
28538 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
28539 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
28540 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
28541 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
28542 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
28543 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
28544 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
28545
28546
28547 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
28548
28549 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
28550
28551 There should be no return data.
28552
28553
28554 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
28555
28556 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
28557 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
28558 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
28559 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
28560 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
28561 they are.
28562
28563 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
28564 able to delete.
28565
28566 There should be no result data returned.
28567
28568
28569 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
28570
28571 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
28572 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
28573
28574 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
28575 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
28576 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
28577 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
28578 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
28579 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
28580
28581 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
28582 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
28583 optimizations.
28584
28585 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
28586 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
28587
28588 There should be no data returned.
28589
28590
28591 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
28592
28593 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
28594 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
28595 this function in short order.
28596
28597 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
28598 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
28599
28600 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
28601 article for that group.
28602
28603 There should be no data returned.
28604
28605
28606 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
28607
28608 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
28609 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
28610
28611 There should be no data returned.
28612
28613
28614 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
28615
28616 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
28617 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
28618 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
28619
28620 There should be no data returned.
28621
28622
28623 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
28624
28625 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
28626 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
28627
28628 There should be no data returned.
28629
28630 @end table
28631
28632
28633 @node Error Messaging
28634 @subsubsection Error Messaging
28635
28636 @findex nnheader-report
28637 @findex nnheader-get-report
28638 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
28639 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
28640 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
28641 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
28642 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
28643 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
28644
28645 @lisp
28646 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
28647
28648 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
28649 @end lisp
28650
28651 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
28652 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
28653 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
28654 takes one argument---the server symbol.
28655
28656 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
28657 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
28658 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
28659
28660
28661 @node Writing New Back Ends
28662 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
28663
28664 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
28665 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
28666 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
28667 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
28668 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
28669 editing articles.
28670
28671 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
28672 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
28673 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
28674
28675 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
28676 package called @code{nnoo}.
28677
28678 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
28679 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
28680 following macros:
28681
28682 @table @code
28683
28684 @item nnoo-declare
28685 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
28686 parameters. For instance:
28687
28688 @lisp
28689 (nnoo-declare nndir
28690 nnml nnmh)
28691 @end lisp
28692
28693 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
28694 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
28695
28696 @item defvoo
28697 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
28698 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
28699 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
28700
28701 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
28702 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
28703 a function in those back ends.
28704
28705 @lisp
28706 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28707 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28708 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28709 @end lisp
28710
28711 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
28712 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
28713 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
28714
28715 @item nnoo-define-basics
28716 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
28717 have.
28718
28719 @lisp
28720 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28721 @end lisp
28722
28723 @item deffoo
28724 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
28725 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
28726 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
28727
28728 @item nnoo-map-functions
28729 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
28730 functions from the parent back ends.
28731
28732 @lisp
28733 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28734 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28735 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
28736 @end lisp
28737
28738 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
28739 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
28740 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
28741 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
28742
28743 @item nnoo-import
28744 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
28745 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
28746 haven't already been defined.
28747
28748 @lisp
28749 (nnoo-import nndir
28750 (nnmh
28751 nnmh-request-list
28752 nnmh-request-newgroups)
28753 (nnml))
28754 @end lisp
28755
28756 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
28757 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
28758 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
28759 defined now.
28760
28761 @end table
28762
28763 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
28764
28765 @lisp
28766 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
28767 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
28768
28769 ;;; @r{Code:}
28770
28771 (require 'nnheader)
28772 (require 'nnmh)
28773 (require 'nnml)
28774 (require 'nnoo)
28775 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
28776
28777 (nnoo-declare nndir
28778 nnml nnmh)
28779
28780 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28781 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28782 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28783
28784 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
28785 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
28786 nnml-nov-is-evil)
28787
28788 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
28789 nil
28790 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
28791 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
28792 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
28793
28794 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
28795 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
28796
28797 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
28798
28799 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28800
28801 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
28802 (setq nndir-directory
28803 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
28804 server))
28805 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
28806 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
28807 (push `(nndir-current-group
28808 ,(file-name-nondirectory
28809 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28810 defs)
28811 (push `(nndir-top-directory
28812 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28813 defs)
28814 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
28815
28816 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28817 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28818 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28819 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
28820 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
28821
28822 (nnoo-import nndir
28823 (nnmh
28824 nnmh-status-message
28825 nnmh-request-list
28826 nnmh-request-newgroups))
28827
28828 (provide 'nndir)
28829 @end lisp
28830
28831
28832 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28833 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28834
28835 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
28836 @findex gnus-declare-backend
28837 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
28838 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
28839 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
28840
28841 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
28842 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
28843
28844 Here's an example:
28845
28846 @lisp
28847 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
28848 @end lisp
28849
28850 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
28851
28852 The abilities can be:
28853
28854 @table @code
28855 @item mail
28856 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
28857 @item post
28858 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
28859 @item post-mail
28860 This back end supports both mail and news.
28861 @item none
28862 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
28863 different.
28864 @item respool
28865 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
28866 articles and groups.
28867 @item address
28868 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
28869 true for almost all back ends.
28870 @item prompt-address
28871 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
28872 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
28873 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
28874 @end table
28875
28876
28877 @node Mail-like Back Ends
28878 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
28879
28880 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
28881 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
28882 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
28883 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
28884
28885 @lisp
28886 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
28887 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
28888 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
28889 @end lisp
28890
28891 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
28892 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
28893 mail.
28894
28895 This function takes four parameters.
28896
28897 @table @var
28898 @item method
28899 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
28900 the call.
28901
28902 @item exit-function
28903 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
28904
28905 @item temp-directory
28906 Where the temporary files should be stored.
28907
28908 @item group
28909 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
28910 performed for one group only.
28911 @end table
28912
28913 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
28914 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
28915 find the article number assigned to this article.
28916
28917 The function also uses the following variables:
28918 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
28919 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
28920 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
28921 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
28922 this:
28923
28924 @example
28925 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
28926 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
28927 @end example
28928
28929
28930 @node Score File Syntax
28931 @subsection Score File Syntax
28932
28933 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
28934 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
28935 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
28936
28937 Here's a typical score file:
28938
28939 @lisp
28940 (("summary"
28941 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
28942 ("Gnus"))
28943 ("from"
28944 ("Lars" -1000))
28945 (mark -100))
28946 @end lisp
28947
28948 BNF definition of a score file:
28949
28950 @example
28951 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
28952 element = rule / atom
28953 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
28954 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
28955 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
28956 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
28957 quote = <ascii 34>
28958 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
28959 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
28960 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
28961 date-header = "date"
28962 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28963 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28964 score = "nil" / <integer>
28965 date = "nil" / <natural number>
28966 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
28967 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
28968 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
28969 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
28970 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28971 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28972 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
28973 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28974 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
28975 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
28976 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
28977 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
28978 exclude-files / read-only / touched
28979 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
28980 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
28981 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
28982 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
28983 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
28984 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
28985 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
28986 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
28987 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
28988 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
28989 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
28990 eval = "eval" space <form>
28991 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
28992 @end example
28993
28994 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
28995 discarded.
28996
28997 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
28998 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
28999 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
29000 one looong line, then that's ok.
29001
29002 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
29003 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
29004
29005
29006 @node Headers
29007 @subsection Headers
29008
29009 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
29010 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
29011 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
29012 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
29013
29014 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
29015 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
29016 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
29017 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
29018 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
29019 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
29020 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
29021
29022 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
29023 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
29024 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
29025 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
29026 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
29027
29028 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
29029 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
29030
29031
29032 @node Ranges
29033 @subsection Ranges
29034
29035 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
29036 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
29037
29038 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
29039 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
29040 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
29041 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
29042
29043 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
29044 sequence.
29045
29046 @example
29047 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
29048 @end example
29049
29050 is transformed into
29051
29052 @example
29053 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
29054 @end example
29055
29056 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
29057 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
29058
29059 @example
29060 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
29061 @end example
29062
29063 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
29064 is slightly tricky:
29065
29066 @example
29067 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
29068 @end example
29069
29070 and
29071
29072 @example
29073 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
29074 @end example
29075
29076 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
29077
29078 @example
29079 (1 2 3 4 5)
29080 @end example
29081
29082 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
29083 also valid:
29084
29085 @example
29086 (1 . 5)
29087 @end example
29088
29089 and is equal to the previous range.
29090
29091 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
29092 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
29093 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
29094 range handling.)
29095
29096 @example
29097 range = simple-range / normal-range
29098 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
29099 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
29100 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
29101 number *[ " " contents ]
29102 @end example
29103
29104 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
29105 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
29106 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
29107 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
29108 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
29109 sequences.)
29110
29111
29112 @node Group Info
29113 @subsection Group Info
29114
29115 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
29116 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
29117 describes the group.
29118
29119 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
29120 second is a more complex one:
29121
29122 @example
29123 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
29124
29125 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
29126 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
29127 (nnml "")
29128 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
29129 @end example
29130
29131 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
29132 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
29133 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
29134 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
29135 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
29136 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
29137 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
29138 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
29139 this section is about.
29140
29141 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
29142 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
29143 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
29144
29145 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
29146
29147 @example
29148 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
29149 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
29150 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
29151 group = quote <string> quote
29152 ralevel = rank / level
29153 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
29154 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
29155 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
29156 read = range
29157 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
29158 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
29159 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
29160 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
29161 @end example
29162
29163 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
29164 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
29165 in pseudo-BNF.
29166
29167 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
29168 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
29169
29170 @table @code
29171 @item gnus-info-group
29172 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
29173 @findex gnus-info-group
29174 @findex gnus-info-set-group
29175 Get/set the group name.
29176
29177 @item gnus-info-rank
29178 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
29179 @findex gnus-info-rank
29180 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
29181 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
29182
29183 @item gnus-info-level
29184 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
29185 @findex gnus-info-level
29186 @findex gnus-info-set-level
29187 Get/set the group level.
29188
29189 @item gnus-info-score
29190 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
29191 @findex gnus-info-score
29192 @findex gnus-info-set-score
29193 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
29194
29195 @item gnus-info-read
29196 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
29197 @findex gnus-info-read
29198 @findex gnus-info-set-read
29199 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
29200
29201 @item gnus-info-marks
29202 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
29203 @findex gnus-info-marks
29204 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
29205 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
29206
29207 @item gnus-info-method
29208 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
29209 @findex gnus-info-method
29210 @findex gnus-info-set-method
29211 Get/set the group select method.
29212
29213 @item gnus-info-params
29214 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
29215 @findex gnus-info-params
29216 @findex gnus-info-set-params
29217 Get/set the group parameters.
29218 @end table
29219
29220 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
29221 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
29222
29223 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
29224 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
29225 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
29226 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
29227
29228
29229 @node Extended Interactive
29230 @subsection Extended Interactive
29231 @cindex interactive
29232 @findex gnus-interactive
29233
29234 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
29235 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
29236 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
29237
29238 @lisp
29239 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
29240 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
29241 ...
29242 )
29243 @end lisp
29244
29245 The best thing to do would have been to implement
29246 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
29247 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
29248 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
29249 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
29250 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
29251 @code{interactive}.
29252
29253 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
29254 adds a few more.
29255
29256 @table @samp
29257 @item y
29258 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
29259 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
29260 variable.
29261
29262 @item Y
29263 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
29264 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
29265 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
29266
29267 @item A
29268 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
29269 function.
29270
29271 @item H
29272 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
29273 function.
29274
29275 @item g
29276 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
29277 function.
29278
29279 @end table
29280
29281
29282 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
29283 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
29284 @cindex XEmacs
29285 @cindex Emacsen
29286
29287 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
29288 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
29289 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
29290
29291 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
29292 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
29293 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
29294 Gnus, that's very useful.
29295
29296 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
29297 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
29298 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
29299 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
29300 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
29301 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
29302 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
29303 following function:
29304
29305 @lisp
29306 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
29307 (start-itimer
29308 "gnus-run-at-time"
29309 `(lambda ()
29310 (,function ,@@args))
29311 time repeat))
29312 @end lisp
29313
29314 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
29315 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
29316 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
29317 all over.
29318
29319 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
29320 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
29321 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
29322
29323 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
29324 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
29325 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
29326
29327
29328 @node Various File Formats
29329 @subsection Various File Formats
29330
29331 @menu
29332 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
29333 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
29334 @end menu
29335
29336
29337 @node Active File Format
29338 @subsubsection Active File Format
29339
29340 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
29341 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
29342 in each group.
29343
29344 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
29345
29346 @example
29347 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
29348 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
29349 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
29350 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
29351 no.general 1000 900 y
29352 @end example
29353
29354 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
29355
29356 @example
29357 active = *group-line
29358 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
29359 group = <non-white-space string>
29360 spc = " "
29361 high-number = <non-negative integer>
29362 low-number = <positive integer>
29363 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
29364 @end example
29365
29366 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
29367 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
29368
29369
29370 @node Newsgroups File Format
29371 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
29372
29373 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
29374 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
29375 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
29376 the user.
29377
29378 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
29379 Here's the definition:
29380
29381 @example
29382 newsgroups = *line
29383 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
29384 group = <non-white-space string>
29385 tab = <TAB>
29386 description = <string>
29387 @end example
29388
29389
29390 @page
29391 @node Emacs for Heathens
29392 @section Emacs for Heathens
29393
29394 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
29395 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
29396 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
29397 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
29398 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
29399 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
29400 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
29401 cat instead.
29402
29403 @menu
29404 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
29405 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
29406 @end menu
29407
29408
29409 @node Keystrokes
29410 @subsection Keystrokes
29411
29412 @itemize @bullet
29413 @item
29414 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
29415
29416 @item
29417 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
29418 @end itemize
29419
29420 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
29421 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
29422 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
29423 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
29424 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
29425 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
29426
29427 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
29428 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
29429 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
29430 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
29431 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
29432 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
29433 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
29434
29435 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
29436 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
29437 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
29438 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
29439 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
29440 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
29441 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
29442
29443 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
29444 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
29445 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
29446 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
29447 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
29448 it.
29449
29450
29451
29452 @node Emacs Lisp
29453 @subsection Emacs Lisp
29454
29455 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
29456 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
29457 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
29458 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
29459
29460 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
29461 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
29462 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
29463 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
29464 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
29465 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
29466 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
29467 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
29468 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
29469 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
29470
29471 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
29472 write the following:
29473
29474 @lisp
29475 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
29476 @end lisp
29477
29478 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
29479 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
29480 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
29481 change how Gnus works.
29482
29483 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
29484 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
29485 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
29486 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
29487 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
29488
29489 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
29490 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
29491 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
29492
29493 Some pitfalls:
29494
29495 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
29496 that means:
29497
29498 @lisp
29499 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
29500 @end lisp
29501
29502 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
29503 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
29504
29505 @lisp
29506 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
29507 @end lisp
29508
29509 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
29510 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
29511
29512 @page
29513 @include gnus-faq.texi
29514
29515 @node GNU Free Documentation License
29516 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
29517 @include doclicense.texi
29518
29519 @node Index
29520 @chapter Index
29521 @printindex cp
29522
29523 @node Key Index
29524 @chapter Key Index
29525 @printindex ky
29526
29527 @summarycontents
29528 @contents
29529 @bye
29530
29531 @iftex
29532 @iflatex
29533 \end{document}
29534 @end iflatex
29535 @end iftex
29536
29537 @c Local Variables:
29538 @c mode: texinfo
29539 @c coding: iso-8859-1
29540 @c End:
29541
29542 @ignore
29543 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
29544 @end ignore